Attached files

file filename
EX-32.2 - EXHIBIT 32.2 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex32_2.htm
EX-32.1 - EXHIBIT 32.1 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex32_1.htm
EX-31.2 - EXHIBIT 31.2 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex31_2.htm
EX-31.1 - EXHIBIT 31.1 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex31_1.htm
EX-23.1 - EXHIBIT 23.1 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex23_1.htm
EX-21 - EXHIBIT 21 - META FINANCIAL GROUP INCcash09302016ex21.htm

 
 
 
 
 

UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
FORM 10‑K
 
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016
OR
 
TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
For the transition period from _______ to _______
 
Commission file number 0‑22140.
 
META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
(Name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
Delaware
 
42‑1406262
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
 
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)
5501 South Broadband Lane, Sioux Falls, SD
 
57108
(Address of principal executive offices)
 
(Zip Code)
 
Registrant’s telephone number:  (605) 782‑1767
 
Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
 
Title of Class
 
Name of each exchange on which registered
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share
 
NASDAQ Global Market

Securities Registered Pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:  None
 
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is a well‑known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  YES ☐ NO ☒
 
Indicate by check mark if the Registrant is not required to file reports pursuant Section 13 and Section 15(d) of the Act.  YES ☐ NO ☒
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  YES ☒ NO ☐
 

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S‑T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit and post such files).  YES ☒ NO☐.
 
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S‑K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of Registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10‑K or any amendment to this Form 10‑K.☐
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non‑accelerated filer or a smaller reporting company.  (Check one):

Large accelerated filer ☐
Accelerated filer ☒
Non‑accelerated filer ☐
Smaller Reporting Company ☐
 
Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b‑2 of the Exchange Act). ☐ YES ☒ NO
 
As of March 31, 2016, the aggregate market value of the voting stock held by non-affiliates of the Registrant, computed by reference to the average of the closing bid and asked prices of such stock on the NASDAQ Global Market as of such date, was $360.0 million.
 
As of December 8, 2016, there were outstanding 9,188,292 shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock.
 
DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE
 
PART III of Form 10-K -- Portions of the Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held January 23, 2017.

 
 
 
 
 



META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
FORM 10-K

Table of Contents
 
 
 
Page
No.
 
 
 
 
PART I
 
 
 
 
Item 1.
Item 1A.
Item 1B.
Item 2.
Item 3.
Item 4.
 
 
 
 
PART II
 
 
 
 
Item 5.
Item 6.
Item 7.
Item 7A.
Item 8.
Item 9.
Item 9A.
Item 9B.
 
 
 
 
PART III
 
 
 
 
Item 10.
Item 11.
Item 12.
Item 13.
Item 14.
 
 
 
 
PART IV
 
 
 
 
Item 15.
Item 16.


i


Forward-Looking Statements
 
Meta Financial Group, Inc.® (“Meta Financial” or “the Company” or “us”) and its wholly-owned subsidiary, MetaBank® (the “Bank” or “MetaBank”), may from time to time make written or oral “forward-looking statements,” including statements contained in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, in its other filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), in its reports to stockholders, and in other communications by the Company and the Bank, which are made in good faith by the Company pursuant to the “safe harbor” provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.

You can identify forward-looking statements by words such as “may,” “hope,” “will,” “should,” “expect,” “plan,” “anticipate,” “intend,” “believe,” “estimate,” “predict,” “potential,” “continue,” “could,” “future,” or the negative of those terms, or other words of similar meaning. You should carefully read statements that contain these words because they discuss our future expectations or state other “forward-looking” information. These forward-looking statements include statements with respect to the Company’s beliefs, expectations, estimates, and intentions that are subject to significant risks and uncertainties, and are subject to change based on various factors, some of which are beyond the Company’s control. Such statements address, among others, the following subjects: statements regarding the potential benefits of the proposed acquisition of Specialty Consumer Services LP (“SCS”), including but not limited to, its ability to increase the Company's growth and the planned retention of SCS employees; future operating results; customer retention; loan and other product demand; important components of the Company's statements of financial condition and operations; growth and expansion; new products and services, such as those offered by MetaBank or Meta Payment Systems® (“MPS”), a division of the Bank; credit quality and adequacy of reserves; technology; and the Company's employees. Actual results may differ materially from those contained in the forward-looking statements contained herein. The following factors, among others, could cause the Company's financial performance and results of operations to differ materially from the expectations, estimates, and intentions expressed in such forward-looking statements: the risk that the SCS transaction may not be completed on a timely basis or at all; the businesses of the Bank and SCS may not be combined successfully, or such combination may take longer, be more difficult, time-consuming or costly to accomplish than expected; the risk that sales of SCS products by the Bank may not be as high as anticipated; the expected growth opportunities or cost savings from the SCS acquisition may not be fully realized or may take longer to realize than expected; customer losses and business disruption following the SCS acquisition, including adverse effects on relationships with former or current employees of SCS may be greater than expected; the risk that the Company may incur unanticipated or unknown losses or liabilities if it completes the transaction with SCS; maintaining our executive management team; the strength of the United States' economy, in general, and the strength of the local economies in which the Company conducts operations; the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary, and fiscal policies and laws, including interest rate policies of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”), as well as efforts of the United States Treasury in conjunction with bank regulatory agencies to stimulate the economy and protect the financial system; inflation, interest rate, market, and monetary fluctuations; the timely development of, and acceptance of new products and services offered by the Company, as well as risks (including reputational and litigation) attendant thereto, and the perceived overall value of these products and services by users; the risks of dealing with or utilizing third parties; any actions which may be initiated by our regulators in the future; the impact of changes in financial services laws and regulations, including, but not limited to, laws and regulations relating to the tax refund industry and the insurance premium finance industry, our relationship with our primary regulators, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) and the Federal Reserve, as well as the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”), which insures the Bank’s deposit accounts up to applicable limits; technological changes, including, but not limited to, the protection of electronic files or databases; acquisitions; litigation risk, in general, including, but not limited to, those risks involving the Bank's divisions; the growth of the Company’s business, as well as expenses related thereto; continued maintenance by the Bank of its status as a well-capitalized institution, particularly in light of our growing deposit base, a substantial portion of which has been characterized as “brokered”; changes in consumer spending and saving habits; and the success of the Company at maintaining its high quality asset level and managing and collecting assets of borrowers in default should problem assets increase.

These statements are based on information currently available to us and are subject to various risks, uncertainties, and other factors, including, but not limited to, those discussed herein under the caption “Risk Factors” that could cause our actual growth, results of operations, financial condition, cash flows, performance and business prospects and opportunities to differ materially from those expressed in, or implied by, these statements.

The foregoing list of factors is not exclusive.  We caution you not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date of this report.  All subsequent written and oral forward-looking statements attributable to us or any person acting on our behalf are expressly qualified in their entirety by the cautionary statements contained or referred to in this section.  Additional discussions of factors affecting the Company’s business and prospects are contained herein, including under the caption “Risk Factors,” and in the Company’s periodic filings with the SEC.  The Company expressly disclaims any intent or obligation to update any forward-looking statements, whether written or oral, that may be made from time to time by or on behalf of the Company or its subsidiaries.

 

2




Available Information
 
The Company’s website address is www.metafinancialgroup.com.  The Company makes available, through a link with the SEC’s EDGAR database, free of charge, its annual report on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K, amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), and beneficial ownership reports on Forms 3, 4, and 5.  Investors are encouraged to access these reports and other information about our business on our website.  The information found on the Company’s website is not incorporated by reference in this or any other report the Company files or furnishes to the SEC.  We also will provide copies of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, free of charge, upon written request to Brittany Kelly, Investor Relations Analyst, at the Company’s address.  Also posted on our website, among other things, are the charters of our committees of the Board of Directors as well as the Company’s and the Bank’s Codes of Ethics.


PART I
Item 1.        Business

General
 
Meta Financial, a registered unitary savings and loan holding company, is a Delaware corporation, the principal assets of which are all the issued and outstanding shares of the Bank, a federal savings bank, the accounts of which are insured up to applicable limits by the Deposit Insurance Fund (“DIF”) of the FDIC.  Unless the context otherwise requires, references herein to the Company include Meta Financial and the Bank, and all subsidiaries of Meta Financial, direct or indirect, on a consolidated basis.

The Bank, a wholly-owned full-service banking subsidiary of Meta Financial, is both a community-oriented financial institution offering a variety of financial services to meet the needs of the communities it serves and a payments company providing services on a nationwide basis, as further described below.  The business of the Bank consists of attracting retail deposits from the general public and investing those funds primarily in one-to-four family residential mortgage loans, commercial and multi-family real estate, agricultural operations and real estate, construction, consumer loans (including tax refund advance loans), commercial operating loans, and premium finance loans. In addition to originating loans, the Bank also has contracted to sell loans, in this case principally tax refund advance loans, to third party buyers. The Bank also purchases loan participations from time to time from other financial institutions, but presently at a lower level compared to prior years, as well as mortgage-backed securities and other investments permissible under applicable regulations.

In addition to its community-oriented lending and deposit gathering activities, the Bank’s various divisions issue prepaid cards, design innovative consumer credit products, sponsor Automatic Teller Machines (“ATMs”) into various debit networks, and offer tax refund-transfer services and other payment industry products and services.  Through its activities, the Meta Payment Systems ("MPS") division of the Bank generates both fee income and low- and no cost deposits for the Bank. On December 2, 2014, the Bank purchased substantially all of the commercial loan portfolio and related assets of AFS/IBEX Financial Services Inc., (“AFS/IBEX”), an insurance premium financing company.  The transaction has diversified the Company’s business and further expands its commercial loan portfolio and growth prospects. In addition, on September 8, 2015, the Bank purchased substantially all of the assets and related liabilities of Fort Knox Financial Services Corporation and its subsidiary, Tax Product Services, LLC (together “Refund Advantage”).  The assets acquired by MetaBank in the acquisition include the Fort Knox operating platform and trade name, Refund Advantage®, and other assets.  More recently, on October 26, 2016, MetaBank entered into an agreement with certain H&R Block® entities to originate up to $1.45 billion and retain up to $750 million of interest-free refund advance loans for H&R Block customers during the 2017 tax season. On November 1, 2016, the Bank purchased substantially all of the assets and certain liabilities of EPS Financial, LLC ("EPS") from privately held Drake Enterprises, Ltd. ("Drake"). The assets acquired by MetaBank in the EPS acquisition include the EPS trade name, operating platform, and other assets. Also, on November 9, 2016, the Bank signed a definitive agreement to purchase substantially all of the assets and specified liabilities of privately-held Specialty Consumer Services LP ("SCS") relating to its consumer lending and tax advance business. These transactions expand the Company’s business into tax refund-transfer services for its customers.
 
  As noted in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, MPS continues to expand and to play a very significant role in the Company’s financial performance.

The Company completed the public offering of $75 million of 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures during fiscal year 2016. These notes are due August 15, 2026. The subordinated debentures were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds of approximately $73.9 million, a substantial portion of which was invested in the Bank as Tier 1 capital.

3



First Midwest Financial Capital Trust, also a wholly-owned subsidiary of Meta Financial, was established in July 2001 for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities.
 
Meta Financial and the Bank are subject to comprehensive regulation and supervision.  See “Regulation” herein.
 
The principal executive office of the Company is located at 5501 South Broadband Lane, Sioux Falls, South Dakota 57108.  Its telephone number at that address is (605) 782-1767.
 
Market Areas
 
The Bank has four market areas:  Northwest Iowa (“NWI”), Brookings, South Dakota (“Brookings”), Central Iowa (“CI”), and Sioux Empire (“SE”) and four divisions: MPS, AFS/IBEX, Refund Advantage and EPS.  The Bank’s home office is located at 5501 South Broadband Lane, Sioux Falls, South Dakota.  NWI operates two offices in Storm Lake, Iowa. Brookings operates one office in Brookings, South Dakota.  CI operates a total of four offices in Iowa:  Des Moines (2), West Des Moines, and Urbandale.  SE operates three offices and one administrative office in Sioux Falls, South Dakota.  AFS/IBEX operates an office in Texas and one in California.  MPS, which offers prepaid cards, tax refund-transfer services, and other payment industry products and services nationwide, operates out of Sioux Falls, South Dakota, with offices in Louisville, Kentucky and Easton, Pennsylvania. Upon the expected closing of the SCS acquisition, operations will expand into Hurst, Texas. See “Meta Payment Systems® Division.”
 
The Bank has a total of ten full-service branch offices, one non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee, and two agency offices, one in Texas and one in California.
 
The Company’s primary commercial banking market area includes the Iowa counties of Buena Vista, Dallas, and Polk, and the South Dakota counties of Brookings, Lincoln, Minnehaha, and Moody.  South Dakota ranks 10th and Iowa 14th in “The Best States for Business and Careers” (Forbes.com, November 2016).  Iowa has low corporate income and franchise taxes.  South Dakota has no corporate income tax, personal income tax, personal property tax, business inventory tax, or inheritance tax.

Storm Lake is located in Iowa’s Buena Vista County approximately 150 miles northwest of Des Moines and 200 miles southwest of Minneapolis.  Like much of the state of Iowa, Storm Lake and the surrounding market area are highly dependent upon farming and agricultural markets.  Major employers in the area include Buena Vista Regional Medical Center, Tyson Foods, Sara Lee Foods, and Buena Vista University.  The NWI market operates two offices in Storm Lake.
 
Brookings is located in Brookings County, South Dakota, approximately 50 miles north of Sioux Falls and 200 miles west of Minneapolis.  The Bank’s market area encompasses approximately a 60-mile radius surrounding Brookings.  The area is generally rural, and agriculture is a significant industry in the community.  South Dakota State University is the largest employer in Brookings.  The community also has several manufacturing companies, including 3M, Larson Manufacturing, Daktronics, Falcon Plastics, Twin City Fan, and Rainbow Play Systems, Inc.
 
Des Moines, Iowa’s capital, is located in central Iowa and is the political, economic, and cultural capital of the state.  Des Moines was ranked sixth in “The Best Places for Business and Careers” (Forbes.com, 2016).  The Des Moines metro area is a center of insurance, printing, finance, retail and wholesale trades as well as industry, providing a diverse economic base.  Major employers include Principal Life Insurance Company, Iowa Health – Des Moines, Mercy Hospital Medical Center, Hy-Vee Food Stores, Inc., City of Des Moines, United Parcel Service, Nationwide Mutual Insurance Co., Pioneer Hi Bred International Inc., and Wells Fargo.  Universities and colleges in the area include Des Moines Area Community College, Drake University, Simpson College, Des Moines University, Grand View College, AIB College of Business, and Upper Iowa University.  The unemployment rate in the Des Moines metro area was 3.6% as of September 2016.
 
Sioux Falls is located at the crossroads of Interstates 29 and 90 in southeast South Dakota, 270 miles southwest of Minneapolis.  On Forbes’ October 2016 list of “The Best Small Places for Business and Careers,” Sioux Falls ranked second among the best small cities.  Major employers in the area include Sanford Health, Avera McKennan Hospital and Health System, John Morrell & Company, Citibank (South Dakota) NA, Sioux Falls School District 49-5, Wells Fargo Bank, and Hy-Vee Food Stores.  Sioux Falls is home to Augustana College and The University of Sioux Falls.  The unemployment rate in Sioux Falls was 2.0% as of September 2016.
 




4



As noted above, several of the Company’s market areas are dependent on agriculture and agriculture-related businesses, which are exposed to exogenous risk factors such as weather conditions and commodity prices.  Loss rates in the agricultural real estate and agricultural operating loan portfolios have been low in the previous two years, partially offset by the charge-off of one large agriculture relationship in the current fiscal year.  Low average loss rates are primarily due to strong crop yields over the last few years, offset by lower grain prices in 2015 and 2016.  Overall, these factors have created positive economic conditions for most farmers in our markets during this time period.  Nonetheless, management still expects that future losses in this portfolio could be higher than recent historical experience.  Management believes that the recent positive weather conditions within our markets have been offset by low commodity prices and high input costs, which have the potential to more than offset higher yields, producing a negative economic effect on our agricultural markets.
 
Lending Activities
 
General.  The Company originates both fixed-rate and adjustable-rate (“ARM”) residential mortgage loans in response to consumer demand.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had $850.8 million in fixed-rate loans and $75.1 million in ARM loans.  See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on Asset/Liability Management.

In addition, the Company has more recently focused its lending activities on the origination of commercial and multi-family real estate loans, agricultural-related loans, commercial operating loans, premium finance loans, and tax refund advance loans. The Company also continues to originate one-to-four family mortgage loans and traditional consumer loans. Other than tax refund advance loans, the Company originates most of its loans in its primary market area.  At September 30, 2016, the Company’s net loan portfolio totaled $919.5 million, or 22.9% of the Company’s total assets, as compared to $706.3 million, or 27.9%, at September 30, 2015. As noted above, the Bank recently signed an agreement to originate tax refund advance loans to customers of H&R Block.
 
Loan applications are initially considered and approved at various levels of authority, depending on the type and amount of the loan.  The Company has a loan committee consisting of senior lenders and Market Presidents, and is led by the Chief Lending Officer.  Loans in excess of certain amounts require approval by at least two members of the loan committee, a majority of the loan committee, or by the Company’s Board Loan Committee, which has responsibility for the overall supervision of the loan portfolio.  The Company may discontinue, adjust, or create new lending programs to respond to competitive factors.  The Company also created a Specialty Lending committee to oversee its insurance premium finance division and other specialized lending activities in which the Company may become involved.  The Committee consists of senior personnel with diverse backgrounds well suited for oversight of these types of activities.  Insurance premium finance loans in excess of certain amounts require approval from one or more members of the Committee.
 
At September 30, 2016, the Company’s largest lending relationship to a single borrower or group of related borrowers totaled $32.5 million.  The Company had 24 other lending relationships in excess of $7.5 million as of September 30, 2016.  At September 30, 2016, two of these relationships had loans totaling $27.8 million and $8.2 million, respectively, and were classified as either substandard or special mention.  See “Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern, and Classified Assets.”
 
Loan Portfolio Composition.  The following table provides information about the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio in dollar amounts and in percentages as of the dates indicated.  In general, for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, the amounts in all categories of loans discussed below, except agriculture real estate and agriculture operating loans, increased over levels from the prior fiscal year.

5


 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Real Estate Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family
$
162,298

 
17.5
%
 
$
125,021

 
17.5
%
 
$
116,395

 
23.3
%
 
$
82,287

 
21.4
%
 
$
49,134

 
14.9
%
Commercial & Multi-Family
422,932

 
45.7
%
 
310,199

 
43.5
%
 
224,302

 
44.9
%
 
192,786

 
50.1
%
 
191,905

 
57.9
%
Agricultural
63,612

 
6.9
%
 
64,316

 
9.0
%
 
56,071

 
11.3
%
 
29,552

 
7.7
%
 
19,861

 
6.0
%
Total Real Estate Loans
648,842

 
70.1
%
 
499,536

 
70.0
%
 
396,768

 
79.5
%
 
304,625

 
79.2
%
 
260,900

 
78.8
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Loans:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Consumer Loans:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Home Equity
20,883

 
2.2
%
 
18,463

 
2.6
%
 
15,116

 
3.0
%
 
13,799

 
3.6
%
 
13,299

 
4.0
%
Automobile
730

 
0.1
%
 
573

 
0.1
%
 
671

 
0.1
%
 
658

 
0.1
%
 
792

 
0.2
%
Other (1)
15,481

 
1.7
%
 
14,491

 
2.0
%
 
13,542

 
2.7
%
 
15,857

 
4.1
%
 
18,747

 
5.7
%
Total Consumer Loans
37,094

 
4.0
%
 
33,527

 
4.7
%
 
29,329

 
5.8
%
 
30,314

 
7.8
%
 
32,838

 
9.9
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Agricultural Operating
37,083

 
4.0
%
 
43,626

 
6.1
%
 
42,258

 
8.5
%
 
33,750

 
8.8
%
 
20,981

 
6.3
%
Commercial Operating
31,271

 
3.4
%
 
29,893

 
4.2
%
 
30,846

 
6.2
%
 
16,264

 
4.2
%
 
16,452

 
5.0
%
Premium Finance
171,604

 
18.5
%
 
106,505

 
15.0
%
 

 
%
 

 
%
 

 
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Other Loans
277,052

 
29.9
%
 
213,551

 
30.0
%
 
102,433

 
20.5
%
 
80,328

 
20.8
%
 
70,271

 
21.2
%
Total Loans
$
925,894

 
100.0
%
 
$
713,087

 
100.0
%
 
$
499,201

 
100.0
%
 
$
384,953

 
100.0
%
 
$
331,171

 
100.0
%

(1) 
Consist generally of various types of secured and unsecured consumer loans.


6


The following table shows the composition of the Company’s loan portfolio by fixed and adjustable rate at the dates indicated.
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
Amount
 
Percent
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fixed Rate Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family
$
152,232

 
16.5
%
 
$
116,171

 
16.3
%
 
$
105,870

 
21.2
%
 
$
75,477

 
19.6
%
 
$
44,045

 
13.3
%
Commercial & Multi-Family
404,888

 
43.7
%
 
284,586

 
39.9
%
 
203,840

 
40.8
%
 
173,373

 
45.1
%
 
162,552

 
49.1
%
Agricultural
59,455

 
6.4
%
 
59,219

 
8.3
%
 
49,643

 
10.0
%
 
22,433

 
5.8
%
 
15,399

 
4.6
%
Total Fixed-Rate Real Estate Loans
616,575

 
66.6
%
 
459,976

 
64.5
%
 
359,353

 
72.0
%
 
271,283

 
70.5
%
 
221,996

 
67.0
%
Consumer
23,024

 
2.5
%
 
20,842

 
2.9
%
 
19,279

 
3.9
%
 
20,129

 
5.2
%
 
20,322

 
6.1
%
Agricultural Operating
27,196

 
2.9
%
 
35,802

 
5.0
%
 
24,991

 
5.0
%
 
23,137

 
6.0
%
 
10,627

 
3.2
%
Commercial Operating
12,393

 
1.4
%
 
15,520

 
2.2
%
 
13,659

 
2.7
%
 
8,070

 
2.1
%
 
6,818

 
2.1
%
Premium Finance
171,604

 
18.5
%
 
106,505

 
15.0
%
 

 
%
 

 
%
 

 
%
Total Fixed-Rate Loans
850,792

 
91.9
%
 
638,645

 
89.6
%
 
417,282

 
83.6
%
 
322,619

 
83.8
%
 
259,763

 
78.4
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Adjustable Rate Loans:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Real Estate:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family
10,066

 
1.1
%
 
8,850

 
1.2
%
 
10,525

 
2.1
%
 
6,810

 
1.8
%
 
5,089

 
1.5
%
Commercial & Multi-Family
18,044

 
1.9
%
 
25,613

 
3.6
%
 
20,461

 
4.1
%
 
19,413

 
5.0
%
 
29,353

 
8.9
%
Agricultural
4,157

 
0.5
%
 
5,097

 
0.7
%
 
6,429

 
1.3
%
 
7,119

 
1.9
%
 
4,462

 
1.4
%
Total Adjustable Real Estate Loans
32,267

 
3.5
%
 
39,560

 
5.5
%
 
37,415

 
7.5
%
 
33,342

 
8.7
%
 
38,904

 
11.8
%
Consumer
14,070

 
1.5
%
 
12,685

 
1.8
%
 
10,050

 
2.0
%
 
10,185

 
2.6
%
 
12,516

 
3.8
%
Agricultural Operating
9,887

 
1.1
%
 
7,824

 
1.1
%
 
17,267

 
3.5
%
 
10,613

 
2.8
%
 
10,354

 
3.1
%
Commercial Operating
18,878

 
2.0
%
 
14,373

 
2.0
%
 
17,187

 
3.4
%
 
8,194

 
2.1
%
 
9,634

 
2.9
%
Total Adjustable Loans
75,102

 
8.1
%
 
74,442

 
10.4
%
 
81,919

 
16.4
%
 
62,334

 
16.2
%
 
71,408

 
21.6
%
Total Loans
925,894

 
100.0
%
 
713,087

 
100.0
%
 
499,201

 
100.0
%
 
384,953

 
100.0
%
 
331,171

 
100.0
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Less:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Deferred Fees and Discounts
789

 
 

 
577

 
 

 
797

 
 

 
595

 
 

 
219

 
 

Allowance for Loan Losses
5,635

 
 

 
6,255

 
 

 
5,397

 
 

 
3,930

 
 

 
3,971

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Loans Receivable, Net
$
919,470

 
 

 
$
706,255

 
 

 
$
493,007

 
 

 
$
380,428

 
 

 
$
326,981

 
 


7


 
The following table illustrates the maturity analysis of the Company’s loan portfolio at September 30, 2016.  Mortgages that have adjustable or renegotiable interest rates are shown as maturing in the period during which the contract reprices.  The table reflects management’s estimate of the effects of loan prepayments or curtailments based on data from the Company’s historical experiences and other third-party sources.
 
 
Real Estate (1)
 
Consumer
 
Commercial Operating
 
Agricultural Operating
 
Premium Finance
 
Total
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
Amount
 
Weighted
Average
Rate
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less (2)
$
206,315

 
4.24
%
 
$
13,384

 
3.09
%
 
$
15,421

 
3.96
%
 
$
24,704

 
4.43
%
 
$
171,369

 
6.02
%
 
$
431,193

 
4.92
%
Due after one year through five years
364,545

 
4.24
%
 
22,200

 
2.90
%
 
14,040

 
3.76
%
 
11,406

 
4.63
%
 
235

 
4.67
%
 
412,426

 
4.16
%
Due after five years
77,982

 
4.04
%
 
1,510

 
5.21
%
 
1,810

 
3.41
%
 
973

 
5.13
%
 

 
%
 
82,275

 
4.06
%
Total
$
648,842

 
 

 
$
37,094

 
 

 
$
31,271

 
 

 
$
37,083

 
 

 
$
171,604

 
 

 
$
925,894

 
 


(1) 
Includes one-to-four family, multi-family, commercial and agricultural real estate loans.
(2) 
Includes demand loans, loans having no stated maturity and overdraft loans.


8


One-to-Four Family Residential Mortgage Lending.  One-to-four family residential mortgage loan originations, which are made primarily in the Company's market areas, are generated by the Company’s marketing efforts, its present customers, walk-in customers and referrals.  At September 30, 2016, the Company’s one-to-four family residential mortgage loan portfolio totaled $162.3 million, or 17.5% of the Company’s total loans.  See “Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans and Mortgage-Backed Securities.”  At September 30, 2016, the average outstanding principal balance of a one-to-four family residential mortgage loan was approximately $0.1 million.  At September 30, 2016, $0.1 million of the Company’s one-to-four family residential mortgage loans were non-performing.

The Company offers fixed-rate and ARM loans for both permanent structures and those under construction.  During the year ended September 30, 2016, the Company originated $15.3 million of ARM loans and $81.2 million of fixed-rate loans secured by one-to-four family residential real estate.  The Company’s one-to-four family residential mortgage originations are secured primarily by properties located in its primary market area and surrounding areas.
 
The Company originates one-to-four family residential mortgage loans with terms up to a maximum of 30 years and with loan-to-value ratios up to 100% of the lesser of the appraised value of the security property or the contract price.  The Company generally requires that private mortgage insurance be obtained in an amount sufficient to reduce the Company’s exposure to at or below the 80% loan‑to‑value level.  Residential loans generally do not include prepayment penalties.
 
The Company currently offers five- and ten-year ARM loans.  These loans have a fixed-rate for the stated period and, thereafter, adjust annually.  These loans generally provide for an annual cap of up to 200 basis points and a lifetime cap of 600 basis points over the initial rate.  As a consequence of using an initial fixed-rate and caps, the interest rates on these loans may not be as rate sensitive as the Company’s cost of funds.  The Company’s ARMs do not permit negative amortization of principal and are not convertible into fixed-rate loans.  The Company’s delinquency experience on its ARM loans has generally been similar to its experience on fixed-rate residential loans.  The current low mortgage interest rate environment makes ARM loans relatively unattractive and very few are currently being originated.
 
Due to consumer demand, the Company also offers fixed-rate mortgage loans with terms up to 30 years, most of which conform to secondary market, i.e., Fannie Mae, Ginnie Mae, and Freddie Mac standards.  The Company typically holds all fixed-rate mortgage loans and does not engage in secondary market sales.  Interest rates charged on these fixed-rate loans are competitively priced according to market conditions.
 
In underwriting one-to-four family residential real estate loans, the Company evaluates both the borrower’s ability to make monthly payments and the value of the property securing the loan.  Properties securing real estate loans made by the Company are appraised by independent appraisers approved by the Board of Directors.  The Company generally requires borrowers to obtain an attorney’s title opinion or title insurance, and fire and property insurance (including flood insurance, if necessary) in an amount not less than the amount of the loan.  Real estate loans originated by the Company generally contain a “due on sale” clause allowing the Company to declare the unpaid principal balance due and payable upon the sale of the security property.  The Company has not engaged in sub-prime residential mortgage originations.
 
Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate Lending.  The Company engages in commercial and multi-family real estate lending in its primary market area and surrounding areas and, in order to supplement its loan portfolio, has purchased participation interests in loans from other financial institutions.  At September 30, 2016, the Company’s commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio totaled $422.9 million, or 45.7%, of the Company’s total loans.  The purchased loans and loan participation interests are generally secured by properties located in the Midwest and West.  See “Originations, Purchases, Sales and Servicing of Loans and Mortgage-Backed Securities.”  At September 30, 2016, there were no commercial and multi‑family real estate loans that were non-performing.  See “Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern and Classified Assets.”

The Company’s commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio is secured primarily by apartment buildings, office buildings, and hotels.  Commercial and multi-family real estate loans generally are underwritten with terms not exceeding 20 years, have loan-to-value ratios of up to 80% of the appraised value of the security property, and are typically secured by personal guarantees of the borrowers.  The Company has a variety of rate adjustment features and other terms in its commercial and multi-family real estate loan portfolio.  Commercial and multi-family real estate loans provide for a margin over a number of different indices.  In underwriting these loans, the Company analyzes the financial condition of the borrower, the borrower’s credit history, and the reliability and predictability of the cash flow generated by the property securing the loan.  Appraisals on properties securing commercial real estate loans originated by the Company are performed by independent appraisers.
 
At September 30, 2016, the Company’s largest commercial and multi-family real estate lending relationship totaled $32.5 million and was secured by real estate.  At September 30, 2016, the average outstanding principal balance of a commercial or multi-family real estate loan held by the Company was approximately $1.4 million.

9


 
Commercial and multi-family real estate loans generally present a higher level of risk than loans secured by one-to-four family residences.  This greater risk is due to several factors, including the concentration of principal in a limited number of loans and borrowers, the effect of general economic conditions on income producing properties and the increased difficulty of evaluating and monitoring these types of loans.  Furthermore, the repayment of loans secured by commercial and multi-family real estate is typically dependent upon the successful operation of the related real estate project.  If the cash flow from the project is reduced (for example, if leases are not obtained or renewed, or a bankruptcy court modifies a lease term, or a major tenant is unable to fulfill its lease obligations), the borrower’s ability to repay the loan may be impaired.
 
Agricultural Lending.  The Company originates loans to finance the purchase of farmland, livestock, farm machinery and equipment, seed, fertilizer and other farm-related products, primarily in its market areas.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had agricultural real estate loans secured by farmland of $63.6 million or 6.9% of the Company’s total loans.  At the same date, $37.1 million, or 4.0%, of the Company’s total loans consisted of secured loans related to agricultural operations.  Agricultural-related lending constituted 10.9% of total loans.
 
At September 30, 2016, the Company’s largest agricultural real estate and agricultural operating loan relationship was $27.8 million.  At September 30, 2016, the average outstanding principal balance of an agricultural real estate loan and agricultural operating loan held by the Company was approximately $0.7 million and $0.2 million, respectively.
 
Agricultural operating loans are originated at either an adjustable or fixed-rate of interest for up to a one-year term or, in the case of livestock, upon sale.  Such loans provide for payments of principal and interest at least annually or a lump sum payment upon maturity if the original term is less than one year. Loans secured by agricultural machinery are generally originated as fixed-rate loans with terms of up to seven years. At September 30, 2016, there were no agricultural operating loans that were non-performing.
 
Agricultural real estate loans are frequently originated with adjustable rates of interest.  Generally, such loans provide for a fixed rate of interest for the first five to ten years, which then balloon or adjust annually thereafter.  In addition, such loans generally amortize over a period of 20 to 25 years.  Fixed-rate agricultural real estate loans generally have terms up to ten years.  Agricultural real estate loans are generally limited to 75% of the value of the property securing the loan.  At September 30, 2016, none of the Company’s agricultural real estate loans were non-performing.

Agricultural lending affords the Company the opportunity to earn yields higher than those obtainable on one-to-four family residential lending, but involves a greater degree of risk than one-to-four family residential mortgage loans because of the typically larger loan amount.  In addition, payments on loans are dependent on the successful operation or management of the farm property securing the loan or for which an operating loan is utilized.  The success of the loan may also be affected by many factors outside the control of the borrower.
 
Weather presents one of the greatest risks as hail, drought, floods, or other conditions can severely limit crop yields and thus impair loan repayments and the value of the underlying collateral.  This risk can be reduced by the farmer with a variety of insurance coverages which can help to ensure loan repayment.  Government support programs and the Company generally require that farmers procure crop insurance coverage.  Grain and livestock prices also present a risk as prices may decline prior to sale, resulting in a failure to cover production costs.  These risks may be reduced by the farmer with the use of futures contracts or options to mitigate price risk.  The Company frequently requires borrowers to use futures contracts or options to reduce price risk and help ensure loan repayment.  Another risk is the uncertainty of government programs and other regulations.  During periods of low commodity prices, the income from government programs can be a significant source of cash for the borrower to make loan payments, and if these programs are discontinued or significantly changed, cash flow problems or defaults could result.  Finally, many farms are dependent on a limited number of key individuals whose injury or death may result in an inability to successfully operate the farm.
 
Consumer Lending.  The Company, through the auspices of its “Retail Bank” (generally referring to the Company’s operations in our four market areas discussed above), originates a variety of secured consumer loans, including home equity, home improvement, automobile, boat and loans secured by savings deposits.  In addition, the Retail Bank offers other secured and unsecured consumer loans.  The Retail Bank currently originates most of its consumer loans in its primary market area and surrounding areas.  At September 30, 2016, the Retail Bank’s consumer loan portfolio totaled $22.8 million, or 2.5% of its total loans.  Of the Retail Bank consumer loan portfolio at September 30, 2016, $8.7 million were short- and intermediate-term, fixed-rate loans, while $14.1 million were adjustable-rate loans.
 

10


The largest component of the Retail Bank’s consumer loan portfolio consists of home equity loans and lines of credit.  Substantially all of the Retail Bank’s home equity loans and lines of credit are secured by second mortgages on principal residences.  The Retail Bank will lend amounts which, together with all prior liens, may be up to 90% of the appraised value of the property securing the loan.  Home equity loans and lines of credit generally have maximum terms of five years.
 
The Retail Bank primarily originates automobile loans on a direct basis to the borrower, as opposed to indirect loans, which are made when the Retail Bank purchases loan contracts, often at a discount, from automobile dealers which have extended credit to their customers.  The Bank’s automobile loans typically are originated at fixed interest rates with terms up to 60 months for new and used vehicles.  Loans secured by automobiles are generally originated for up to 80% of the N.A.D.A. book value of the automobile securing the loan.
 
Consumer loan terms vary according to the type and value of collateral, length of contract and creditworthiness of the borrower.  The underwriting standards employed by the Bank for consumer loans include an application, a determination of the applicant’s payment history on other debts and an assessment of ability to meet existing obligations and payments on the proposed loan.  Although creditworthiness of the applicant is a primary consideration, the underwriting process also may include a comparison of the value of the security, if any, in relation to the proposed loan amount.

Consumer loans may entail greater credit risk than residential mortgage loans, particularly in the case of consumer loans which are unsecured or are secured by rapidly depreciable assets, such as automobiles or recreational equipment.  In such cases, any repossessed collateral for a defaulted consumer loan may not provide an adequate source of repayment of the outstanding loan balance as a result of the greater likelihood of damage, loss or depreciation.  In addition, consumer loan collections are dependent on the borrower’s continuing financial stability, and thus more likely to be affected by adverse personal circumstances.  Furthermore, the application of various federal and state laws, including bankruptcy and insolvency laws, may limit the amount which can be recovered on such loans.  At September 30, 2016, $0.1 million of the Bank’s consumer loans were non-performing.
 
Consumer Lending - MPS.  The Company believes that well-managed, nationwide credit programs can help meet legitimate credit needs for prime and sub-prime borrowers, and affords the Company an opportunity to diversify the loan portfolio and minimize earnings exposure due to economic downturns.  Therefore, MPS designs and administers certain credit programs that seek to accomplish these objectives.  The MPS Credit Committee, consisting of members of Executive Management of the Company, is charged with monitoring, evaluating and reporting portfolio performance and the overall credit risk posed by its credit products. All proposed credit programs must first be reviewed and approved by the committee before such programs are presented to the Bank’s Board of Directors for approval.
 
At September 30, 2016, the Bank’s MPS consumer loan portfolio totaled $14.3 million, or 1.5% of total loans, all of which were short-term, fixed rate loans.
 
MPS strives to offer consumers innovative payment products, including credit products.  Most credit products have fallen into the category of portfolio lending.  MPS continues to work on new alternative portfolio lending products striving to serve its core customer base and to provide unique and innovative lending solutions to the unbanked and under-banked segment.
 
A Portfolio Credit Policy which has been approved by the Board of Directors governs portfolio credit initiatives undertaken by MPS, whereby the Company retains some or all receivables and relies on the borrower as the underlying source of repayment.  Several portfolio lending programs also have a contractual provision that requires the Bank to be indemnified for credit losses that meet or exceed predetermined levels.  Such a program carries additional risks not commonly found in sponsorship programs, specifically funding and credit risk.  Therefore, MPS has strived to employ policies, procedures and information systems that it believes commensurate with the added risk and exposure.
 
The Company recognizes concentrations of credit may naturally occur and may take the form of a large volume of related loans to an individual, a specific industry, a geographic location or an occupation.  Credit concentration is a direct, indirect or contingent obligation that has a common bond where the aggregate exposure equals or exceeds a certain percentage of the Bank’s Tier 1 Capital plus the Allowance for Loan Losses.  The MPS Credit Committee monitors and identifies the credit concentrations in accordance with the Bank’s concentration policy and evaluates the specific nature of each concentration to determine the potential risk to the Bank.  An evaluation includes the following:
 
A recommendation regarding additional controls needed to mitigate the concentration exposure.
A limitation or cap placed on the size of the concentration.
The potential necessity for increased capital and/or credit reserves to cover the increased risk caused by the concentration(s).
A strategy to reduce to acceptable levels those concentration(s) that are determined to create undue risk to the Bank.    


11


No MPS credit products were non-performing as of September 30, 2016.
    
Through its Refund Advantage division, MetaBank also provides short-term consumer refund advance loans. Taxpayers are underwritten to determine eligibility for the advances and the advances are unsecured. These consumer loans are interest-and fee free. Due to the nature of consumer advance loans, it typically takes no more than three e-file cycles to collect. In the event of default, MetaBank has no recourse with the tax consumer. Generally, when the refund advance loan becomes delinquent for 90 days or more, or when collection of principal becomes doubtful, the Company will charge off the loan balance. There were no taxpayer advances outstanding as of September 30, 2016; the Company expects this portfolio to expand significantly following its agreement with H&R Block to offer such loans during the 2017 tax season.
 
Commercial Operating Lending.  The Company also originates commercial operating loans primarily in its market areas.  Most of the Company’s commercial operating loans have been extended to finance local and regional businesses and include short-term loans to finance machinery and equipment purchases, inventory and accounts receivable.  Commercial loans also may involve the extension of revolving credit for a combination of equipment acquisitions and working capital in expanding companies.  At September 30, 2016, $31.3 million, or 3.4% of the Company’s total loans, were comprised of commercial operating loans.
 
The maximum term for loans extended on machinery and equipment is based on the projected useful life of such machinery and equipment.  Generally, the maximum term on non-mortgage lines of credit is one year.  The loan-to-value ratio on such loans and lines of credit generally may not exceed 80% of the value of the collateral securing the loan.  The Company’s commercial operating lending policy includes credit file documentation and analysis of the borrower’s character, capacity to repay the loan, the adequacy of the borrower’s capital and collateral as well as an evaluation of conditions affecting the borrower.  Analysis of the borrower’s past, present and future cash flows is also an important aspect of the Company’s current credit analysis.  Nonetheless, such loans are believed to carry higher credit risk than more traditional lending activities.
 
 At September 30, 2016, the average outstanding principal balance of a commercial operating loan held by the Company was approximately $0.1 million.
 
Unlike residential mortgage loans, which generally are made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from his or her employment and other income and which are secured by real property whose value tends to be more easily ascertainable, commercial operating loans typically are made on the basis of the borrower’s ability to make repayment from the cash flow of the borrower’s business.  As a result, the availability of funds for the repayment of commercial operating loans may be substantially dependent on the success of the business itself (which, in turn, is likely to be dependent upon the general economic environment).  The Company’s commercial operating loans are usually, but not always, secured by business assets and personal guarantees.  However, the collateral securing the loans may depreciate over time, may be difficult to appraise and may fluctuate in value based on the success of the business.  At September 30, 2016, none of the Company’s commercial operating loans were non-performing.

Through its Refund Advantage division, MetaBank also provides short-term Electronic Return Originator ("EROs") advance loans on a nation-wide basis. These loans are typically utilized to purchase tax preparation software and to prepare tax offices for the upcoming season. EROs go through an underwriting process to determine eligibility for the advances and the advances are unsecured.  Due to the nature of ERO advance loans, it typically takes no more than three e-file cycles to begin collection. Generally, when the ERO advance loan becomes delinquent for 90 days or more, or when collection of principal becomes doubtful, the Company will charge off the loan balance. There were no ERO advances outstanding as of September 30, 2016.

Premium Finance Lending.  Through its AFS/IBEX division, MetaBank provides short-term, primarily collateralized financing to facilitate the commercial customers’ purchase of insurance for various forms of risk otherwise known as insurance premium financing primarily in California, Texas and Florida.  This includes, but is not limited to, policies for commercial property, casualty and liability risk.  The AFS/IBEX division markets itself to the insurance community as a competitive option based on service, its reputation, competitive terms, cost and ease of operation.  At September 30, 2016, $171.6 million, or 18.5% of the Company’s total loans, were comprised of premium finance loans.
 
Insurance premium financing is the business of extending credit to a policyholder to pay for insurance premiums when the insurance carrier requires payment in full at inception of coverage.  Premiums are advanced either directly to the insurance carrier or through an intermediary/broker and repaid by the policyholder with interest during the policy term.  The policyholder generally makes a 20% to 25% down payment to the insurance broker and finances the remainder over nine to ten months on average.  The down payment is set such that if the policy is canceled, the unearned premium is typically sufficient to cover the loan balance and accrued interest.


12


The largest premium finance exposure outstanding at September 30, 2016, was a $3.7 million loan relationship secured by the related insurance policy of the borrower.  At September 30, 2016, the average outstanding principal balance of a premium finance loan held by the Company was approximately $7,900.
 
Due to the nature of collateral for commercial premium finance receivables, it customarily takes 60-210 days to convert the collateral into cash.  In the event of default, AFS/IBEX, by statute and contract, has the power to cancel the insurance policy and establish a first position lien on the unearned portion of the premium from the insurance carrier. In the event of cancellation, the cash returned in payment of the unearned premium by the insurer should typically be sufficient to cover the receivable balance, the interest and other charges due. Due to notification requirements and processing time by most insurance carriers, many receivables will become delinquent beyond 90 days while the insurer is processing the return of the unearned premium.  Generally, when a premium finance loan becomes delinquent for 210 days or more, or when collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will charge off the loan balance and any remaining interest and fees after applying any collection from the insurance company.  At September 30, 2016, $1.0 million of the Company’s premium finance loans were non-performing.


Originations, Sales and Servicing of Loans
 
At the Retail Bank, loans are generally originated by the Company’s staff of loan officers.  Loan applications are taken and processed in the branches and the main office of the Company.  While the Company originates both adjustable-rate and fixed-rate loans, its ability to originate loans is dependent upon the relative customer demand for loans in its market.  Demand is affected by the interest rate and economic environment.
 
The Company, from time to time, sells loan participations, generally without recourse.  At September 30, 2016, there were no loans outstanding sold with recourse.  When loans are sold, the Company may retain the responsibility for collecting and remitting loan payments, making certain that real estate tax payments are made on behalf of borrowers, and otherwise servicing the loans.  The servicing fee is recognized as income over the life of the loans.  The Company services loans that it originated and sold totaling $19.4 million at September 30, 2016, of which $4.0 million were sold to Fannie Mae and $15.4 million were sold to others.

On October 26, 2016, MetaBank entered into an agreement with certain H&R Block entities to originate up to $1.45 billion and retain up to $750 million of interest-free refund advance loans for H&R Block tax preparation customers during the 2017 tax season.
 
In periods of economic uncertainty, the Company’s ability to originate large dollar volumes of loans may be substantially reduced or restricted, with a resultant decrease in related loan origination fees, other fee income and operating earnings.  In addition, the Company’s ability to sell loans may substantially decrease if potential buyers (principally government agencies) reduce their purchasing activities.


13


The following table shows the loan originations (including draws, loan renewals, and undisbursed portions of loans in process), purchases, and sales and repayment activities of the Company for the periods indicated.
 
 
Years Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Originations by Type:
(Dollars in Thousands)
Adjustable Rate:
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
15,276

 
$
15,360

 
$
12,412

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
2,460

 
5,575

 
9,704

Agricultural Real Estate

 

 
1,130

Consumer
13

 
13

 
6

Commercial Operating
35,433

 
20,219

 
38,448

Agricultural Operating
21,954

 
12,347

 
23,492

Total Adjustable Rate
75,136

 
53,514

 
85,192

 
 
 
 
 
 
Fixed Rate:
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate
81,218

 
48,576

 
53,251

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
154,478

 
109,173

 
94,868

Agricultural Real Estate
4,216

 
12,877

 
35,713

Consumer
222,391

 
204,258

 
157,776

Commercial Operating
42,775

 
15,533

 
13,985

Agricultural Operating
30,889

 
20,646

 
31,628

Premium Finance
357,252

 
208,183

 

Total Fixed-Rate
893,219

 
619,246

 
387,221

Total Loans Originated
968,355

 
672,760

 
472,413

 
 
 
 
 
 
Purchases:
 

 
 

 
 

Agricultural Operating

 

 
343

Premium Finance

 
74,120

 

Total Loans Purchased

 
74,120

 
343

 
 
 
 
 
 
Sales and Repayments:
 

 
 

 
 

Sales:
 

 
 

 
 

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate

 
4,843

 
11,665

Agricultural Real Estate

 
520

 

Consumer
17,611

 
11,650

 
12,144

Agricultural Operating
83

 
99

 
82

Total Loan Sales
17,694

 
17,112

 
23,891

 
 
 
 
 
 
Repayments:
 

 
 

 
 

Loan Principal Repayments
737,853

 
515,883

 
334,616

Total Principal Repayments
737,853

 
515,883

 
334,616

Total Reductions
755,547

 
532,995

 
358,507

 
 
 
 
 
 
Increase (decrease) in Other Items, Net
408

 
(637
)
 
(1,670
)
Net Increase
$
213,216

 
$
213,248

 
$
112,579



14


At September 30, 2016, approximately $6.4 million, or 0.7%, of the Company’s loan portfolio consisted of purchased loans.  The Company believes that purchasing loans outside of its market area assists the Company in diversifying its portfolio and may lessen the adverse effects on the Company’s business or operations which could result in the event of a downturn or weakening of the local economy in which the Company conducts its primary operations.  However, additional risks are associated with purchasing loans outside of the Company’s market area, including the lack of knowledge of the local market and difficulty in monitoring and inspecting the property securing the loans.

At September 30, 2016, the Company’s purchased loans were secured by properties located, as a percentage of total loans, as follows:  less than 1% combined in Oregon, North Dakota, North Carolina, and Connecticut. No loans were purchased in fiscal 2016.
 
Non-Performing Assets, Other Loans of Concern and Classified Assets
 
When a borrower fails to make a required payment on real estate secured loans and consumer loans within 16 days after the payment is due, the Company generally initiates collection procedures by mailing a delinquency notice.  The customer is contacted again, by written notice or telephone, before the payment is 30 days past due and again before 60 days past due.  Generally, delinquencies are cured promptly; however, if a loan has been delinquent for more than 90 days, satisfactory payment arrangements must be adhered to or the Company will initiate foreclosure or repossession.
 
The following table sets forth the Company’s loan delinquencies by type, by amount and by percentage of type at September 30, 2016.
 
 
Loans Delinquent For:
 
30-59 Days
 
60-89 Days
 
90 Days and Over
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Percent
of
Category
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Percent
of
Category
 
Number
 
Amount
 
Percent
of
Category
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Real Estate:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family

 
$

 
%
 
1

 
$
30

 
4.6
%
 
1

 
$
83

 
7.5
%
Consumer

 

 
%
 

 

 
%
 
1

 
53

 
4.8
%
Commercial Operating
1

 
151

 
9.7
%
 
1

 
354

 
53.7
%
 

 

 
%
Premium Finance
285

 
1,398

 
90.3
%
 
264

 
275

 
41.7
%
 
977

 
965

 
87.7
%
Total
286

 
$
1,549

 
100.0
%
 
266

 
$
659

 
100.0
%
 
979

 
$
1,101

 
100.0
%

Delinquencies 90 days and over constituted 0.1% of total loans and 0.03% of total assets.
 
Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent, 210 days or more for Premium Finance, or 90 days or more for all other loan categories, or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is charged against current income.  The loan will remain on a non-accrual status until six months of good payment history.

15


The table below sets forth the amounts and categories of the Company’s non-performing assets.
 
 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
Non-Performing Loans
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Accruing Loans:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
83

 
$
24

 
$
281

 
$
245

 
$
307

Commercial & Multi-Family Real Estate

 
904

 
312

 
427

 
1,423

Agricultural Operating

 
5,132

 
340

 

 

Commercial Operating

 

 

 
7

 
18

Total
83

 
6,060

 
933

 
679

 
1,748

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Accruing Loans Delinquent 90 Days or More:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Consumer
53

 
13

 
54

 
13

 
63

Premium Finance
965

 
1,728

 

 

 

Total
1,018

 
1,741

 
54

 
13

 
63

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Non-Performing Loans
1,101

 
7,801

 
987

 
692

 
1,811

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Assets
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Foreclosed Assets:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate
76

 

 

 

 
9

Commercial & Multi-Family Real Estate

 

 
15

 
116

 
827

Commercial Operating

 

 

 

 
2

Total
76

 

 
15

 
116

 
838

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Other Assets
76

 

 
15

 
116

 
838

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Non-Performing Assets
$
1,177

 
$
7,801

 
$
1,002

 
$
808

 
$
2,649

Total as a Percentage of Total Assets
0.03
%
 
0.31
%
 
0.05
%
 
0.05
%
 
0.16
%

For the year ended September 30, 2016, gross interest income that would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to approximately $2,000, of which none was included in interest income.
 
Non-Accruing Loans.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had $0.1 million in non-accruing loans, which constituted less than 0.1% of the Company's gross loan portfolio and total assets. At September 30, 2015, the Company had $6.1 million in non-accruing loans which constituted 0.8% of its gross loan portfolio, or 0.2% of total assets.  The fiscal 2016 decrease in non-performing loans primarily relates to a decrease in non-accruing loans in the agricultural operating category of $5.1 million, primarily due to the partial charge-off of a large agricultural relationship that has no remaining loan balance.
 
Accruing Loans Delinquent 90 Days or More.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had $1.0 million in accruing premium finance loans delinquent 90 days or more.




16


Classified Assets.  Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans and other assets such as debt and equity securities considered by our primary regulator, the OCC, to be of lesser quality as “substandard,” “doubtful” or “loss.”  An asset is considered “substandard” if it is inadequately protected by the current net worth and paying capacity of the obligor or of the collateral pledged, if any.  “Substandard” assets include those characterized by the “distinct possibility” that the Bank will sustain “some loss” if the deficiencies are not corrected.  Assets classified as “doubtful” have all of the weaknesses inherent in those classified “substandard,” with the added characteristic that the weaknesses present make “collection or liquidation in full,” on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions and values, “highly questionable and improbable.”  Assets classified as “loss” are those considered “uncollectible” and of such minimal value that their continuance as assets without the establishment of a specific loss reserve is not warranted.
 
General allowances represent loss allowances which have been established to recognize the inherent risk associated with lending activities, but which, unlike specific allowances, have not been allocated to particular problem assets.  When assets are classified as “loss,” the Bank is required either to establish a specific allowance for losses equal to 100% of that portion of the asset so classified or to charge off such amount.  The Bank’s determinations as to the classification of its assets and the amount of its valuation allowances are subject to review by its regulatory authorities, which may order the establishment of additional general or specific loss allowances.
 
On the basis of management’s review of its classified assets, at September 30, 2016, the Company had classified loans of $9.0 million as substandard and none as doubtful or loss.  Further, at September 30, 2016, the Bank had $76,101 in real estate owned or other foreclosed assets.
 
Allowance for Loan Losses.  The allowance for loan losses is established through a provision for loan losses based on management’s evaluation of the risk inherent in its loan portfolio and changes in the nature and volume of its loan activity, including those loans which are being specifically monitored by management.  Such evaluation, which includes a review of loans for which full collectability may not be reasonably assured, considers, among other matters, the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral, economic conditions, historical loan loss experience and other factors that warrant recognition in providing for an appropriate loan loss allowance.
 
Management closely monitors economic developments both regionally and nationwide, and considers these factors when assessing the appropriateness of its allowance for loan losses.  The current economic environment continues to show signs of stability to improvement in the Bank’s markets.  The Bank’s average loss rates over the past three years were low, offset with a higher agricultural loss rate in the current fiscal year driven by the charge off of one relationship. The Bank does not believe it is likely these low loss conditions will continue indefinitely.  Management believes the low commodity prices and high land rents have the potential to negatively impact the economies of our agricultural markets.
 
The allowance for loan losses established by MPS results from an estimation process that evaluates relevant characteristics of its credit portfolio.  MPS also considers other internal and external environmental factors such as changes in operations or personnel and economic events that may affect the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses.  Adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are recorded periodically based on the result of this estimation process.

Management believes that, based on a detailed review of the loan portfolio, historic loan losses, current economic conditions, the size of the loan portfolio and other factors, the current level of the allowance for loan losses at September 30, 2016, reflects an appropriate allowance against probable losses from the loan portfolio.  Although the Company maintains its allowance for loan losses at a level it considers to be appropriate, investors and others are cautioned that there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods.  In addition, the Company’s determination of the allowance for loan losses is subject to review by the OCC, which can require the establishment of additional general or specific allowances.
 
Real estate properties acquired through foreclosure are recorded at fair value.  If fair value at the date of foreclosure is lower than the balance of the related loan, the difference will be charged to the allowance for loan losses at the time of transfer.  Valuations are periodically updated by management and, if the value declines, a specific provision for losses on such property is established by a charge to operations.
 







17


The following table sets forth an analysis of the Company’s allowance for loan losses. 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Balance at Beginning of Period
$
6,255

 
$
5,397

 
$
3,930

 
$
3,971

 
$
4,926

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Charge Offs:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate
(32
)
 
(45
)
 

 
(25
)
 
(3
)
Commercial & Multi-Family Real Estate
(385
)
 
(214
)
 

 
(194
)
 
(2,094
)
Consumer
(728
)
 

 

 
(1
)
 
(6
)
Commercial Operating
(249
)
 

 

 

 

Agricultural Operating
(3,252
)
 
(186
)
 
(50
)
 

 

Premium Finance
(726
)
 
(285
)
 

 

 

Total Charge Offs
(5,372
)
 
(730
)
 
(50
)
 
(220
)
 
(2,103
)
Recoveries:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate

 

 
2

 
2

 
1

Commercial & Multi-Family Real Estate
27

 
6

 
347

 
113

 
40

Consumer
11

 

 

 
1

 
4

Commercial Operating

 
3

 
18

 
63

 
4

Agricultural Operating
2

 

 

 

 
50

Premium Finance
107

 
114

 

 

 

Total Recoveries
147

 
123

 
367

 
179

 
99

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net (Charge Offs) Recoveries
(5,225
)
 
(607
)
 
317

 
(41
)
 
(2,004
)
Provision Charged to Expense
4,605

 
1,465

 
1,150

 

 
1,049

Balance at End of Period
$
5,635

 
$
6,255

 
$
5,397

 
$
3,930

 
$
3,971

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of Net Charge Offs During the Period to
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Average Loans Outstanding During the Period
0.64
%
 
0.10
%
 
(0.07
)%
 
0.01
%
 
0.61
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ratio of Net Charge Offs During the Period to
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Non-Performing Assets at Year End
443.84
%
 
7.78
%
 
(31.66
)%
 
5.07
%
 
75.65
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance to Total Loans
0.61
%
 
0.88
%
 
1.08
 %
 
1.02
%
 
1.20
%

For more information on the Provision for Loan Losses, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” which is included in Item 7 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 

18


The distribution of the Company’s allowance for losses on loans at the dates indicated is summarized as follows:
 
 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category
of Total
Loans
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category
of Total
Loans
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category
of Total
Loans
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category
of Total
Loans
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Loans in
Each
Category
of Total
Loans
 
 
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
654

 
17.5
%
 
$
278

 
17.5
%
 
$
552

 
23.3
%
 
$
333

 
21.4
%
 
$
193

 
14.8
%
Commercial & Multi-Family Real Estate
2,198

 
45.7
%
 
1,187

 
43.5
%
 
1,575

 
44.9
%
 
1,937

 
50.1
%
 
3,113

 
58.0
%
Agricultural Real Estate
142

 
6.9
%
 
163

 
9.0
%
 
263

 
11.2
%
 
112

 
7.6
%
 
1

 
6.0
%
Consumer
51

 
4.0
%
 
20

 
4.7
%
 
78

 
5.9
%
 
74

 
7.9
%
 
3

 
9.9
%
Commercial Operating
117

 
3.4
%
 
28

 
4.2
%
 
93

 
6.2
%
 
49

 
4.2
%
 
49

 
5.0
%
Agricultural Operating
1,332

 
4.0
%
 
3,537

 
6.1
%
 
719

 
8.5
%
 
267

 
8.8
%
 

 
6.3
%
Premium Finance
588

 
18.5
%
 
293

 
15
%
 

 

 

 

 

 

Unallocated
553

 

 
749

 

 
2,117

 

 
1,158

 

 
612

 

Total
$
5,635

 
100.0
%
 
$
6,255

 
100.0
%
 
$
5,397

 
100.0
%
 
$
3,930

 
100.0
%
 
$
3,971

 
100.0
%

Investment Activities
 
General.  The investment policy of the Company generally is to invest funds among various categories of investments and maturities based upon the Company’s need for liquidity, to achieve the proper balance between its desire to minimize risk and maximize yield, to provide collateral for borrowings and to fulfill the Company’s asset/liability management policies.  The Company’s investment and mortgage-backed securities portfolios are managed in accordance with a written investment policy adopted by the Board of Directors, which is implemented by members of the Company’s Investment Committee.  The Company closely monitors balances in these accounts, and maintains a portfolio of highly liquid assets to fund potential deposit outflows or other liquidity needs.  To date, the Company has not experienced any significant outflows related to MPS, though no assurance can be given that this will continue to be the case.
 
As of September 30, 2016, investment and mortgage-backed securities with fair values of approximately $824.5 million, $237.2 million and $9.2 million were pledged as collateral for the Bank’s Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines (“FHLB”) advances, Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) advances and collateral for securities sold under agreements to repurchase, respectively.  For additional information regarding the Company’s collateralization of borrowings, see Notes 8 and 9 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Investment Securities.  It is the Company’s general policy to purchase investment securities which are U.S. Government securities, U.S. Government agency and instrumentality securities, U.S. Government agency or instrumentality collateralized securities, state and local government obligations, commercial paper, corporate debt securities and overnight federal funds.


19



Beginning in June 2012, the Company began executing a strategy designed to diversify the Bank’s investment securities portfolio.  This strategy involved purchasing other investments, primarily non-bank qualified municipal bond securities.  In fiscal 2016, the Company also executed upon relative value opportunities in the securities portfolio posed by perceived dislocations in the market by purchasing a sizable portion of government-related three-month Libor floating rate securities during the year. The Company believes diversification reduces the risk in the portfolio by spreading its investable dollars among a broader range of investment types and takes advantage of the Company’s innovative and low-cost funding structure.  As of September 30, 2016, the Company had total investment securities, excluding mortgage-backed securities, with an amortized cost of $1.37 billion compared to $953.0 million as of September 30, 2015.  At September 30, 2016, $420.1 million, or 32.6%, of the Company’s investment securities were pledged to secure various obligations of the Company.

A large portion of this investment strategy involves the purchase of non-bank qualified obligations of political subdivisions or municipal housing securities backed by or convertible into Fannie Mae, Freddie Mac, and or Ginnie Mae securities.  These bonds are issued in larger denominations than bank qualified obligations of political subdivisions, which allows for the purchase of larger blocks.  These larger blocks of municipal bonds are typically issued in larger denominations by well-known issuers with reputable reporting and in turn, tend to be more liquid, which helps reduce price risk.  These municipal bonds are tax-exempt and as such have a tax equivalent yield higher than their book yield.  The tax equivalent yield calculation uses the Company’s cost of funds as one of its components.  Given the Company’s relatively low cost of funds due to the volume of interest-free deposits generated by the MPS division, the tax equivalent yield for these bonds is higher than a similar term investment in other investment categories.  Many of the Company’s municipal holdings are able to be pledged at both the Federal Reserve and the Federal Home Loan Bank.
 
As of September 30, 2016, the Company had obligations of states and political subdivisions of $1.18 billion, representing 84.8% of total investment securities, excluding mortgage‑backed securities.  This amount is spread among 47 of the 50 U.S. states and the District of Columbia, with no individual state (excluding agency backed and/or convertible municipal securities) having a concentration higher than 10% of the total carrying value of the municipal portfolio.  The Company has no direct municipal bond exposure in Detroit or Puerto Rico.  Management believes this geographical diversification lessens the credit risk associated with these investments. The Company also monitors concentrations of the ultimate borrower and exposure to counties within each state to further enhance proper diversification.


20


The following table sets forth the carrying value of the Company’s investment securities portfolio, excluding mortgage-backed securities and other Benefit Equalization Plan equity securities, at the dates indicated.
 
 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Investment Securities AFS
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities (1)
$
12,978

 
$
13,944

 
$
46,929

Asset backed securities
116,815

 

 

Small business administration securities
80,719

 
56,056

 
67,012

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
698,672

 
608,590

 
367,580

Common equities and mutual funds
1,125

 
914

 
825

Subtotal AFS
910,309

 
679,504

 
482,346

 
 
 
 
 
 
Investment Securities HTM
 

 
 

 
 

Obligations of states and political subdivisions
20,626

 
19,540

 
19,304

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions (2)
465,469

 
259,627

 
193,595

Subtotal HTM
486,095

 
279,167

 
212,899

 
 
 
 
 
 
FHLB Stock
47,512

 
24,410

 
21,245

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Investment Securities and FHLB Stock
$
1,443,916

 
$
983,081

 
$
716,490

 
 
 
 
 
 
Other Interest-Earning Assets:
 

 
 

 
 

Interest bearing deposits in other financial institutions and
 

 
 

 
 

Federal Funds Sold (3)
$
513,441

 
$
10,051

 
$
9,084

 
(1) 
Within the trust preferred securities presented above, there are no securities from individual issuers that exceed 5% of the Company’s total equity.  The name and the aggregate market value of securities of each individual issuer as of September 30, 2016, are as follows: Key Corp Capital I, $4.2 million; PNC Capital Trust, $4.7 million; and Huntington Capital Trust II SE, $4.1 million.

(2) 
Includes $3.1 million of taxable obligations of states and political subdivisions.

(3) 
The Company at times maintains balances at the FHLB and the FRB, and also maintains balances in excess of FDIC-insured limits at various financial institutions.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had $512.9 million in interest-bearing deposits held at the FRB, $0.5 million at other institutions, and none at the FHLB.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had no federal funds sold at a private institution.


21


The composition and maturities of the Company’s available for sale and held to maturity investment securities portfolio, excluding equity securities, FHLB stock and mortgage-backed securities, are indicated in the following table.
 
 
September 30, 2016
 
1 Year or Less
 
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
 
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
 
After 10 Years
 
Total Investment Securities
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
Available for Sale
(Dollars in Thousands)
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
12,978

 
$
14,936

 
$
12,978

Asset backed securities

 

 

 
116,815

 
117,487

 
116,815

Small business administration securities

 

 
80,719

 

 
78,430

 
80,719

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions

 
17,897

 
366,052

 
314,723

 
668,628

 
698,672

Total Investment Securities AFS
$

 
$
17,897

 
$
446,771

 
$
444,516

 
$
879,481

 
$
909,184

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted Average Yield (1)
%
 
1.19
%
 
1.57
%
 
1.95
%
 
2.37
%
 
1.72
%
 
 
September 30, 2016
 
1 Year or Less
 
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
 
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
 
After 10 Years
 
Total Investment Securities
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
Held to Maturity
(Dollars in Thousands)
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
472

 
$
6,587

 
$
9,558

 
$
4,009

 
$
20,626

 
$
20,936

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions

 
5,915

 
148,386

 
311,168

 
465,469

 
477,203

Total Investment Securities HTM
$
472

 
$
12,502

 
$
157,944

 
$
315,177

 
$
486,095

 
$
498,139

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted Average Yield (1)
1.08
%
 
2.03
%
 
2.27
%
 
2.91
%
 
2.68
%
 
2.25
%
 
(1) 
Yields on tax-exempt obligations have not been computed on a tax-equivalent basis.


Mortgage-Backed Securities.  The Company’s mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consisted entirely of securities issued by U.S. Government agencies or instrumentalities, including those of Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac as of September 30, 2016.  The Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac certificates are modified pass‑through mortgage-backed securities representing undivided interests in underlying pools of fixed‑rate, or certain types of adjustable-rate, predominantly single-family and, to a lesser extent, multi‑family residential mortgages issued by these U.S. Government agencies or instrumentalities.
 

22


At September 30, 2016, the Company had a diverse portfolio of mortgage-backed securities with an amortized cost of $688.8 million, all at fixed rates of interest.  The Company held primarily seasoned 15-year, 20-year, and 30-year pass through mortgage-backed securities. Coupons on these securities ranged from below 3% to 5.5%.
 
Mortgage-backed securities generally increase the quality of the Company’s assets by virtue of the insurance or guarantees that back them, are more liquid than individual mortgage loans, and may be used to collateralize borrowings or other obligations of the Company.  At September 30, 2016, $568.1 million or 81.9% of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities were pledged to secure various obligations of the Company.
 
While mortgage-backed securities carry a reduced credit risk as compared to whole loans, such securities remain subject to the risk that a fluctuating interest rate environment, along with other factors such as the geographic distribution and other underwriting risks inherent in the underlying mortgage loans, may alter the prepayment rate of such mortgage loans and so affect both the prepayment speed, and value, of such securities.  The prepayment risk associated with mortgage-backed securities is continually monitored, and prepayment rate assumptions are adjusted as appropriate to update the Company’s mortgage-backed securities accounting and asset/liability reports.

The following table sets forth the carrying value of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities at the dates indicated.
 
 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Available for Sale
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Freddie Mac
$
164,577

 
$
174,322

 
$
155,340

Fannie Mae
394,363

 
391,846

 
266,214

Fannie Mae DUS

 
10,415

 
194,663

Ginnie Mae

 

 
41,653

Total AFS
$
558,940

 
$
576,583

 
$
657,870

 
 
At September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Held to Maturity
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Farmer Mac
$
71,011

 
$

 
$

Fannie Mae
51,894

 
61,026

 
70,034

Ginnie Mae
10,853

 
5,551

 

Total HTM
$
133,758

 
$
66,577

 
$
70,034

 

23


The following table sets forth the contractual maturities of the Company’s mortgage-backed securities at September 30, 2016.  Not considered in the preparation of the table below is the effect of prepayments, periodic principal repayments and the adjustable-rate nature of these instruments which typically lower the average life of these holdings.
 
September 30, 2016
 
1 Year or Less
 
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
 
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
 
After 10 Years
 
Total Investment Securities
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
Available for Sale
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Freddie Mac
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
164,577

 
$
164,881

 
$
164,577

Fannie Mae

 

 

 
394,363

 
390,155

 
394,363

Total Investment Securities
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
558,940

 
$
555,036

 
$
558,940

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted Average Yield
%
 
%
 
%
 
1.97
%
 
2.02
%
 
1.97
%
 
September 30, 2016
 
1 Year or Less
 
After 1 Year Through 5 Years
 
After 5 Years Through 10 Years
 
After 10 Years
 
Total Investment Securities
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Carrying Value
 
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
Held to Maturity
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Farmer Mac
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
71,011

 
$
71,011

 
$
71,186

Fannie Mae

 

 

 
51,893

 
51,893

 
52,310

Ginnie Mae

 

 

 
10,854

 
10,854

 
10,939

Total Investment Securities
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
133,758

 
$
133,758

 
$
134,435

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted Average Yield
%
 
%
 
%
 
2.79
%
 
2.79
%
 
2.85
%

At September 30, 2016, the contractual maturity of all of the Company’s mortgage‑backed securities was in excess of ten years.  The actual maturity of a mortgage-backed security is typically less than its stated contractual maturity due to scheduled principal payments and prepayments of the underlying mortgages.  Prepayments that are different than anticipated will affect the yield to maturity.  The yield is based upon the interest income and the amortization of any premium or discount related to the mortgage-backed security.  In accordance with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“GAAP”), premiums and discounts are amortized over the estimated lives of the loans, which decrease and increase interest income, respectively.  The prepayment assumptions used to determine the amortization period for premiums and discounts can significantly affect the yield of mortgage-backed securities, and these assumptions are reviewed periodically to reflect actual prepayments.  Although prepayments of underlying mortgages depend on many factors, including the type of mortgages, the coupon rate, borrower credit scores, loan to premises value, the age of mortgages, the geographical location of the underlying real estate collateralizing the mortgages and general levels of market interest rates, the difference between the interest rates on the underlying mortgages and the prevailing mortgage interest rates generally is the most significant determinant of the rate of prepayments.  During periods of falling mortgage interest rates, if the coupon rate of the underlying mortgages exceeds the prevailing market interest rates offered for mortgage loans, refinancing generally increases and accelerates the prepayment of the underlying mortgages and the related security.  Under such circumstances, the Company may be subject to reinvestment risk because, to the extent that the Company’s mortgage-backed securities amortize or prepay faster than anticipated, the Company may not be able to reinvest the proceeds of such repayments and prepayments at a comparable rate.  During periods of rising interest rates, these prepayments tend to decelerate as the prevailing market interest rates for mortgage rates increase and prepayment incentives dissipate.

24



Management has implemented a process to identify securities with potential credit impairment that are other-than-temporary.  This process involves evaluation of the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating, watch, and outlook of the security, monitoring changes in value, cash flow projections, and the Company’s intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost which, in some cases, may extend to maturity.  To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized.
 
For all securities considered temporarily impaired, the Company does not intend to sell these securities and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost, which may occur at maturity.  The Company believes it will collect all principal and interest due on all investments with amortized cost in excess of fair value and considered only temporarily impaired.
 
In fiscal 2016, 2015 and 2014, there were no other-than-temporary impairments recorded.  Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac, which are both in conservatorship, generally provide the certificate holder a guarantee of timely payments of interest, whether or not collected.  Ginnie Mae’s guarantee to the holder is timely payments of principal and interest, backed by the full faith and credit of the U.S. Government.
 
Sources of Funds
 
General.  The Company’s sources of funds are deposits, borrowings, amortization and repayment of loan principal, interest earned on or maturation of investment securities and short-term investments, mortgage-backed securities and funds provided from operations.
 
Borrowings, including FHLB advances, repurchase agreements and funds available through the FRB Discount Window, may be used at times to compensate for seasonal reductions in deposits or deposit inflows at less than projected levels, may be used on a longer-term basis to support expanded lending activities, and may also be used to match the funding of a corresponding asset.
 
Deposits.  The Company offers a variety of deposit accounts having a wide range of interest rates and terms.  The Company’s deposits consist of statement savings accounts, money market savings accounts, NOW and regular checking accounts, deposits related to prepaid cards primarily categorized as checking accounts and certificate accounts currently ranging in terms from 3 months to 5 years.  The Company solicits deposits from its primary market area and relies primarily on competitive pricing policies, advertising and high-quality customer service to attract and retain these deposits.

The flow of deposits is influenced significantly by general economic conditions, changes in money market and prevailing interest rates, and competition.
 
The variety of deposit accounts offered by the Company has allowed it to be competitive in obtaining funds and to respond with flexibility to changes in consumer demand.  The Company endeavors to manage the pricing of its deposits in keeping with its asset/liability management and profitability objectives.  Based on its experience, the Company believes that its savings, money market accounts, NOW, regular checking accounts and deposits related to prepaid cards are relatively stable sources of deposits.  However, the ability of the Company to attract and maintain certificates of deposit and the rates paid on these deposits has been and will continue to be significantly affected by market conditions.
 
At September 30, 2016, $2.13 billion of the Company’s $2.43 billion deposit portfolio was attributable to MPS.  The majority of these deposits represent funds available to spend on prepaid debit cards and other stored value products, of which $2.11 billion are included with non-interest-bearing checking accounts and $23.1 million are included with savings deposits on the Company’s Consolidated Statement of Financial Condition.  Generally, these deposits do not pay interest.  MPS originates debit card programs through outside sales agents and other financial institutions.  As such, these deposits carry a somewhat higher degree of concentration risk than traditional consumer products.  If a major client or card program were to leave the Bank, deposit outflows could be more significant than if the Bank were to lose a more traditional customer, although it is considered unlikely that all deposits related to a program would leave the Bank without significant advance notification.  As such, and as historical results indicate and management believes, the Company’s deposit portfolio attributable to MPS is stable.  The increase in deposits arising from MPS has allowed the Bank to reduce its reliance on higher costing certificates of deposits and public funds.  See “Regulation – FDIC Deposit Classification Guidance.”
 

25


The following table sets forth the deposit flows at the Company during the periods indicated.
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Opening Balance
$
1,657,534

 
$
1,366,541

 
$
1,315,283

Deposits
418,950,277

 
315,944,447

 
215,420,492

Withdrawals
(418,178,086
)
 
(315,653,993
)
 
(215,369,877
)
Interest Credited
357

 
539

 
643

 
 
 
 
 
 
Ending Balance
$
2,430,082

 
$
1,657,534

 
$
1,366,541

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net Increase
$
772,548

 
$
290,993

 
$
51,258

 
 
 
 
 
 
Percent Increase
46.61
%
 
21.29
%
 
3.90
%

The following table sets forth the dollar amount of deposits in the various types of deposit programs offered by the Company for the periods indicated.
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Total
 
Amount
 
Percent of
Total
 
Amount
 
Percent of
 Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Transactions and Savings Deposits:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-Interest Bearing Checking
$
2,167,522

 
89.2
%
 
$
1,449,101

 
87.4
%
 
$
1,126,715

 
82.5
%
Interest Bearing Checking
38,077

 
1.6
%
 
33,320

 
2.0
%
 
37,188

 
2.7
%
Savings Deposits
50,742

 
2.1
%
 
41,720

 
2.5
%
 
27,610

 
2.0
%
Money Market Deposits
47,749

 
1.9
%
 
42,222

 
2.6
%
 
40,475

 
3.0
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Non-Certificate Deposits
$
2,304,090

 
94.8
%
 
$
1,566,363

 
94.5
%
 
$
1,231,988

 
90.2
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Time Certificates of Deposit:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Variable
124

 
%
 
192

 
%
 
202

 
%
0.00 - 1.99%
125,519

 
5.2
%
 
89,044

 
5.4
%
 
128,730

 
9.4
%
2.00 - 3.99%
349

 
%
 
1,935

 
0.1
%
 
5,621

 
0.4
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total Time Certificates of Deposits
$
125,992

 
5.2
%
 
$
91,171

 
5.5
%
 
$
134,553

 
9.8
%
Total Deposits
$
2,430,082

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,657,534

 
100.0
%
 
$
1,366,541

 
100.0
%


26


The following table shows rate and maturity information for the Company’s certificates of deposit as of September 30, 2016
 
Variable
 
0.00- 1.99%

 
2.00%- 3.99%

 
Total
 
Percent of
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Certificate accounts maturing in quarter ending:
 
 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
December 31, 2016
$
22

 
$
49,368

 
$
21

 
$
49,411

 
39.2
%
March 31, 2017
28

 
45,170

 
10

 
45,208

 
35.9
%
June 30, 2017
9

 
10,845

 

 
10,854

 
8.6
%
September 30, 2017
45

 
1,598

 

 
1,643

 
1.3
%
December 31, 2017
14

 
5,616

 

 
5,630

 
4.5
%
March 31, 2018
6

 
967

 

 
973

 
0.8
%
June 30, 2018

 
1,626

 

 
1,626

 
1.3
%
September 30, 2018

 
738

 

 
738

 
0.6
%
December 31, 2018

 
2,787

 

 
2,787

 
2.2
%
March 31, 2019

 
301

 

 
301

 
0.2
%
June 30, 2019

 
1,308

 

 
1,308

 
1.0
%
September 30, 2019

 
277

 

 
277

 
0.2
%
Thereafter

 
4,918

 
318

 
5,236

 
4.2
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total
$
124

 
$
125,519

 
$
349

 
$
125,992

 
100.0
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Percent of total
0.1
%
 
99.6
%
 
0.3
%
 
100.0
%
 
 


The following table indicates the amount of the Company’s certificates of deposit and other deposits by time remaining until maturity as of September 30, 2016.
 
Maturity
 
3 Months or
Less
 
After 3 to 6
Months
 
After 6 to 12
Months
 
After 12 Months
 
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Certificates of deposit less than $250,000
$
36,843

 
$
42,459

 
$
1,755

 
$
475

 
$
81,532

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Certificates of deposit of $250,000 or more
12,568

 
2,749

 
10,742

 
18,401

 
$
44,460

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total certificates of deposit
$
49,411

 
$
45,208

 
$
12,497

 
$
18,876

 
$
125,992

 
At September 30, 2016, there were $77.2 million in deposits from governmental and other public entities included in certificates of deposit.
 
Borrowings.  Although deposits are the Company’s primary source of funds, the Company’s practice has been to utilize borrowings when they are a less costly source of funds, can be invested at a positive interest rate spread, or when the Company desires additional capacity to fund loan demand. Borrowings from various sources mature based on stated payment schedules.
     
The Company’s borrowings have historically consisted primarily of advances from the FHLB upon the security of a blanket collateral agreement of a percentage of unencumbered loans and the pledge of specific investment securities.  Such advances can be made pursuant to several different credit programs, each of which has its own interest rate and range of maturities.  At September 30, 2016, the Bank had $107.0 million of advances from the FHLB, $992.0 million of federal funds purchased and the ability to borrow up to an approximate additional $7.2 million.  The Company is able to pledge additional assets to expand its borrowing capability at the FHLB. At September 30, 2016, there were $7.0 million in advances that had maturities ranging up to approximately four years.

27


 
The Company completed the public offering of $75 million of 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures during fiscal year 2016. These notes are due August 15, 2026. The subordinated debentures were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds of approximately $73.9 million. At September 30, 2016, the Company had $73.2 million in subordinated debentures, net of issuance costs of $1.8 million.

On July 16, 2001, the Company issued all of the 10,310 authorized shares of Company Obligated Mandatorily Redeemable Preferred Securities of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I (preferred securities of subsidiary trust) holding solely trust preferred securities.  Distributions are paid semi‑annually.  Cumulative cash distributions are calculated at a variable rate of the London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 3.75%, not to exceed 12.5%.  The Company may, at one or more times, defer interest payments on the capital securities for up to 10 consecutive semi-annual periods, but not beyond July 25, 2031.  At the end of any deferral period, all accumulated and unpaid distributions must be paid.  The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has a semi‑annual option to shorten the maturity date.  The option has not been exercised as of the date of this filing.  The redemption price is $1,000 per capital security plus any accrued and unpaid distributions to the date of redemption.  Holders of the capital securities have no voting rights, are unsecured, and rank junior in priority of payment to all of the Company’s indebtedness and senior to the Company’s common stock.  The trust preferred securities have been includable in the Company’s capital calculations since they were issued.  The preferential capital treatment of the Company’s trust preferred securities was grandfathered under recent banking legislation.

From time to time, the Company has offered retail repurchase agreements to its customers.  These agreements typically range from 14 days to five years in term, and typically have been offered in minimum amounts of $100,000.  The proceeds of these transactions are used to meet cash flow needs of the Company.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had $3.0 million of retail repurchase agreements outstanding.

The Company had three capital leases as of September 30, 2016, two equipment leases and one property lease.  At September 30, 2016, the portion of the liability expected to be expensed and amortized over the next 12 months is $79,000, while the portion of the liability expected to be expensed and amortized beyond 12 months is $1.9 million.  The majority of the $1.9 million is related to the Urbandale, Iowa retail branch location.

 
The following table sets forth the maximum month-end balance and average balance of FHLB advances, retail and reverse repurchase agreements, trust preferred securities, subordinated debentures, capital leases, and overnight fed funds purchased for the periods indicated.
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Maximum Balance:
 
 
 
 
 
FHLB advances
$
107,000

 
$
7,000

 
$
7,000

Repurchase agreements
3,468

 
17,400

 
33,999

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,310

 
10,310

Subordinated debentures
73,211

 

 

Capital leases
2,137

 
2,247

 

Overnight fed funds purchased
992,000

 
540,000

 
470,000

 
 
 
 
 
 
Average Balance:
 

 
 

 
 

FHLB advances
$
61,454

 
$
7,000

 
$
7,000

Repurchase agreements
2,179

 
10,884

 
10,137

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,310

 
10,310

Subordinated debentures
9,437

 

 

Capital leases
2,086

 
1,993

 

Overnight fed funds purchased
339,035

 
234,025

 
186,153

 

28


The following table sets forth certain information as to the Company’s FHLB advances, retail and reverse repurchase agreements, trust preferred securities, subordinated debentures, capital leases, and overnight fed funds purchased at the dates indicated.
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
FHLB advances
$
107,000

 
$
7,000

 
$
7,000

Repurchase agreements
3,039

 
4,007

 
10,411

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,310

 
10,310

Subordinated debentures
73,211

 

 

Capital leases
2,018

 
2,143

 

Overnight fed funds purchased
992,000

 
540,000

 
470,000

 
 
 
 
 
 
Total borrowings
$
1,187,578

 
$
563,460

 
$
497,721

 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest rate of FHLB advances
0.89
%
 
6.98
%
 
6.98
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest rate of repurchase agreements
0.60
%
 
0.52
%
 
0.52
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest rate of trust preferred securities
4.99
%
 
4.28
%
 
4.08
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest rate of subordinated debentures
5.75
%
 
%
 
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
Weighted average interest rate of overnight fed funds purchased
0.45
%
 
0.30
%
 
0.28
%

Subsidiary Activities
 
The subsidiaries of the Company are the Bank and First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I.
 
Meta Payment Systems® Division
 
The Company, through the MPS division of the Bank, is focused on the electronic payments industry and offers a complement of prepaid cards, consumer credit products and other payment industry- related products and services that are marketed to consumers through financial institutions and other commercial entities on a nation-wide basis.  The products and services offered by MPS are generally designed to facilitate the processing and settlement of authorized electronic transactions involving the movement of funds.  MPS offers specific product solutions in the following areas:  (i) prepaid cards, (ii) a consumer credit product, (iii) ATM sponsorship and (iv) tax refund transfers and, beginning in January 2017, interest-free tax refund loans.  MPS’ products and services generally target banks, card processors, third parties who market and distribute the cards and independent EROs.
 
Each line of MPS’ business is discussed generally below.  With respect to the lines of business, there is a significant amount of cross-utilization of personnel and resources (e.g., a client asks MPS to develop products for both prepaid and consumer credit needs).
 
Prepaid Cards.  Prepaid cards take the form of credit card-sized plastics embedded with a magnetic stripe which encodes relevant card data (which may or may not include information about the user and/or purchaser of such card) or a “virtual” card where there is no actual plastic but the transaction and account records are handled in the same manner.  When the holder of such a card attempts a permitted transaction, necessary information, including the authorization for such transaction, is shared between the “point of use” or “point of sale” and authorization systems maintaining the account of record.
 


29


The funds associated with such cards are typically held in pooled accounts at the Bank representing the aggregate value of all cards issued in connection with particular products or programs, further described below.  Although the funds are held in pooled accounts, the account of record indicates the funds held by each individual card.  The cards may work in a closed loop (e.g., the card will only work at one particular merchant and will not work anywhere else), a semi-closed loop (e.g., the card will only work at a specific set of merchants such as a shopping mall), or in an open loop which function as a Visa, MasterCard, or Discover branded debit card that will work wherever such cards are accepted for payment.  Most of MPS’ prepaid cards are open-loop.
 
This segment of MPS’ business can generally be divided into three categories:  reloadable cards, non-reloadable cards and benefit/insurance cards.  These programs are typically offered via a third-party relationship.  Government benefits are another growing application for prepaid cards; however, MPS has not focused on this category to date.
 
Reloadable Cards.  The most common reloadable prepaid card programs are payroll cards, whereby an employee’s payroll is loaded to the card by their employer utilizing direct deposit.  General Purpose Reloadable (“GPR”) cards are usually distributed by retailers and can be reloaded an indefinite number of times at participating retail load networks.  Other examples of reloadable cards are travel cards which are used to replace traveler’s checks and can be reloaded a predetermined number of times as well as tax-related cards where a taxpayer’s refund is placed on the card.  Reloadable cards are generally open- loop cards that consumers can use to obtain cash at ATMs or purchase goods and services wherever such cards are accepted for payment.

Non-Reloadable Cards.  Non-reloadable prepaid cards are sometimes referred to as disposable and may only be used until the funds initially loaded to the card have been exhausted.  These include gift cards, rebate cards and promotional or incentive cards.  These cards may be closed-loop or open-loop but are generally not available to obtain cash.  Under certain conditions, these cards may be anonymous, whereby no customer relationship is created and the identity of the cardholder is unknown.  Except for gift cards, many non-reloadable card programs are funded by a corporation as a marketing tool rather than from consumer funds.
 
Benefit/Insurance Cards.  Benefit/insurance cards are traditionally used by employers and large commercial companies (such as property insurers) to distribute benefits to persons entitled to such funds.  Possible uses of benefit cards could be the distribution of money for qualified expenses related to an employer sponsored flexible spending account program (“FSA”) or the distribution of insurance claim proceeds to insureds who have made a payable claim against an existing insurance policy.  These cards are generally open-loop or semi-closed-loop as in the case of an FSA card that can only be used for qualified medical expenses.
 
Consumer Credit Products.  In its belief that credit programs can help meet legitimate credit needs for prime and sub-prime borrowers, and afford the Company an opportunity to diversify the loan portfolio and minimize earnings exposure due to economic downturns, the Company has offered certain credit programs that were designed to accomplish these objectives, although only one such program currently exists.
 
MPS has strived to offer consumers innovative payment products, including credit products.  Most credit products have historically fallen into one of two general categories:  (1) sponsorship lending and (2) portfolio lending.  In a sponsorship lending model, MPS typically originates loans and sells (without recourse) the resulting receivables to third-party investors equipped to take the associated credit risk.  MPS’ sponsorship lending program is governed by the Policy for Sponsorship Lending which has been approved by the Board of Directors.  MPS discontinued most sponsorship lending programs in fiscal year 2012 with only one run-off portfolio still in existence.  A Portfolio Credit Policy which has been approved by the Board of Directors governs portfolio credit initiatives undertaken by MPS, whereby the Company retains some or all receivables and relies on the borrower as the underlying source of repayment.
 
ATM Sponsorship.  MPS sponsors ATM independent sales organizations (“ISOs”) into various networks and provides associated sponsorships of encryption support organizations and third-party processors in support of the financial institutions and the ATM ISO sponsorships.  Sponsorship consists of the review and oversight of entities participating in debit and credit networks.  In certain instances, MPS also has certain leasehold interests in certain ATMs which require bank ownership and registration for compliance with applicable state law.
 
While the Company has adopted policies and procedures to manage and monitor the risks attendant to this line of business, and the executives who manage the Company’s program have years of experience, no guarantee can be made that the Company will not experience losses in the MPS division.  MPS has signed agreements through the next few years with several of its largest sales agents/program managers, which helps mitigate this risk.  See “- Regulation – Proposal Prepaid Payments Regulation”.
 

30


Tax Refund Transfers.  With the acquisition of Refund Advantage in September 2015, the Company is a leading provider of professional tax refund-transfer software used by independent EROs in over 10,000 locations nationwide and processes over one million refund transfers per year.  Refund Advantage offers tax refund-transfer solutions through ACH direct deposit, check and prepaid card. Beginning in January 2017, the Bank will offer 0% APR tax refund loans to consumers through marketing programs with national consumer tax preparation companies, including H&R Block and MetaBank's own refund transfer companies, Refund Advantage and EPS.

Regulation

General

The Company is broadly regulated as a savings and loan holding company by the Federal Reserve, and is required to file reports with and otherwise comply with the rules and regulations of the Federal Reserve applicable to such companies.  As a reporting company under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Company is also required to file reports with the SEC and otherwise comply with federal securities laws.  The Bank is a federally chartered thrift institution that is subject to broad federal regulation and oversight extending to all of its operations by the OCC, its primary federal regulator, and by the FDIC as deposit insurer.  The Bank is also a member of the FHLB.  See “Risk Factors” which is included in Item 1A of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
The legislative and regulatory enactments described below have had and are expected to continue to have a material impact upon the operations of the Company and the Bank.
 
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010 (“the Dodd-Frank Act”).  In response to the national and international economic recession that began in 2007-2008 and to strengthen supervision of financial institutions and systemically important non-bank financial institutions, Congress and the U.S. Government took a variety of actions, including the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act on July 21, 2010.  The Dodd-Frank Act represented the most comprehensive change to banking laws since the Great Depression of the 1930s and mandated changes in several key areas:  regulation and compliance (both with respect to financial institutions and systemically important non-bank financial companies), securities regulation, executive compensation, regulation of derivatives, corporate governance, transactions with affiliates, deposit insurance assessments and consumer protection.  Importantly for the Bank, the Dodd-Frank Act also abolished the Office of Thrift Supervision (the “OTS”) on July 21, 2011, and transferred rulemaking authority and regulatory oversight to the OCC with respect to federal savings banks, such as the Bank, and to the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System with respect to savings and loan holding companies, such as the Company.  While the changes in the law required by the Dodd-Frank Act have had a major impact on large institutions, even relatively smaller institutions such as ours have been affected.
 
Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, the Bank is subject to regulations promulgated by the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (the “Bureau” or “CFPB”).  The Bureau has consolidated rules and orders with respect to consumer financial products and services and has substantial power to define the rights of consumers and responsibilities of lending institutions, such as the Bank.  The Bureau does not, however, examine or supervise the Bank for compliance with such regulations; rather, based on the Bank’s size (less than $10 billion in assets), enforcement authority remains with the OCC although the Bank may be required to submit reports or other materials to the Bureau upon its request.  Notwithstanding jurisdictional limitations set forth in the Dodd-Frank Act, the Bureau and federal banking regulators may endeavor to work jointly in investigating and resolving cases as they arise.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act included provisions which restrict interchange fees to those which are “reasonable and proportionate” for certain debit card issuers and limits the ability of networks and issuers to restrict debit card transaction routing (known as the “Durbin Amendment”).  The Federal Reserve issued final rules implementing the Durbin Amendment on June 29, 2011.  In the final rule, interchange fees for debit card transactions were capped at $0.21 plus five basis points to be eligible for a “safe harbor” such that the fee is conclusively reasonable and proportionate.  Another related rule also permits an additional $0.01 per transaction “fraud prevention adjustment” to the interchange fee if certain standards designed by the Federal Reserve are implemented including an annual review of fraud prevention policies and procedures.  With respect to network exclusivity and merchant routing restrictions, it is now required that all debit cards participate in at least two unaffiliated networks so that the transactions initiated using those debit cards will have at least two independent routing channels.  Notably, the interchange fee restrictions in the Durbin Amendment do not apply to the Bank because debit card issuers with total worldwide assets of less than $10 billion are exempt.





31


The Dodd-Frank Act also included a provision that supplements the Federal Trade Commission Act’s prohibitions against practices that are unfair or deceptive by also prohibiting practices that are “abusive.”  The Bureau’s Director, Richard Cordray, has publicly stated that this term will not be defined by regulation but will, instead, be illuminated by the enforcement actions the Bureau initiates.  To date, a relatively small number of Bureau enforcement actions have referenced alleged “abusive” acts or practices.
 
The extent to which new legislation, existing and planned governmental initiatives, and a new presidential administration result in an improvement in the national economy is uncertain.  In addition, because some components of the Dodd-Frank Act still have not been finalized, it is difficult to predict the ultimate effect of the Dodd-Frank Act on us or the Bank at this time, especially after the recent 2016 election.
 
USA Patriot Act of 2001.  In October 2001, the USA Patriot Act of 2001 (the “Patriot Act”) was enacted in response to the terrorist attacks in New York, Pennsylvania and Washington, D.C., which occurred on September 11, 2001.  The Patriot Act is intended to strengthen U.S. law enforcement’s and the intelligence communities’ abilities to work cohesively to combat terrorism on a variety of fronts.  The potential impact of the Patriot Act on financial institutions of all kinds is significant and wide-ranging.  The Patriot Act contains sweeping anti-money laundering and financial transparency laws and imposes various regulations, including standards for verifying client identification at account opening, and rules to promote cooperation among financial institutions, regulators and law enforcement entities in identifying parties that may be involved in terrorism or money laundering.  Among other provisions, the Patriot Act requires financial institutions to have anti-money laundering programs in place and requires banking regulators to consider a holding company’s effectiveness in combating money laundering when ruling on certain merger or acquisition applications.
 
Privacy.  The Bank is required by statute and regulation to disclose its privacy policies to its customers on an annual basis.  The Bank does not share nonpublic personal information about its customers with non-affiliated third parties for marketing purposes.  The Bank is also required to appropriately safeguard its customers’ personal information.
 
Preemption.  On July 21, 2011, the preemption provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act became effective, requiring that federal savings associations be subject to the same preemption standards as national banks, with respect to the application of state consumer laws to the interstate activities of federally chartered depository institutions.  Under the preemption standards established under the Dodd‑Frank Act for both national banks and federal savings associations, preemption of a state consumer financial law is permissible only if:  (1) application of the state law would have a discriminatory effect on national banks or federal thrifts as compared to state banks; (2) the state law is preempted under a judicial standard that requires a state consumer financial law to prevent or significantly interfere with the exercise of the national bank’s or federal thrift’s powers before it can be preempted, with such preemption determination being made by the OCC (by regulation or order) or by a court, in either case on a “case‑by‑case” basis; or (3) the state law is preempted by another provision of federal law other than Title X of the Dodd-Frank Act.  Additionally, the Dodd-Frank Act specifies that such preemption standards only apply to national banks and federal thrifts themselves, and not their non-depository institution subsidiaries or affiliates.  Specifically, operating subsidiaries of national banks and federal thrifts that are not themselves chartered as a national bank or federal thrift may no longer benefit from federal preemption of state consumer financial laws, which now apply to such subsidiaries (or affiliates) to the same extent that they apply to any person, corporation or entity subject to such state laws.  The Bank has no operating subsidiaries at present.

Prohibition on Unfair, Deceptive and Abusive Acts and Practices.  July 21, 2011 was the designated transfer date under the Dodd-Frank Act for the formal transfer of rulemaking functions under the federal consumer financial laws from each of the various federal banking agencies to the Bureau, which is charged with the mission of protecting consumer interests.  The Bureau is responsible for administering and carrying out the purposes and objectives of the federal consumer financial laws and to prevent evasions thereof, with respect to all financial institutions that offer financial products and services to consumers.  The Bureau is also authorized to prescribe rules applicable to any covered person or service provider identifying and prohibiting acts or practices that are unfair, deceptive or abusive in connection with any transaction with a consumer for a consumer financial product or service, or the offering of a consumer financial product or service.  With its broad rulemaking and enforcement powers coupled with a five-year operational history, the Bureau has redrawn the consumer financial laws through rulemaking and enforcement actions, which may directly impact the business operations of financial institutions offering consumer financial products or services including the Bank and its divisions.
 




32


Prepaid Accounts under the Electronic Fund Transfer Act (Regulation E) and the Truth In Lending Act (Regulation Z). On October 5, 2016, the CFPB issued a final rule which supplemented the existing regulatory framework pursuant to which prepaid products (both cards and other delivery methods, including codes) are offered and serviced. Importantly for the Bank, the rule brought prepaid products fully within Regulation E, which implements the federal Electronic Funds Transfer Act by adding a definition for “prepaid account”. In addition, prepaid products that have a credit component, like some of those offered in connection with an existing program manager agreement, are now regulated by Regulation Z, which implements the federal Truth in Lending Act.
Pursuant to the Prepaid Accounts Rule, the CFPB requires that the consumer be presented with a new “Know Before You Owe” disclosure. Financial institutions, such as the Bank, must provide certain account information in a short form disclosure, in close proximity to the short-form disclosure, and in a long form disclosure to consumers before they acquire a prepaid account, unless specifically exempted. The rule generally extended Regulation E’s error resolution and limited liability requirements to all prepaid accounts, regardless of whether the financial institution has completed its consumer identification and verification process with respect to the account. In addition, the Prepaid Accounts Rule extended Regulation E’s three tiers of liability for unauthorized transfers to prepaid accounts, depending on when the consumer reported the error. The rule also extended Regulation E’s periodic statement requirement to prepaid accounts. Under the final rule, financial institutions must, at no additional charge or fee, provide prepaid account holders with (i) periodic account statements, or (ii) access to his or her account balance through a readily available telephone line and written and electronic records of the account history. The rule also extended Regulation Z’s credit card rules and disclosure requirements to prepaid accounts that provide overdraft services and other credit features. The rule also requires account issuers, such as the Bank, to post their publicly offered prepaid card program agreements on their websites, make them available to consumers upon request, and provide copies of all publicly offered prepaid card program agreements to the CFPB. The rule generally takes effect on October 1, 2017, with certain exceptions. It is likely that the Bank will incur additional costs to implement the rule.
Customer Identification Programs for Holders of Prepaid Cards. On March 21, 2016, the federal banking agencies, including the OCC and the Federal Reserve, issued Interagency Guidance to Issuing Banks on Applying Customer Identification Program Requirements to Holders of Prepaid Cards. This guidance extends the requirements of the Customer Identification Program required by Section 326 of the USA Patriot Act to prepaid accounts where the cardholder has either the (i) ability to reload funds, or (ii) access to credit or overdraft features. If either of these features is present, the issuer must verify the identity of the named accountholder.
Incentive-Based Compensation Restrictions. On June 10, 2016, the federal banking regulators, including the Federal Reserve and the OCC, issued a proposed rule related to incentive-based compensation (the original proposed rule was published in April 2011). A rule related to incentive-based compensation is required by Dodd-Frank. According to the banking agencies, the rule is intended to (1) prohibit incentive-based payment arrangements that the Agencies determine could encourage certain financial institutions to take inappropriate risks by providing excessive compensation or that could lead to material financial loss, (2) require the board of directors of those financial institutions to take certain oversight actions related to incentive-based compensation, and (3) require those financial institutions to disclose information concerning incentive-based compensation arrangements to the appropriate Federal regulator.

The banking regulators have tailored the requirements of the proposed rule to the size and complexity of the covered institution. As currently contemplated, the Company and the Bank would be Level 3 covered institutions under the proposal because both have an average total consolidated assets between $1 and $50 billion. As a Level 3 covered institution, the proposal subjects the Company and the Bank to only the basic set of prohibitions and requirements, which prohibit “excessive compensation, fees, or benefits” or any compensation agreement that “could lead to material financial loss.”
The proposal also would require that the Company’s board of directors, or a committee thereof, conduct oversight of its incentive-based compensation program and approve incentive-based compensation arrangements for senior executive officers. Additionally, the Company and the Bank would be required to create and maintain records that document the structure of all of the incentive-based compensation arrangements, demonstrate compliance with the final rule, and disclose those records to the appropriate Federal regulator upon request.
Examination Guidance for Third-Party Lending. On July 29, 2016, the FDIC issued revised examination guidance related to third-party lending relationships (e.g., lending arrangements that rely on a third party to perform a significant aspect of the lending process). Similar to guidance published by the OCC in 2013, these regulatory materials generally require that financial institutions ensure that risks related to such programs are evaluated, including the type of lending activity, the complexity of the lending program, the projected and realized volume created by the relationship, and the number of third-party lending relationships the institution has in place.

33


Other Regulation.  The Bank is also subject to a variety of other regulations with respect to its business operations including, but not limited to, the Truth in Lending Act, the Truth in Savings Act, the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Military Lending Act, the Servicemembers’ Civil Relief Act, the Fair Housing Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act and the Fair Credit Reporting Act.  As discussed below, any change in the regulations affecting the Bank’s operations is not predictable and could affect the Bank’s operations and profitability.

Bank Supervision & Regulation
 
The Bank is a federally chartered thrift institution that is subject to broad federal regulation and oversight extending to all of its operations by its primary federal regulator, the OCC, and by its deposit insurer, the FDIC.  Such regulation covers all aspects of the banking business, including lending practices, safeguarding deposits, capital structure, transactions with affiliates and conduct and qualifications of personnel.  The Bank pays assessment fees both to the OCC and the FDIC, and the level of such assessments reflects the condition of the Bank.  If the condition of the Bank were to deteriorate, the level of such assessments could increase significantly, having a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.  The Bank is also a member of the FHLB System and is subject to certain limited regulation by the Federal Reserve.
 
 Regulatory authorities have been granted extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities which are intended to strengthen the financial condition of the banking industry, including, but not limited to, the imposition of restrictions on the operation of an institution, the classification of assets by the institution, and the adequacy of an institution’s allowance for loan losses.  Typically, these actions are undertaken due to violations of laws or regulations or conduct of operations in an unsafe or unsound manner.  The OCC has announced that supervisory strategies for 2017 will focus on the following:  (i) commercial and retail loan underwriting; (ii) business model sustainability and viability; (iii) operational resiliency; (iv) BSA/AML compliance management; and (v) change management processes to address new regulatory requirements.

Any change in the nature of such regulation and oversight, such as the items mentioned above, whether by the OCC, the FDIC, the Federal Reserve, or legislatively by Congress, could have a material impact on the Company or the Bank and their respective operations.  The discussion herein of the regulatory and supervisory structure within which the Bank operates is general and does not purport to be exhaustive or a complete description of the laws and regulations involved in the Bank’s operations.  The discussion is qualified in its entirety by the actual laws and regulations.
 
Federal Regulation of the Bank.  As the primary federal regulator for federal savings associations, the OCC has extensive authority over the operations of federal savings associations, such as the Bank.  This regulation and supervision establishes a comprehensive framework for activities in which a federal savings association can engage and is intended primarily for the protection of the DIF and depositors.  The regulatory structure also gives the regulatory authorities extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities and examination policies.
 
In connection with its assumption of responsibility for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of federal savings associations, the OCC published a final rule on July 21, 2011, that republishes those OTS regulations that the OCC has the authority to promulgate and enforce as of the July 21, 2011 transfer date, with nomenclature and other technical amendments to reflect OCC supervision of federal savings associations.  In addition, on May 17, 2012, November 20, 2013, and June 2, 2015, the OCC rescinded additional OTS documents that formerly applied to federal savings and loan associations, and applied new policy guidance where policy guidance did not already exist.  With respect to the 2015 rules, the OCC streamlined requirements (where permitted) to provide integrated treatment to national banks and federal savings associations with respect to certain corporate activities and transactions.  The new regulations define an “eligible savings association” as one that: (i) is well capitalized as defined in 12 CFR 6.4; (ii) Has a composite rating of 1 or 2 under the Uniform Financial Institutions Rating System (“CAMELS”); (iii) Has a Community Reinvestment Act (“CRA”), 12 U.S.C. 2901 et seq., rating of ‘‘Outstanding’’ or ‘‘Satisfactory,’’ if applicable; (iv) Has a consumer compliance rating of 1 or 2 under the Uniform Interagency Consumer Compliance Rating System; and (v) Is not subject to a cease and desist order, consent order, formal written agreement, or Prompt Corrective Action directive or, if subject to any such order, agreement, or directive, is informed in writing by the OCC that the savings association may be treated as an ‘‘eligible bank or eligible savings association’’ for purposes of the regulation. The OCC undertook this integration to promote fairness in supervision, reduce regulatory duplication and create efficiencies for national banks and federal savings associations, as well as the OCC.  Additional proposed rules by the OCC related to the streamlining of the treatment by federal savings associations and national banks have also been issued, including proposals related to fidelity bonds and insider and affiliate lending.  Once finalized, the OCC’s regulations and guidance supersede that of OTS and are indicative of the OCC’s goal of one integrated policy platform for national banks and savings associations.




34


It is possible that additional rulemaking could require significant revisions to the regulations under which the Bank operates and is supervised.  Any change in such laws and regulations or interpretations thereof negatively impacting the Bank's or the Company's current operations, whether by the OCC, the FDIC, the Bureau, the Federal Reserve or through legislation, could have a material adverse impact on the Bank and its operations and on the Company and its stockholders.
 
Business Activities
 
The activities of federal savings associations are generally governed by federal laws and regulations.  These laws and regulations delineate the nature and extent of the activities in which federal savings associations may engage.  In particular, many types of lending authority for federal savings associations are limited to a specified percentage of the institution’s capital or assets.
 
Loan and Investment Powers
 
The Bank derives its lending and investment powers from the Home Owners’ Loan Act (“HOLA”) and the OCC’s implementing regulations thereunder.  Under these laws and regulations, the Bank may invest in mortgage loans secured by residential and commercial real estate, commercial and consumer loans, certain types of debt securities and certain other assets.  The Bank may also establish service corporations that are permitted to engage in activities not otherwise permissible for the Bank, including certain real estate equity investments and securities and insurance brokerage activities; provided, however, that such investments are limited to 3% of the association's assets.  These investment powers are subject to various limitations, including (i) a prohibition against the acquisition of any corporate debt security unless, prior to acquisition, the savings association has determined that the investment is safe and sound and suitable for the institution and that the issuer has adequate resources and willingness to provide all required payments on its obligations in a timely manner; (ii) a limit of 400% of an association’s capital on the aggregate amount of loans secured by non-residential real estate property; (iii) a limit of 20% of an association’s assets on the aggregate amount of commercial and agricultural loans and leases with the amount of commercial loans in excess of 10% of assets being limited to small business loans; (iv) a limit of 35% of an association’s assets on the aggregate amount of secured consumer loans and acquisitions of certain debt securities, with amounts in excess of 30% of assets being limited to loans made directly to the original obligor and where no third-party finder or referral fees were paid; (v) a limit of 5% of assets on non-conforming loans (loans in excess of the specific limitations of the HOLA); and (vi) a limit of the greater of 5% of assets or an association’s capital on certain construction loans made for the purpose of financing what is or is expected to become residential property.  In addition, the HOLA and the OCC regulations provide that a federal savings association may invest up to 10% of its assets in tangible personal property for leasing purposes.
 
The Bank’s general permissible lending limit to one borrower is equal to the greater of $500,000 or 15% of unimpaired capital and surplus (except for loans fully secured by certain readily marketable collateral, in which case this limit is increased to 25% of unimpaired capital and surplus).  At September 30, 2016, the Bank’s lending limit under these restrictions was $49.5 million.  The Bank is in compliance with this lending limit.

Federal Deposit Insurance and Other Regulatory Requirements

 Insurance of Accounts and Regulation by the FDIC.  The Bank is a member of the DIF, which is administered by the FDIC.  Deposits are insured up to applicable limits by the FDIC and such insurance is backed by the full faith and credit of the United States Government.  While not our primary federal regulator, the FDIC as insurer imposes deposit insurance premiums and is authorized to conduct examinations of and to require reporting by FDIC-insured institutions.  It also may prohibit any FDIC-insured institution from engaging in any activity the FDIC determines by regulation or order to pose a serious risk to the DIF.  The FDIC also has authority to initiate enforcement actions against any FDIC-insured institution after giving its primary federal regulator the opportunity to take such action, and may seek to terminate the deposit insurance if it determines that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or is in an unsafe or unsound condition.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, a permanent increase in deposit insurance was authorized to $250,000.  The coverage limit is per depositor, per insured depository institution for each account ownership category. The Dodd-Frank Act also set a new minimum DIF reserve ratio at 1.35% of estimated insured deposits.  The FDIC is required to attain this ratio by September 30, 2020.  In connection with this requirement, in November 2015, the FDIC released a proposed rulemaking (1) raising the minimum reserve ratio from 1.15% to 1.35%; (2) requiring that the reserve ratio reach 1.35% by September 30, 2020; and (3) requiring that the FDIC offset the effect of the increase in the minimum reserve ratio on insured depository institutions with less than $10 billion in assets, like the Bank.  The Board of the FDIC voted to increase the reserve ratio to 1.35% in October 2015. The reserve ratio reached 1.15% on June 30, 2016 and it is anticipated to reach the statutory mandate of 1.35% in 2018.



35


The FDIC imposes an assessment against all depository institutions for deposit insurance.  Pursuant to changes adopted by the FDIC that were effective July 1, 2016, in connection with the achievement of a 1.15% reserve ratio, the initial base rate for deposit insurance is between 3-30 basis points. Total base assessment after possible adjustments now ranges between 1.5-40.0 basis points. For established smaller institutions, like the Bank, CAMELS composite ratings are used along with (i) an initial base assessment rate, (ii) an unsecured debt adjustment (can be positive or negative), and (iii) a brokered deposit adjustment rate, to calculate a total base assessment rate. Note that the final rule states that it is “revenue neutral” in that it leaves aggregate assessment revenue collected from small banks approximately as it would have been absent the final rule. Risk categorization for purposes of deposit insurance are no longer utilized.

As noted above, brokered deposits are subject to an adjustment rate in the calculation of deposit insurance premiums. Based upon guidance issued by the FDIC, some of Meta’s prepaid deposits would be deemed to be “brokered” deposits. As discussed below, should the Bank fail to maintain its well capitalized status, limitations related to brokered deposits would automatically trigger which could have a material adverse effect on the Bank and the Company.

Under the Federal Deposit Insurance Act (“FDIA”), the FDIC may terminate deposit insurance upon a finding that the institution has engaged in unsafe or unsound practices, is in an unsafe or unsound condition to continue operations, or has violated any applicable law, regulation, rule, order or condition imposed by the FDIC or the OCC.  Management of the Bank does not know of any practice, condition or violation that might lead to termination of deposit insurance.

A significant increase in DIF insurance premiums would have an adverse effect on the operating expenses and results of operations of the Bank.
 
DIF-insured institutions pay a Financing Corporation (“FICO”) assessment in order to fund the interest on bonds issued to resolve thrift failures in the 1980s.  At September 30, 2016, the FICO assessment was equal to 0.56 basis points for each $100 of its total assessment base of approximately $2.80 billion.  These assessments will continue until the bonds mature in 2019.
 
Interest Rate Risk Management.  The OCC requires federal savings banks, like the Bank, to have an effective and sound interest rate risk management program, including appropriate measurement and reporting, robust and meaningful stress testing, assumption development reflecting the institution’s experience, and comprehensive model valuation.  Interest rate risk exposure is supposed to be managed using processes and systems commensurate with their earnings and capital levels; complexity; business model; risk profile; and scope of operations.  As of March 31, 2012, federal savings banks are required to have an independent interest rate risk management process in place that measures both earnings and capital at risk.
 
Stress Testing.  Although the Dodd-Frank Act requires institutions with more than $10 billion in assets to conduct stress testing, the OCC expects every bank, regardless of its size or risk profile, to have an effective internal process to (1) assess its capital adequacy in relation to its overall risks at least annually, and (2) to plan for maintaining appropriate capital levels.  It is the OCC’s belief that stress testing permits community banks to identify their key vulnerabilities to market forces and assess how to effectively manage those risks should they emerge.  If stress testing results indicate that capital ratios could fall below the level needed to adequately support the bank’s overall risk profile, the OCC believes the bank’s board and management should take appropriate steps to protect the bank from such an occurrence, including establishing a plan that requires closer monitoring of market information, adjusting strategic and capital plans to mitigate risk, changing risk appetite and risk tolerance levels, limiting or stopping loan growth or adjusting the portfolio mix, adjusting underwriting standards, raising more capital and selling or hedging loans to reduce the potential impact from such stress events.
 
Assessments.  The Dodd-Frank Act provides that, in establishing the amount of an assessment, the Comptroller of the Currency may consider the nature and scope of the activities of the entity, the amount and type of assets it holds, the financial and managerial condition of the entity and any other factor that is appropriate. The Bank’s assessment (standard assessment) at September 30, 2016, was $297,540.

Basel III Capital Requirements.  2016 is the second year of implementation of the bank capital rules (the “Basel III Capital Rules”) adopted in July 2013 by our primary federal regulator, the Federal Reserve, and the Bank’s primary federal regulator, the OCC. The Basel III Capital Rules established a new comprehensive capital framework for U.S. banking organizations and generally implement the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s (the “Basel Committee”) December 2010 final capital framework referred to as “Basel III” for strengthening international capital standards.  The Basel III Capital Rules substantially increased the risk-based capital requirements applicable to bank holding companies and their depository institution subsidiaries, including us and the Bank. The Basel III Capital Rules became effective for us and the Bank on January 1, 2015, subject to phase-in periods for certain of their components and other provisions.


36


The Basel III Capital Rules established three components of regulatory capital: (1) common equity tier 1 capital (“CET1 Capital”), (2) additional tier 1 capital, and (3) tier 2 capital. Tier 1 capital is the sum of CET1 and additional tier 1 capital instruments meeting certain revised requirements. Total capital is the sum of tier 1 capital and tier 2 capital. Under the Basel III Capital Rules, for most banking organizations, the most common form of additional tier 1 capital is non-cumulative perpetual preferred stock and the most common form of tier 2 capital is subordinated notes and a portion of the allocation for loan and lease losses, in each case, subject to the Basel III Capital Rules’ specific requirements. CET1, tier 1 capital, and total capital serve as the numerators for three prescribed regulatory capital ratios. Risk-weighted assets, calculated using the standardized approach in the Basel III Capital Rules for us and the Bank, provide the denominator for such ratios. There is also a leverage ratio that compares tier 1 capital to average total assets.

Failure by our Company or Bank to meet minimum capital requirements set by the Basel III Capital Rules could result in certain mandatory and/or discretionary disciplinary actions by our regulators that could have a material adverse effect on our business and our consolidated financial position. Under the capital requirements and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, our Company and Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of our Company and Bank’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Our Company’s and Bank’s capital amounts and classifications are also subject to qualitative judgments by regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

Beginning January 1, 2016, we and the Bank became required to maintain a capital conservation buffer above the minimum risk-based capital requirements in order to avoid certain limitations on capital distributions, stock repurchases and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. The capital conservation buffer is exclusively composed of CET1 Capital, and it applies to each of the three risk-based capital ratios but not the leverage ratio. On January 1, 2016, our Company and Bank complied with the capital conservation buffer requirement, which increased the minimum requirement of the three risk-based capital ratios by 0.625% each year through 2019, at which point, the CET1 Capital risk-based, tier 1 risk-based and total risk-based capital ratios will be 7.0%, 8.5% and 10.5%, respectively.

The Basel III Capital Rules provide for a number of deductions from and adjustments to CET1 Capital.  These include, for example, the requirement that deferred tax assets arising from temporary differences that could not be realized through net operating loss carrybacks and significant investments in non-consolidated financial entities be deducted from CET1 Capital to the extent that any one such category exceeds 10% of CET1 or all such items, in the aggregate, exceed 15% of CET1 Capital.  See Note 13 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Pursuant to the Basel III Capital Rules, the effects of certain accumulated other comprehensive income or loss (“AOCI”) items are not excluded; however, “non-advanced approaches banking organizations,” including us and the Bank, may make a one-time permanent election to continue to exclude these items.  This election was made concurrently with the first filing of certain of our and the Bank’s periodic regulatory reports in the beginning of 2015 in order to avoid significant variations in the level of capital depending upon the impact of interest rate fluctuations on the fair value of their securities portfolio.  The Basel III Capital Rules also preclude certain hybrid securities, such as trust preferred securities issued prior to May 19, 2010, from inclusion in our Tier 1 capital, subject to grandfathering in the case of companies, such as us, that had less than $15 billion in total consolidated assets as of December 31, 2009.

Implementation of the deductions and other adjustments to CET1 Capital began on January 1, 2015, and are being phased in over a four-year period (beginning at 40% on January 1, 2015, and an additional 20% per year thereafter). The implementation of the capital conservation buffer began on January 1, 2016, at the 0.625% level and increase by 0.625% on each subsequent January 1, until it reaches 2.5% on January 1, 2019.

With respect to the Bank, the Basel III Capital Rules apply to and revised the “PCA” regulations adopted pursuant to Section 38 of the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, by: (i) introducing a CET1 Capital ratio requirement at each PCA category (other than critically undercapitalized), with the required CET1 Capital ratio being 6.5% for well-capitalized status; (ii) increasing the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio requirement for each category, with the minimum Tier 1 capital ratio for well-capitalized status being 8% (as compared to the previous 6%); and (iii) eliminating the provision that provides that a bank with a composite supervisory rating of 1 may have a 3% leverage ratio and still be adequately capitalized.  The Basel III Capital Rules did not change the total risk-based capital requirement for any PCA category.

The Basel III Capital Rules prescribe a standardized approach for risk weightings for a large and risk-sensitive number of categories, depending on the nature of the assets, generally ranging from 0% for U.S. Government and agency securities, to 600% for certain equity exposures, and resulting in high-risk weights for a variety of asset classes.

37



As of September 30, 2016, the Bank exceeded all of its regulatory capital requirements as showing in the table below and was designated as “well-capitalized” under federal guidelines.  The table below includes certain non-GAAP financial measures that are used by investors, analysts and bank regulatory agencies to assess the capital position of financial services companies.  Management reviews these measures along with other measures of capital as part of its financial analysis and has included this non-GAAP financial information, and the corresponding reconciliation to total equity.  See Note 13 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Regulatory Capital Data
 
Company (Actual)
 
Bank (Actual)
 
Minimum
Requirement For
Capital Adequacy
Purposes
 
Minimum Requirement
To Be Well Capitalized
Under Prompt
Corrective Action
Provisions
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
September 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tier 1 (core) capital (to adjusted total assets)
$
263,555

 
8.35
%
 
$
324,142

 
10.35
%
 
$
10,542

 
4.00
%
 
$
13,178

 
5.00
%
Common equity Tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)
255,543

 
17.28

 
324,142

 
21.95

 
11,499

 
4.50

 
16,610

 
6.50

Tier 1 (core) capital (to risk-weighted assets)
263,555

 
17.82

 
324,142

 
21.95

 
15,813

 
6.00

 
21,084

 
8.00

Total qualifying capital (to risk-weighted assets)
342,589

 
23.17

 
329,965

 
22.35

 
27,407

 
8.00

 
34,259

 
10.00

 
The following table provides a reconciliation of the amounts included in the table above.

38


 
Reconciliation:
 
Standardized Approach (1)
 
September 30, 2016
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
Total equity
$
334,975

Adjustments:
 

LESS: Goodwill, net of associated deferred tax liabilities
35,713

LESS: Certain other intangible assets
17,352

LESS: Net deferred tax assets from operating loss and tax credit carry-forwards
3,447

LESS: Net unrealized gains (losses) on available-for-sale securities
22,920

Common Equity Tier 1 (1)
255,543

Long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 1
10,310

LESS: Additional tier 1 capital deductions
2,298

Total Tier 1 capital
263,555

Allowance for loan losses
5,823

Subordinated debentures (net of issuance costs)
73,211

Total qualifying capital
342,589

(1) 
Capital ratios were determined using the Basel III Capital Rules that became effective on January 1, 2015. Among other changes, the Basel III Capital Rules revised the definition of capital, increased minimum capital ratios, and introduced a minimum CET1 Capital ratio; those changes are being fully phased in through the end of 2019.

Prompt Corrective Action.  Federal banking regulators are authorized and, under certain circumstances, required to take certain actions against banks that fail to meet their capital requirements.  Effective December 19, 1992, (and revised as described above) the federal banking agencies were given additional enforcement authority with respect to undercapitalized depository institutions.  Under the current regulations, an institution is deemed to be (a) “well-capitalized” if it has total risk-based capital of 10.0% or more, has a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or more, has a CET1 risk based capital ratio of 6.5% or more, and has leverage capital ratio of 5.0% or more and is not subject to any order or final capital directive to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure; (b) “adequately capitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% or more, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0% or more, a CET1 risk based capital ratio of 4.5% or more and has a leverage capital ratio of 4.0% or more (3.0% under certain circumstances) and does not meet the definition of well-capitalized; (c) “undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 8.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 6.0%, a CET1 capital ratio less than 4.5% or a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio that is less than 4.0%; (d) “significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 4.0%, a CET1 capital ratio less than 3% or a Tier 1 leverage capital ratio that is less than 3.0%; and (e) “critically undercapitalized” if it has a ratio of tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%.  In certain situations, a federal banking agency may reclassify a well-capitalized institution as adequately capitalized and may require an adequately capitalized or undercapitalized institution to comply with supervisory actions as if the institution were in the next lower category.

The federal banking agencies are generally required to take action to restrict the activities of an “undercapitalized,” “significantly undercapitalized” or “critically undercapitalized” bank.  Any such bank must submit a capital restoration plan that is guaranteed by the parent holding company and such holding company has provided appropriate assurances of performances.  Until such plan is approved, it may not increase its assets, acquire another institution, establish a branch or engage in any new activities, and generally may not make capital distributions.  The banking regulators are authorized to impose additional restrictions, discussed below, that are applicable to significantly undercapitalized institutions.
 






39


Adequately capitalized banks cannot normally pay dividends or make any capital contributions that would leave them undercapitalized; they cannot pay a management fee to a controlling person if, after paying the fee, they would be undercapitalized; and they cannot accept, renew or roll over any brokered deposit unless they have applied for and been granted a waiver by the FDIC.  The FDIC has defined the “national rate” for all interest-bearing deposits held by less-than-well-capitalized institutions as “a simple average of rates paid by all insured depository institutions and branches for which data are available” and has stated that its presumption is that this national rate is the prevailing rate in any market.  As such, less-than-well-capitalized institutions that are permitted to accept, renew or rollover brokered deposits via FDIC waiver generally may not pay an interest rate in excess of the national rate plus 75 basis points on such brokered deposits.
 
Undercapitalized banks may not accept, renew or rollover brokered deposits, and are subject to restrictions on the soliciting of deposits over prevailing rates.  In addition, undercapitalized banks are subject to certain regulatory restrictions.  These restrictions include, among others, that such a bank generally may not make any capital distributions, must submit an acceptable capital restoration plan to the FDIC, may not increase its average total assets during a calendar quarter in excess of its average total assets during the preceding calendar quarter unless any increase in total assets is consistent with a capital restoration plan approved by the FDIC and the bank’s ratio of equity to total assets increases during the calendar quarter at a rate sufficient to enable the bank to become adequately capitalized within a reasonable time.  In addition, such banks may not acquire a business, establish or acquire a branch office or engage in a new line of business without regulatory approval.  Further, as part of a capital restoration plan, the bank’s holding company must generally guarantee that the bank will return to adequately capitalized status and provide appropriate assurances of performance of that guarantee.  If a capital restoration plan is not approved, or if the bank fails to implement the plan in any material respect, the bank would be treated as if it were “significantly undercapitalized,” which would result in the imposition of a number of additional requirements and restrictions.  It should also be noted all FDIC-insured institutions are assigned an assessment risk category.  In general, weaker banks (those with a higher assessment risk category) are subject to higher assessments than stronger banks.  An adverse change in category can lead to materially higher expenses for insured institutions.  Finally, bank regulatory agencies have the ability to seek to impose higher than normal capital requirements known as individual minimum capital requirements (“IMCR”) for institutions with higher risk profiles.  If the Bank’s capital status – well-capitalized – changes as a result of future operations or regulatory order, or if it becomes subject to an IMCR, the Company’s financial condition or results of operations could be adversely affected.


40



Any institution that fails to comply with its capital plan or is “significantly undercapitalized” (i.e., Tier 1 risk-based ratio of less than 4% or CET1 risk-based or core capital ratios of less than 3% or a risk-based capital ratio of less than 6%) must be made subject to one or more of additional specified actions and operating restrictions mandated by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”).  These actions and restrictions include requiring the issuance of additional voting securities; limitations on asset growth; mandated asset reduction; changes in senior management; divestiture, merger or acquisition of the association; restrictions on executive compensation; and any other action the OCC deems appropriate.  An institution that becomes “critically undercapitalized” is subject to further mandatory restrictions on its activities in addition to those applicable to significantly undercapitalized associations.  In addition, the appropriate banking regulator must appoint a receiver (or conservator with the FDIC’s concurrence) for an institution, with certain limited exceptions, within 90 days after it becomes critically undercapitalized.  Any undercapitalized institution is also subject to other possible enforcement actions, including the appointment of a receiver or conservator.  The appropriate regulator is also generally authorized to reclassify an institution into a lower capital category and impose restrictions applicable to such category if the institution is engaged in unsafe or unsound practices or is in an unsafe or unsound condition.
 
The imposition of any of these measures on the Bank may have a substantial adverse effect on it and on the Company’s operations and profitability.  Meta Financial stockholders do not have preemptive rights and, therefore, if Meta Financial is directed by its regulators to issue additional shares of common stock, such issuance may result in the dilution in stockholders’ percentage of ownership of Meta Financial.
 
Institutions in Troubled Condition.  Certain events, including entering into a formal written agreement with a bank’s regulator that requires action to improve the bank’s financial condition, or simply being informed by the regulator that the bank is in troubled condition, will automatically result in limitations on so-called “golden parachute” agreements pursuant to Section 18(K) of the FDIA.  In addition, organizations that are not in compliance with minimum capital requirements, or are otherwise in a troubled condition, must give 90 days’ written notice before appointing a Director or Senior Executive Officer, pursuant to the OCC’s regulations.
 
Branching by Federal Savings Associations.  Subject to certain limitations, the HOLA and the OCC regulations permit federally chartered savings associations to establish branches in any state of the United States.  The authority to establish such branches is available if the law of the state in which the branch is located, or is to be located, would permit establishment of the branch if the savings association were a state savings association chartered by such state or if the association qualifies as a “domestic building and loan association” under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended, which imposes qualification requirements similar to those for a “qualified thrift lender” under the HOLA.  See “—Qualified Thrift Lender Test.”  The branching authority under the HOLA and the OCC regulations preempts any state law purporting to regulate branching by federal savings associations.
 
Standards for Safety and Soundness.  The federal banking agencies have adopted the Interagency Guidelines Establishing Standards for Safety and Soundness.  The guidelines establish certain safety and soundness standards for all depository institutions.  The operational and managerial standards in the guidelines generally relate to the following:  (1) internal controls and information systems; (2) internal audit systems; (3) loan documentation; (4) credit underwriting; (5) interest rate exposure; (6) asset growth; (7) compensation, fees and benefits; (8) asset quality; and (9) earnings.  Again, rather than providing specific rules, the guidelines set forth basic compliance considerations and guidance with respect to a depository institution.  Failure to meet the standards in the guidelines, however, could result in a request by the OCC to the Bank to provide a written compliance plan to demonstrate its efforts to come into compliance with such guidelines.

Civil Money Penalties. The OCC has the authority to assess civil money penalties (“CMPs”) against any national bank, federal savings bank or any of their institution-affiliated parties (“IAP”). In addition, the OCC has the authority to assess CMPs against bank service companies and service providers. CMPs may encourage an affected party to correct violations, unsafe or unsound practices or breaches of fiduciary duty. CMPs also serve as a deterrent to future violations of law, regulation, orders and other conditions. When determining CMP amounts, the OCC is required by statute to consider the following four factors: (1) the size and financial resources and good faith of the institution or IAP charged; (2) the gravity of the violation; (3) the history of previous violations; and (4) such other matters as justice may require. In addition to these factors there are other factors that the FFIEC has adopted that banking agencies should consider. If the Bank, the Company or any of its IAPs were to have CMPs imposed, such penalties could be material.






41


Limitations on Dividends and Other Capital Distributions.  Federal regulations govern the permissibility of capital distributions by a federal savings association.  Pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings associations that are part of a savings and loan holding company structure must now file a notice of a declaration of a dividend with the Federal Reserve at least 30 days before the proposed dividend declaration by the Bank’s board of directors.  In the case of cash dividends, OCC regulations require that federal savings associations that are subsidiaries of a stock savings and loan holding company must file an informational copy of that notice with the OCC at the same time the notice is filed with the Federal Reserve.  OCC regulations further set forth the circumstances under which a federal savings association is required to submit an application or notice before it may make a capital distribution.
 
A federal savings association proposing to make a capital distribution is required to submit an application to the OCC if:  the association does not qualify for expedited treatment pursuant to criteria set forth in OCC regulations; the total amount of all of the association’s capital distributions (including the proposed capital distribution) for the applicable calendar year exceeds the association’s net income for that year to date plus the association’s retained net income for the preceding two years; the association would not be at least adequately capitalized following the distribution; or the proposed capital distribution would violate a prohibition contained in any applicable statute, regulation or agreement between the association and the OCC or the Company’s and Bank’s former regulator, the OTS, or violate a condition imposed on the association in an application or notice approved by the OCC or the OTS.
 
A federal savings association proposing to make a capital distribution is required to submit a prior notice to the OCC if:  the association would not be well-capitalized following the distribution; the proposed capital distribution would reduce the amount of or retire any part of the association’s common or preferred stock or retire any part of debt instruments such as notes or subordinate debentures included in the association’s capital (other than regular payments required under a debt instrument); or the association is a subsidiary of a federally chartered mutual savings and loan holding company; however, where a savings association subsidiary of a stock savings and loan holding company is proposing to pay a cash dividend that does not require an application or a notice filing, only an informational filing is required.
 
Each of the Federal Reserve and OCC have primary reviewing responsibility for the applications or notices required to be submitted to them by savings associations relating to a proposed distribution.  The Federal Reserve may disapprove of a notice, and the OCC may disapprove of a notice or deny an application, if:
 
the savings association would be undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized or critically undercapitalized following the distribution;

the proposed distribution raises safety and soundness concerns; or

the proposed distribution violates a prohibition contained in any statute, regulation, enforcement action or agreement between the savings association (or its holding company, in the case of the Federal Reserve) and the entity’s primary federal regulator, or a condition imposed on the savings association (or its holding company, in the case of the Federal Reserve) in an application or notice approved by the entity’s primary federal regulator.

Under current regulations, the Bank is not permitted to pay dividends on its stock if its regulatory capital would fall below the amount required for the liquidation account established to provide a limited priority claim to the assets of the Bank to qualifying depositors at March 31, 1992, who continue to maintain deposits at the Bank after its conversion from a federal mutual savings and loan association to a federal stock savings bank pursuant to its Plan of Conversion adopted August 21, 1991.

During the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, the Bank paid no cash dividends to the Company, as the Company utilized existing cash holdings for payment of dividends to the Company’s stockholders and other holding company expenses.  The Company does not currently anticipate that it will need dividends from the Bank in order to fund dividends to the Company’s stockholders.  To declare a dividend under new rules adopted in 2015 by the OCC, an institution must file a notice with the OCC as an “eligible savings association” (as defined in the OCC’s regulations) if, among other things, it would not remain well-capitalized or would not be an eligible savings association upon the distribution.  An application to the OCC is required prior to a capital distribution if, among other things, a federal savings association is not an “eligible savings association.”  If neither of these are triggered, an institution does not need to file a notice or an application before declaring a dividend or otherwise making a capital distribution.
 




42


Qualified Thrift Lender Test.  All savings associations, including the Bank, are required to meet a qualified thrift lender (“QTL”) test to avoid certain restrictions on their operations.  This test requires a savings association to have at least 65% of its portfolio assets (as defined by regulation) in qualified thrift investments (primarily residential mortgages and related investments, including certain mortgage-backed securities) on a monthly average for nine out of every 12 months on a rolling basis or meet the requirements for a domestic building and loan association under the Internal Revenue Code.  Under either test, the required assets primarily consist of residential housing related to loans and investments.  At September 30, 2016, the Bank met the test and always has since its inception.
 
Any savings association that fails to meet the QTL test must convert to a national bank charter, unless it qualifies as a QTL within one year and thereafter remains a QTL, or limits its new investments and activities to those permissible for both a savings association and a national bank.  In addition, the association is subject to national bank limits for payment of dividends and branching authority.  If such association has not requalified or converted to a national bank within three years after the failure, it must divest all investments and cease all activities not permissible for a national bank.  The Bank currently meets its QTL requirement and expects to do so for the foreseeable future.
 
Community Reinvestment Act.  Under the Community Reinvestment Act (the “CRA”), the Bank is evaluated periodically by its primary federal banking regulator to determine if it is meeting its continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with its safe and sound operation to help meet the credit needs of its assessment areas, including low and moderate income neighborhoods.  The Bank received a “Satisfactory” rating during its most recent Performance Evaluation as an Intermediate Small Bank, dated October 16, 2013.  Due to its asset size, the Bank will be evaluated as a Large Bank in future CRA performance evaluations.  A copy of the Bank’s most recent Performance Evaluation is available as part of its Public File.
 
Volcker Rule.  On December 10, 2013, five financial regulatory agencies, including our primary federal regulators the Federal Reserve and the OCC, adopted final rules implementing the so-called Volcker Rule embodied in Section 13 of the Bank Holding Company Act (“BHCA”), which was added by Section 619 of the Dodd-Frank Act.  The final rules prohibit banking entities from (1) engaging in short-term proprietary trading for their own accounts and (2) having certain ownership interests in and relationships with hedge funds or private equity funds (“covered funds”).  The final rules are intended to provide greater clarity with respect to both the extent of those primary prohibitions and of the related exemptions and exclusions.  The final rules also require each regulated entity to establish an internal compliance program that is consistent with the extent to which it engages in activities covered by the Volcker Rule, which must include (for the largest entities) making regular reports about those activities to regulators.  Community and small banks, such as MetaBank, are afforded some relief under the final rules.  If such banks are engaged only in exempted proprietary trading, such as trading in U.S. Government, agency, state and municipal obligations, they are exempt entirely from compliance program requirements.  Moreover, even if a community or small bank engages in proprietary trading or covered fund activities under the rule, they need only incorporate references to the Volcker Rule into their existing policies and procedures.  The compliance date for banks to conform to the Volcker Rule was July 21, 2015, but the regulators have granted multiple extensions until July 21, 2017 for conformance of relationships with covered funds that existed prior to December 31, 2013 (in granting this last extension, the Federal Reserve noted that this is the final extension that will be granted in connection with such "legacy" covered funds).  Beginning June 30, 2014, banking entities with $50 billion or more in trading assets and liabilities were required to report quantitative metrics; on April 30, 2016, banking entities with at least $25 billion but less than $50 billion must report; and on December 31, 2016, banking entities with at least $10 billion but less than $25 billion must report.  The Company does not at this time expect the Volcker Rule to have a material impact on its operations.

Interstate Banking and Branching.  The FRB may approve an application of an adequately capitalized and adequately managed savings and loan holding company to acquire control of, or acquire all or substantially all of the assets of, a bank or savings association located in a state other than such holding company’s home state, without regard to whether the transaction is prohibited by the laws of any state.  In general, the FRB may not approve the acquisition of a bank that has not been in existence for the minimum time period (not exceeding five years) specified by the statutory law of the host state or if the applicant (and its depository institution affiliates) controls or would control more than 10% of the insured deposits in the United States or 30% or more of the deposits in the target bank’s home state or in any state in which the target bank maintains a branch.
 
The federal banking agencies are also generally authorized to approve interstate merger transactions without regard to whether such transaction is prohibited by the law of any state.  Interstate acquisitions of branches or the establishment of a new branch is permitted only if the law of the state in which the branch is located permits such acquisitions.  Interstate mergers and branch acquisitions are also subject to the nationwide and statewide insured deposit concentration amounts described above.  South Dakota permits interstate branching only by merger.
 




43


Transactions with Affiliates.  The Bank must comply with Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act relative to transactions with “affiliates,” generally defined to mean any company that controls or is under common control with the institution (as such, Meta Financial is an affiliate of the Bank for these purposes).  Transactions between an institution or its subsidiaries and its affiliates are required to be on terms as favorable to the Bank as terms prevailing at the time for transactions with non-affiliates.  In addition, certain transactions, such as loans to an affiliate, are restricted to a percentage of the institutions’ capital (e.g., the aggregate amount of covered transactions with any individual affiliate is limited to 10% of the capital and surplus of the institution; the aggregate amount of covered transactions with all affiliates is limited to 20% of the institution’s capital and surplus).  In addition, a savings and loan holding company may not lend to any affiliate engaged in activities not permissible for a savings and loan holding company or acquire the securities of most affiliates.  The OCC has the discretion to treat subsidiaries of savings institutions as affiliates on a case-by-case basis.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act also included specific changes to the law related to the definition of “covered transaction” in Sections 23A and 23B and limitations on asset purchases from insiders.  With respect to the definition of “covered transaction,” the Dodd-Frank Act now defines that term to include the acceptance of debt obligations issued by an affiliate as collateral for a bank’s loan or extension of credit to another person or company.  In addition, a “derivative transaction” with an affiliate is now deemed to be a “covered transaction” to the extent that such a transaction causes a bank or its subsidiary to have a credit exposure to the affiliate.  A separate provision of the Dodd-Frank Act states that an insured depository institution may not “purchase an asset from, or sell an asset to” a bank insider (or their related interests) unless (1) the transaction is conducted on market terms between the parties, and (2) if the proposed transaction represents more than 10% of the capital stock and surplus of the insured institution, it has been approved in advance by a majority of the institution’s non-interested directors.

Certain transactions with directors, officers or controlling persons are also subject to conflict of interest regulations.  These conflict of interest regulations and other statutes also impose restrictions on loans to such persons and their related interests.  Among other things, such loans must be made on terms substantially the same as for loans to unaffiliated individuals and must not create an abnormal risk of repayment or other unfavorable features for the Bank.
 
Federal Home Loan Bank System.  The Bank is a member of the FHLB of Des Moines, one of 11 regional FHLBs that administers the home financing credit function of savings associations that is subject to supervision and regulation by the Federal Housing Finance Agency.  All advances from the FHLB are required to be fully secured by sufficient collateral as determined by the FHLB.  In addition, all long-term advances must be used for residential home financing.
 
As members of the FHLB System, the Bank is required to purchase and maintain activity-based capital stock in the FHLB in the amount specified by the applicable Federal Home Loan Bank's capital plan. At September 30, 2016, the Bank had in the aggregate $47.5 million in FHLB stock, which was in compliance with the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines' requirement.  For the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, dividends paid by the FHLB to the Bank totaled $571,819.  In June 2015, the FHLB of Des Moines and the FHLB of Seattle merged into the FHLB of Des Moines.  Notably, pursuant to certain integration rules adopted by the OCC in 2015, federal savings associations are no longer required to become members of a Federal Home Loan Bank.
 
Under federal law, the FHLBs are required to provide funds for the resolution of troubled savings associations and to contribute to low and moderately priced housing programs through direct loans or interest subsidies on advances targeted for community investment and low- and moderate-income housing projects.  These contributions have affected adversely the level of FHLB dividends paid and could continue to do so in the future.  These contributions could also have an adverse effect on the value of FHLB stock in the future.  A reduction in value of the Bank’s FHLB stock may result in a corresponding reduction in the Bank’s capital.  In addition, the federal agency that regulates the FHLBs has required each FHLB to register its stock with the SEC, which has increased the costs of each FHLB and may have other effects that are not possible to predict at this time.
 
Federal Securities Law.  The common stock of Meta Financial is registered with the SEC under the Exchange Act, as amended.  Meta Financial is subject to the information, proxy solicitation, insider trading restrictions and other requirements under the Exchange Act.
 
Meta Financial’s stock held by persons who are affiliates (generally officers, directors and principal stockholders) of the Company may not be resold without registration unless sold in accordance with certain resale restrictions.  If Meta Financial meets specified current public information requirements, each affiliate of the Company, subject to certain requirements, will be able to sell, in the public market, without registration, a limited number of shares in any three-month period.
 




44


FDIC Deposit Classification Guidance
 
On January 5, 2015, the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) published initial industry guidance (the “Guidance”) in the form of Frequently Asked Questions with respect to the categorization of deposit liabilities as "brokered" deposits.  This guidance was later supplemented on November 13, 2015, and was finalized on June 30, 2016.  As of September 30, 2016, the Bank categorized $1.48 billion, or 63.2% of its deposit liabilities, as brokered deposits.
 
Due to the Bank’s status as a "well-capitalized" institution under the new Basel III Capital Rules, and further with respect to the Bank’s financial condition in general, the Company does not at this time anticipate that the Guidance will have a material adverse impact on the Company’s liquidity, statements of financial condition or results of operations going forward. However, should the Bank ever fail to be well-capitalized in the future as a result of not meeting the well-capitalized requirements or the imposition of an individual minimum capital requirement or a similar formal requirement, then, notwithstanding that the Bank has capital in excess of the well-capitalized minimum requirements, the Bank would be prohibited, absent waiver from the FDIC, from utilizing brokered deposits (i.e., no insured depository institution that is deemed to be less than “well-capitalized” may accept, renew or rollover brokered deposits absent a waiver from the FDIC).  In such event, unless the Bank were to receive a suitable waiver from the FDIC, such a result could produce serious material adverse consequences for the Bank with respect to liquidity and could also have serious material adverse effects on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.  Further, and in general, depending on the Bank’s condition in the future, the FDIC could increase the surcharge on our brokered deposits up to thirty basis points. The Company will monitor any future clarifications, rulings and interpretations, including whether institutions would be expected by the FDIC to amend prior call reports.  If we are required to amend previous call reports with respect to our level of brokered deposits, which the Company does not expect, or we are ever required to pay higher surcharge assessments with respect to these deposits, such payments could be material and therefore could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Holding Company Supervision & Regulation
 
We are a registered unitary savings and loan holding company, and as such we are subject to Federal Reserve examination, supervision, and certain reporting requirements.  In addition, the Federal Reserve has enforcement authority over us and any of our non-savings institution subsidiaries.  Among other things, this authority permits the Federal Reserve to restrict or prohibit activities that are determined to be a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of a subsidiary savings association.

The Federal Reserve has responsibility for the primary supervision and regulation of all savings and loan holding companies, including the Company.  In connection with its assumption of responsibility for the ongoing examination, supervision and regulation of savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve has published an interim final rule (“Regulation LL”, which, as of the date of this filing, has still not been adopted in final form) that provides for the corresponding transfer from the OTS to the Federal Reserve of the regulations necessary for the Federal Reserve to administer the statutes governing savings and loan holding companies.  Related to this authority, the Federal Reserve issued on November 7, 2014, a list identifying the supervisory guidance documents issued by it prior to July 21, 2011 that are now applicable to savings and loan holding companies such as the Company.  The FRB stated that, among other things, this list was part of their initiative to establish a savings and loan holding company supervisory program similar in nature to its “long-established supervisory program for bank holding companies.”

 
Restrictions Applicable to All Savings and Loan Holding Companies.
 
Federal law prohibits a savings and loan holding company, including us, directly or indirectly, from acquiring:
 
control (as defined under the HOLA) of another savings institution (or a holding company parent) without prior Federal Reserve approval;

through merger, consolidation or purchase of assets another savings institution or a holding company thereof, or acquiring all or substantially all of the assets of such institution (or a holding company) without prior Federal Reserve approval; or

control of any depository institution not insured by the FDIC (except through a merger with and into the holding company’s savings institution subsidiary that is approved by the Federal Reserve).

A savings and loan holding company may not acquire as a separate subsidiary an FDIC-insured institution that has a principal office outside of the state where the principal office of its subsidiary institution is located, except:
 

45


in the case of certain emergency acquisitions approved by the FDIC;

if such holding company controls a savings institution subsidiary that operated a home or branch office in such additional state as of March 5, 1987; or

if the laws of the state in which the savings institution to be acquired is located specifically authorize a savings institution chartered by that state to be acquired by a savings institution chartered by the state where the acquiring savings institution or savings and loan holding company is located, or by a holding company that controls such a state-chartered association.

The HOLA also prohibits a savings and loan holding company (directly or indirectly, or through one or more subsidiaries) from acquiring or retaining, with certain exceptions, more than 5% of the voting shares of a non‑subsidiary savings association, a non-subsidiary holding company or a non-subsidiary company engaged in activities other than those permitted by the HOLA.  In evaluating applications by holding companies to acquire savings associations, the Federal Reserve must consider the financial and managerial resources and future prospects of the company and institution involved, the effect of the acquisition on the risk to the DIF, the convenience and needs of the community and competitive factors.
 
Failure to Meet QTL Test.
 
If a banking subsidiary of a savings and loan holding company fails to meet the QTL test, the holding company must register with the FRB as a bank holding company within one year of the savings institution’s failure to comply.
 
Activities Restrictions.
 
Prior to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings and loan holding companies were generally permitted to engage in a wider array of activities than those permissible for their bank holding company counterparts and could have concentrations in real estate lending that are not typical for bank holding companies.  Section 606 of the Dodd-Frank Act amended the HOLA and requires that covered savings and loan holding companies (e.g., those that are not exempt from activities restrictions under the HOLA) that intend to engage in activities that are permissible only for a financial holding company under Section 4(k) of the BHCA do so only if the covered company meets all of the criteria to qualify as a financial holding company, and complies with all of the requirements applicable to a financial holding company as if the covered savings and loan holding company was a bank holding company.  Savings and loan holding companies engaging in new Section 4(k) activities permissible for bank holding companies will need to comply with notice and filing requirements of the Federal Reserve.
 
If the Federal Reserve believes that an activity of a savings and loan holding company or a non-bank subsidiary constitutes a serious risk to the financial safety, soundness or stability of a subsidiary savings association and is inconsistent with the principles of sound banking, the purposes of the HOLA or other applicable statutes, the Federal Reserve may require the savings and loan holding company to terminate the activity or divest control of the non-banking subsidiary.  This obligation is established in Section 10(g)(5) of the HOLA and bank holding companies are subject to equivalent obligations under the BHCA and the Federal Reserve’s Regulation Y.

Source of Strength and Capital Requirements.
 
The Dodd-Frank Act requires all companies, including savings and loan holding companies, that directly or indirectly control an insured depository institution to serve as a source of financial and managerial strength to its subsidiary savings associations; to date, however, specific regulations implementing this requirement have not been published.  Moreover, pursuant to the Dodd-Frank Act, savings and loan holding companies are generally subject to the same capital and activity requirements as those applicable to bank holding companies.
 
New rules promulgated by the Federal Reserve related to capital requirements that were required by the Dodd-Frank Act have also become effective. For a summary of the applicable changes, see “Risk Factors – Risks Related to Our Industry and Business.”
 








46


Examination.
 
The Federal Reserve has stated that it intends, to the greatest extent possible, taking into account any unique characteristics of savings and loan holding companies and the requirements of the HOLA, to assess the condition, performance and activities of savings and loan holding companies on a consolidated basis in a manner that is consistent with the Federal Reserve’s established risk-based approach regarding bank holding company supervision.  As with bank holding companies, the Federal Reserve’s objective will be to ensure that a savings and loan holding company and its non-depository subsidiaries are effectively supervised and can serve as a source of strength for, and do not threaten the soundness of, its subsidiary depository institution(s).
 
In accordance with its goal to assess the condition, performance and activities of savings and loan holding companies on a consolidated basis in a manner that is consistent with the Federal Reserve’s established risk-based approach regarding bank holding company supervision, the Federal Reserve announced in 2013 that it will continue to use “RFI/C(D)” rating system (commonly referred to as “RFI”) to assign indicative ratings to such companies.  Further, on November 7, 2014, the Federal Reserve announced that it will soon issue a notice seeking public comment on the application of the RFI rating system for Savings and Loan Holding Companies.  In addition, in late 2013, the Federal Reserve announced that, with respect to savings and loan holding companies with less than $10 billion in assets (like the Company), such companies’ inspection frequency and scope requirements will be the same as those for bank holding companies of the same asset size.  The FRB will also determine whether or not a savings and loan holding company is “complex” as determined by certain factors enumerated by the Federal Reserve.  According to the Federal Reserve, with respect to institutions with less than $10 billion in assets (such as the Company), the determination of whether a holding company is "complex" versus "noncomplex" is made at least annually on a case-by-case basis taking into account and weighing a number of considerations, such as: the size and structure of the holding company; the extent of intercompany transactions between insured depository institution subsidiaries and the holding company or uninsured subsidiaries of the holding company; the nature and scale of any non-bank activities, including whether the activities are subject to review by another regulator and the extent to which the holding company is conducting Gramm-Leach-Bliley authorized activities (e.g., insurance, securities, merchant banking); whether risk management processes for the holding company are consolidated; and whether the holding company has material debt outstanding to the public.  As of the date of this filing, the FRB has not advised the Company that it is complex.
 
Change of Control.
 
The federal banking laws require that appropriate regulatory approvals must be obtained before an individual or company may take actions to “control” a bank or savings association.  The definition of control found in the HOLA is similar to that found in the BHCA for bank holding companies.  Both statutes apply a similar three-prong test for determining when a company controls a bank or savings association.  Specifically, a company has control over either a bank or savings association if the company:

(1)directly or indirectly or acting in concert with one or more persons, owns, controls or has the power to vote 25% or more of the voting securities of a company;

(2)controls in any manner the election of a majority of the directors (or any individual who performs similar functions in respect of any company, including a trustee under a trust) of the board; or

(3)directly or indirectly exercises a controlling influence over the management or policies of the bank.

Regulation LL, the interim final rule discussed above, implements the HOLA to govern the operations of savings and loan holding companies. Regulation LL includes a specific definition of “control” similar to the statutory definition, with certain additional provisions.  Additionally, Regulation LL modifies the regulations previously used by the OTS for purposes of determining when a company or natural person acquires control of a savings association or savings and loan holding company under the HOLA or the Change in Bank Control Act (“CBCA”).  In light of the similarity between the statutes governing bank holding companies and savings and loan holding companies, the Federal Reserve proposed to use its established rules and processes with respect to control determinations under the HOLA and the CBCA to ensure consistency between equivalent statutes administered by the same agency.
 
The Federal Reserve stated in connection with its issuance of Regulation LL that it will review investments and relationships with savings and loan holding companies by companies using the current practices and policies applicable to bank holding companies to the extent possible.  Overall, the indicia of control used by the Federal Reserve under the BHCA to determine whether a company has a controlling influence over the management or policies of a banking organization (which, for Federal Reserve purposes, will now include savings associations and savings and loan holding companies) are similar to the control factors found in OTS regulations.  However, the OTS rules weighed these factors somewhat differently and used a different review process designed to be more mechanical.

47


 
Among the differences highlighted by the Federal Reserve with respect to OTS procedures on determinations of control, the Federal Reserve noted that it does not limit its review of companies with the potential to have a controlling influence to the two largest stockholders.  Specifically, the Federal Reserve reviews all investors based on all of the facts and circumstances to determine if a controlling influence is present.
 
Moreover, unlike the OTS control rules, the Federal Reserve does not have a separate application process for rebutting control under the BHCA and Regulation LL does not include such a process.  Under the former OTS rules, investors that triggered a control factor under the rules could submit an application to the OTS requesting a determination that they have successfully rebutted control under the HOLA.  This separate application process is not available under Regulation LL.  Given that Federal Reserve practice is to consider potential control relationships for all investors in connection with applications submitted under the BHCA, the Federal Reserve will review potential control relationships for all investors in connection with applications submitted to the Federal Reserve under Section 10(e) or 10(o) of the HOLA.  The Federal Reserve may obtain a series of passivity commitments from investors seeking to purchase in excess of 5% of the issued and outstanding common stock of savings and loan holding companies and bank holding companies.

Federal and State Taxation
 
Federal and State Taxation.  Meta Financial and its subsidiaries file a consolidated federal and various consolidated state income tax returns.  Additionally, Meta Financial or its subsidiaries file separate company income tax returns in states where required.  All returns are filed on a fiscal year basis using the accrual method of accounting.  We monitor relevant tax authorities and change our estimate of accrued income tax due to changes in income or franchise tax laws and their interpretation by the courts and regulatory authorities.  In addition to the regular income tax, corporations, including savings banks such as the Bank, generally are subject to a minimum tax.  An alternative minimum tax is imposed at a minimum tax rate of 20% on alternative minimum taxable income, which is the sum of a corporation’s regular taxable income (with certain adjustments) and tax preference items, less any available exemption.  The alternative minimum tax is imposed to the extent it exceeds the corporation’s regular income tax and net operating losses can offset no more than 90% of alternative minimum taxable income.
 
To the extent earnings appropriated to a savings bank’s bad debt reserves and deducted for federal income tax purposes exceed the allowable amount of such reserves computed under the experience method and to the extent of the bank’s supplemental reserves for losses on loans (“Excess”), such Excess may not, without adverse tax consequences, be utilized for the payment of cash dividends or other distributions to a stockholder (including distributions on redemption, dissolution or liquidation) or for any other purpose (except to absorb bad debt losses).  As of September 30, 2016, the Bank’s Excess for tax purposes totaled approximately $6.7 million.
 
Competition
 
The Company’s Retail Banking operation faces strong competition, both in originating real estate and other loans and in attracting deposits.  Competition in originating real estate loans comes primarily from commercial banks, savings banks, credit unions, captive finance companies, insurance companies and mortgage bankers making loans secured by real estate located in the Company’s market area.  Commercial banks and credit unions provide vigorous competition in consumer lending.  The Company competes for real estate and other loans principally on the basis of the quality of services it provides to borrowers, interest rates and loan fees it charges, and the types of loans it originates.
 
The Company’s Retail Banking operation attracts deposits through its Retail Banking offices, primarily from the communities in which those Retail Banking offices are located; therefore, competition for those deposits is principally from other commercial banks, savings banks, credit unions and brokerage offices located in the same communities.  The Company competes for these deposits by offering a variety of deposit accounts at competitive rates, convenient business hours and convenient branch locations with interbranch deposit and withdrawal privileges at each.
 
The Company’s MPS division serves customers nationally and also faces strong competition from large commercial banks and specialty providers of electronic payments processing and servicing, including prepaid, debit and credit card issuers, Automated Clearing House (“ACH”) processors and ATM network sponsors.  Many of these national players are aggressive competitors, leveraging relationships and economies of scale.
 
It is also expected that the Bank will experience strong competition for its AFS/IBEX division with respect to financing insurance premiums and for its Refund Advantage business with respect to tax return processing services.



48


Employees
 
At September 30, 2016, the Company and its subsidiaries had a total of 672 full-time equivalent employees, an increase of 34 employees, or 5.3%, from September 30, 2015.  The Company’s employees are not represented by any collective bargaining group.  Management considers its employee relations to be good.
 
Executive Officers of the Company Who Are Not Directors
 
The following information as to the business experience during the past five years is provided with respect to the executive officers of the Company who are not serving on the Company’s Board of Directors.  There are no arrangements or understandings between such person named and any persons pursuant to which such officer was selected.
 

Mr. Glen W. Herrick, age 54, is Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of the Company after being appointed to the position effective October 1, 2013.  Additionally, Mr. Herrick is a member of the Executive Committees for both the Company and the Bank.  Mr. Herrick previously served as SVP of Finance and Investment Management of the Company.  Mr. Herrick joined the Company in March 2013 following 19 years of various finance, accounting and risk management roles at Wells Fargo & Company, including serving as CFO of Wells Fargo’s student loan division.  Before joining Wells Fargo, Mr. Herrick worked at Ingersoll-Rand Company after serving as a Captain in the United States Army.  Mr. Herrick has a B.S. in Engineering Management from the United States Military Academy at West Point and an MBA from the University of South Dakota.  In addition, he is a graduate of the Stonier Graduate School of Banking.


Ms. Cindy Smith, age 57, is Executive Vice President and Chief Operating Officer of the Company after being appointed to the position effective September 9, 2016. Ms. Smith brings more than 25 years of banking and payments industry experience to her position. She previously held senior executive positions at Zions Bancorporation, a regional bank holding company headquartered in Salt Lake City, UT. Before working at Zions Bancorporation, Cindy was an executive with U.S. Bank. In 2008, she was named by American Banker as one of the "Top 25 Most Powerful Women in Banking". Cindy has an MBA from Lansbridge University and a Masters in Management from the American Graduate School of Management.

Ms. Sonja A. Theisen, age 35, is Senior Vice President and Chief Accounting Officer of the Company after being appointed to the position effective August 3, 2015.  Ms. Theisen previously served as Senior Vice President and Controller of the Company and MetaBank, positions Ms. Theisen held since December 2013. Prior to joining the Company in December 2013, Ms. Theisen served as the Senior Vice President and Head of Finance Operations for Great Western Bancorp Inc., a bank holding company for Great Western Bank, from November 2010 to December 2013, and as Audit Manager for Eide Bailly LLP, a certified public accounting and business advisory firm, from May 2010 to November 2010 and for KPMG LLP, an audit, tax and advisory firm, from January 2004 to May 2010. Ms. Theisen has a B.A. degree in Accounting and a Master of Professional Accountancy from the University of South Dakota and is a Certified Public Accountant.
 
Item 1A.    Risk Factors

Factors that, individually or in the aggregate, we think could cause our actual results to differ materially from expected and historical results include those described below as well as other risks and factors identified from time to time in our SEC filings.  The Company’s business could be harmed by any of these risks, as well as other risks that we have not identified.  The trading price of the Company’s common stock could decline due to any of these risks, and you may lose all or part of your investment.  In assessing these risks, you should also refer to the other information contained in this annual report on Form 10-K, including the Company’s financial statements and related notes.













49


Risks Related to Our Industry and Business
 
Our growth has been robust, and failure to generate sufficient capital to support anticipated growth could cause us difficulty in maintaining regulatory capital compliance and meeting our capital requirements, and adversely affect our earnings and prospects.
 
The Company has recently experienced considerable growth, having increased its assets from $2.53 billion at September 30, 2015 to $4.01 billion at September 30, 2016.  Funded primarily by growth of low- and no-cost deposits, the proceeds thereof have been invested primarily in loans, municipal bonds, mortgage-backed securities (“MBS”) and investment securities available for sale.  The Company’s asset growth, if continued as expected, will generate a need for higher levels of capital which management believes may not be met through earnings retention alone. Additionally, our asset mix is changing as we increase commercial and consumer loans, especially in our new divisions; such loans carry risk weights far in excess of traditional one- to four- family loans, and as a result it will be more difficult to maintain regulatory capital compliance. (In that respect, in August 2016, the Company announced it had completed the public offering of $75 million of its 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures due August 15, 2026. The proceeds of the offering, approximately $73.9 million, qualify as Tier 2 capital for regulatory purposes at the Company level, and as Tier 1 capital as invested by the Company in the Bank. In addition, the Company privately placed 266,430 shares of common stock to several institutional investors during fiscal 2016.) There can be no assurance, however, that the Company will be able to continue to access sources of capital, private or public.  Failure to remain well-capitalized, or to attain potentially even higher levels of capitalization that are or will be required in the future under regulatory initiatives mandated by Congress, our regulatory agencies, or under the Basel accords, could adversely affect the Company’s earnings and prospects.
 
We may have difficulty continuing to grow, and even if we do grow, our growth may strain our resources and limit our ability to expand our operations successfully.
 
As described above, we have experienced significant growth in the amount of our assets; this is also the case with the level of our deposits.  Our future profitability will depend in part on our continued ability to grow in both these categories; however, we may not be able to sustain our historical growth rate or be able to grow at all.  In addition, our future success will depend on competitive factors and on the ability of our senior management to continue to maintain a robust system of internal controls and procedures and manage a growing number of customer relationships.  We may not be able to implement changes or improvements to these internal controls and procedures in an efficient or timely manner and may discover deficiencies in existing systems and controls.  Consequently, continued growth, if achieved, may place a strain on our operational infrastructure, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 

Our loan portfolio has grown substantially, and our underwriting practices may not prevent future losses in our loan portfolio.
 
Over the last several fiscal years, our loan portfolio has grown substantially with new loan originations.  Our underwriting practices are designed to mitigate risk by adhering to specific loan parameters.  Components of our underwriting program include, where appropriate, an analysis of the borrower and their creditworthiness, a financial statement review, and, if applicable, cash flow projections and a valuation of collateral. Other lending programs, particularly in the Bank's divisions, rely on experience and quantitative data. While the Company believes its asset quality to be good in comparison to most banking institutions, we may incur losses in our loan portfolio, especially the new portions thereof, if our underwriting criteria fail to identify credit risks.  It is also possible that losses will exceed the amounts the Bank has set aside for loss reserves and result in reduced interest income and increased provision for loan losses, which could have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Deterioration in our loan portfolio could also cause a decrease in our capital, which would make it more difficult to maintain regulatory capital compliance.

Our lending operations are concentrated in Iowa and South Dakota.
 
Our Retail Bank lending activities are largely based in Iowa and South Dakota.  As a result, and notwithstanding lending in our AFS/IBEX division and expected lending in our Refund Advantage division, our financial performance depends to a large degree on the economic conditions in these areas.  If local economic conditions worsen it could cause us to experience an increase in the number of borrowers who default on their loans along with a reduction in the value of the collateral securing such loans, which could decrease our capital and have an adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations. Lending by AFS/IBEX is concentrated in California, Texas and Florida, while lending by our Refund Advantage division is nationwide.
 




50


Economic and market conditions have adversely affected our industry and regulatory costs have increased.
 
Over the last few fiscal years, general economic trends, low national economic growth and reduced availability of commercial credit have negatively impacted the credit performance of commercial and consumer credit in general.  While the situation has improved somewhat over the last two fiscal years, this has led to increased commercial and consumer deficiencies, lack of customer confidence, increased market volatility and widespread reduction in general business activity.  The resulting economic pressure on consumers and businesses and the lack of confidence in the financial markets may adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and stock price.  A worsening of these conditions would likely exacerbate the adverse effects of these difficult market conditions on us and others in the financial institutions industry.  In particular, we may face the following risks in connection with these events:
 
We have faced increased regulation of our industry.  Although it is possible that the effect of the recent elections may curtail such events, compliance with existing and expected regulations may increase our costs and limit our ability to pursue business opportunities;

Customer demand for loans secured by real estate could be reduced due to weaker economic conditions, an increase in unemployment, a decrease in real estate values or an increase in interest rates;

The process we use to estimate losses inherent in our credit exposure requires difficult, subjective and complex judgments, including forecasts of economic conditions, and whether economic conditions might impair the ability of our borrowers to repay their loans.  The level of uncertainty concerning economic conditions may adversely affect the accuracy of our estimates which may, in turn, impact the reliability of the process.  Further, a new method of determining loan loss allowances, expected to be implemented in fiscal year 2020, could decrease our profitability.

The value of the portfolio of investment securities that we hold, and which constitute a large percentage of our assets, may be adversely affected; and

If we experience financial setbacks or other regulatory action in the future, we may be required to pay significantly higher FDIC insurance premiums than we currently pay due, in part, to our significant level of brokered deposits.  See “– Regulation.”

The full impact of the Dodd-Frank Act is still unknown.
 
While regulatory agencies have made considerable progress in implementing the Dodd-Frank Act, the full compliance burden and impact on our operations and profitability are still not fully known.  Hundreds of new federal regulations, studies and reports were required under the Dodd-Frank Act and not all of them have been finalized; some rules and policies will be further developing for months and years to come.  Based on the provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act that have already been implemented as well as anticipated regulations, and notwithstanding the recent election results of 2016, it is likely that banks and thrifts as well as their holding companies will continue to be subject to regulation and compliance obligations that expose us to higher costs as well as noncompliance risk and consequences.

The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau is reshaping the consumer financial laws through rulemaking and enforcement of prohibitions against unfair, deceptive or abusive practices, which may directly impact the business operations of depository institutions offering consumer financial products or services, including the Bank.
 
The Bureau has broad rulemaking authority to administer and carry out the purposes and objectives of “federal consumer financial laws, and to prevent evasions thereof” with respect to all financial institutions that offer financial products and services to consumers.  The Bureau is also authorized to prescribe rules, applicable to any covered person or service provider, identifying and prohibiting acts or practices that are “unfair, deceptive, or abusive” in connection with any transaction with a consumer for a consumer financial product or service, or the offering of a consumer financial product or service (“UDAAP authority”).  The term “abusive” is new and developing and because Bureau officials have indicated that compliance will be achieved through enforcement actions rather than the issuance of regulations, we cannot predict to what extent the Bureau’s future actions will have on the banking industry or the Company.  Notwithstanding that insured depository institutions with assets of $10 billion or less (such as the Bank) will continue to be supervised and examined by their primary federal regulators, the full reach and impact of the Bureau’s broad new rulemaking powers and UDAAP authority on the operations of financial institutions offering consumer financial products or services are currently unknown.
 


51


In addition to taking many enforcement actions and finalizing regulation covering prepaid payments, described below, the Bureau finalized its ability to repay (“ATR”) rule as well as its qualified mortgage rule in January 2013.  The ATR rule applies to residential mortgage loan applications received after January 10, 2014.  The scope of the rule specifically applies to loans securing one-to-four unit dwellings and includes purchases, refinances and home equity loans for principal or second homes.  Under the ATR rules, a lender may not make a residential mortgage loan unless the lender makes a reasonable and good faith determination that is based on verified, documented information at or before consummation that the borrower has a reasonable ability to repay.  The eight underwriting factors that must be considered and verified include the following: (1) income and assets: (2) employment status; (3) monthly payment of loan; (4) monthly payment of any simultaneous loan secured by the same property; (5) monthly payment for other mortgage-related obligations like property taxes and insurance; (6) current debt obligations; (7) monthly debt to income ratio; and (8) credit history (although eight factors are delineated, the ATR rule does not dictate that a lender follow a particular underwriting model).  Liability for violations of the ATR rule include actual damages, statutory damages, court costs and attorneys’ fees.
 
Additionally, the Bureau published regulations required by the Dodd-Frank Act related to “qualified mortgages,” which are mortgages for which there is a presumption that the lender has satisfied the ATR rules.  Pursuant to Dodd-Frank, qualified mortgages (“QMs”) must have certain product-feature prerequisites and affordability underwriting requirements.  Generally, to meet the QM test, the lender must calculate the  monthly payments based on the highest payment that will apply in the first five years and the consumer must have a total debt-to-income ratio that is less than or equal to 43%.  The QM rule provides a safe harbor for lenders that make loans that satisfy the definition of a QM and are not higher priced.  With respect to higher-priced mortgage loans, there is a rebuttable presumption of compliance available to the lender with respect to compliance with the ATR rule.
 
With respect to final regulations that affect insured depository institutions such as the Bank, the Bureau also issued a final rule related to international remittances, which covers entities that provide at least 100 remittance transfers per calendar year.  As such, the Bank became subject to the rule.  The Bank has implemented a compliance solution.

Our most recent CRA rating was “Satisfactory.”  A less than “Satisfactory” CRA rating could have a negative effect on the OCC’s review of certain banking applications.
 
Under the CRA, the Bank is evaluated periodically by its primary federal banking regulator to determine if it is meeting its continuing and affirmative obligation consistent with its safe and sound operation to help meet the credit needs of its entire community, including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods.  In the Bank’s most recent CRA examination dated October 16, 2013, the Bank received an overall rating of “Satisfactory.”  If the Bank were to receive a future CRA rating of less than “Satisfactory,” the CRA requires the OCC to take such rating into account in considering an application for any of the following:  (i) the establishment of a domestic branch; (ii) the relocation of its main office or of a branch; (iii) the merger or consolidation with or acquisition of assets or assumption of liabilities of an insured depository institution; or (iv) the conversion of the Bank to a national charter.
 
Legislative and regulatory initiatives taken to date may not achieve their intended objective; Capital ratios.
 
Under the Basel III Capital Rules, minimum requirements have increased for both the quantity and quality of capital held by banking organizations. The Basel III Capital Rules include a new minimum ratio of CET1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 4.5% and a CET1 capital conservation buffer of which is .0625% for 2016, rising to 2.5% of risk-weighted assets for 2019 and later years. The Rules also impose a minimum ratio of tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets of 6% and includes a minimum leverage ratio (tier 1 capital to average total assets) of 4% for all banking organizations. The Rules also emphasize CET1 Capital and implement strict eligibility criteria for regulatory capital instruments. The minimum total capital ratio remains at 8% but the general PCA framework has been changed to incorporate these increased minimum requirements. The Basel III Capital Rules phase-in period for smaller, less complex banking organizations like the Company and the Bank began in January 2015. The phase-in will gradually increase capital requirements for the Company and the Bank, making compliance and future growth more difficult to achieve. Should the Company or the Bank not meet the requirements of the Basel III Capital Rules, including the application of well-capitalized levels in connection with such rules, the Company and the Bank would be subject to adverse regulatory action by our regulators, which action could result in material adverse consequences for us, the Bank, and our shareholders.
 

52


We have a concentration of our assets in mortgage-backed securities and municipal securities.
 
As of September 30, 2016, approximately 17.3% of the Bank’s assets were invested in mortgage‑backed securities, compared to 25.4% at September 30, 2015.  The Company’s mortgage-backed and related securities portfolio consists primarily of securities issued by U.S. Government instrumentalities, including those of Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac which are in conservatorship.  The Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac certificates are modified pass-through mortgage-backed securities that represent undivided interests in underlying pools of fixed-rate, or certain types of adjustable-rate, predominantly single-family and, to a lesser extent, multi-family residential mortgages issued by these U.S. Government instrumentalities.  Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac generally provide the certificate holder a guarantee of timely payments of interest, whether or not collected.  Privately issued mortgage pass‑through certificates generally provide no guarantee as to timely payment of interest or principal, and reliance is placed on the creditworthiness of the issuer.

Mortgage-backed securities generally increase the quality of the Company’s assets by virtue of the insurance or guarantees that back them, are more liquid than individual mortgage loans and may be used to collateralize borrowings or other obligations of the Company.
 
The prepayment risk associated with mortgage-backed securities is monitored periodically, and prepayment rate assumptions adjusted as appropriate to update the Company’s mortgage-backed securities accounting and asset/liability reports.  Nonetheless, while mortgage-backed securities carry a reduced credit risk as compared to whole loans, such securities remain subject to some credit risk, and to the risk that a fluctuating interest rate environment, along with other factors such as the geographic distribution of the underlying mortgage loans, as well as other risks, may alter the prepayment rate of such mortgage loans and so affect both the prepayment speed, and value, of such securities.
 
As of September 30, 2016, approximately 29.6% of the Bank’s assets were invested in municipal securities, compared to approximately 35.1% at September 30, 2015.  As of September 30, 2016, 29.1% of the 29.6% of the Bank’s assets invested in municipal securities were non-bank qualified obligations.  These bonds are issued in larger denominations than bank qualified obligations, which allows for the purchase of larger blocks.  These larger blocks of municipal bonds are typically issued in larger denominations by well-known issuers with reputable reporting and in turn, tend to be more liquid, which helps reduce price risk.  Furthermore, approximately 2% of these municipal securities are backed by and convertible into Agency mortgage backed security pools upon the Company’s request.  Lastly, the largest exposure to any one direct municipality, when excluding municipal bonds backed by or convertible into Agency mortgage backed securities, represented approximately 0.3% of the Bank’s assets as of September 30, 2016.
 
The Company believes these municipal securities generally increase the quality of the Bank’s assets by virtue of the high credit quality of the Bank’s municipal holdings and the low historical loss rates and elevated recovery rates associated with these types of securities with corresponding credit quality.  Nonetheless, while these municipal securities carry a reduced credit risk as compared to whole loans, such securities remain subject to the risk that a fluctuating interest rate environment may alter the value of the securities.
 
In the past, we have recorded other-than-temporary impairment (“OTTI”) charges in our trust preferred securities (“TRUPS”) portfolio in the past, and we could record additional losses in the future.
 
We determine the fair value of our investment securities based on GAAP and three levels of informational inputs that may be used to measure fair value.  The price at which a security may be sold in a market transaction could be significantly lower than the quoted market price for the security, particularly if the quoted market price is based on infrequent trading history, the market for the security is illiquid or a significant amount of securities are being sold.  In fiscal 2016, 2015 and 2014, there were no other‑than-temporary impairments recorded.
 
The valuation of our TRUPS, the total of which was $13.0 million at September 30, 2016, will continue to be influenced by external market and other factors, including implementation of SEC and Financial Accounting Standards Board guidance on fair value accounting, the financial condition of specific issuers’ deferral and default rates of specific issuer financial institutions, rating agency actions and the prices at which observable market transactions occur.  If we are required to record additional OTTI charges on our TRUPS portfolio, we could experience potentially significant earnings losses as well as a material adverse impact on our capital position.


53


Risks Related to the Banking Industry
 
Our reputation and business could be damaged by negative publicity.
 
Reputational risk, or the risk to our business, earnings and capital from negative publicity, is inherent in our business.  Negative publicity can result from actual or alleged conduct in a number of areas, including legal and regulatory compliance, lending practices, corporate governance, litigation, inadequate protection of customer data, ethical behavior of our employees and from actions taken by regulators and others as a result of that conduct.  Damage to our reputation could impact our ability to attract new and maintain existing loan and deposit customers, employees and business relationships, and, particularly with respect to our MPS division, could result in the imposition of new regulatory requirements, operational restrictions, enhanced supervision and/or civil money penalties.  Such damage could also adversely affect our ability to raise additional capital.  If any of these measures should be imposed in the future, they could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
We are subject to certain operational risks, including, but not limited to, data processing system failures, errors, breaches and customer or employee fraud.
 
There have been a number of publicized cases involving errors, fraud or other misconduct by employees of financial services firms in recent years.  Misconduct by our employees could include hiding unauthorized activities from us, improper or unauthorized activities on behalf of our customers or improper use of confidential information.  Employee fraud, errors and employee and customer misconduct could subject us to financial losses or regulatory sanctions and seriously harm our reputation.  It is not always possible to prevent employee errors and misconduct, and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases.  Employee errors could also subject us to civil claims for negligence.
 
Although we maintain a system of internal controls and procedures designed to reduce the risk of loss from employee or customer fraud or misconduct and employee errors as well as insurance coverage to mitigate against operational risks, including data processing system failures and errors and customer or employee fraud, these internal controls may fail to prevent or detect such an occurrence, or such an occurrence may not be insured or exceed applicable insurance limits.
 
In addition, there have also been a number of cases where financial institutions have been the victim of fraud related to unauthorized wire and automated clearinghouse transactions.  The facts and circumstances of each case vary but generally involve criminals posing as customers (i.e., stealing bank customers’ identities) to transfer funds out of the institution quickly in an effort to place the funds beyond recovery prior to detection.  Although we have policies and procedures in place to verify the authenticity of our customers and prevent identity theft, we can provide no assurances that these policies and procedures will prevent all fraudulent transfers.  In addition, although we have safeguards in place, it is possible that our computer systems could be infiltrated by hackers or other intruders.  We can provide no assurances that these safeguards will prevent all unauthorized infiltrations or breaches.  Identity theft, successful unauthorized intrusions and similar unauthorized conduct could result in reputational damage and financial losses to the Company.  See “Item 7.  Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

Changes in economic and political conditions could adversely affect the Company’s earnings, as the Company’s borrowers’ ability to repay loans and the value of the collateral securing the Company’s loans decline.
 
The Company’s success depends, to a certain extent, upon economic and political conditions, local and national, as well as governmental monetary policies.  Conditions such as inflation, recession, unemployment, changes in interest rates, money supply and other factors beyond the Company’s control may adversely affect the Company’s asset quality, deposit levels, products and loan demand and, therefore, the Company’s earnings.  Because the Company has a significant amount of real estate loans, decreases in real estate values could adversely affect the value of property used as collateral.  Among other things, adverse changes in the economy may also have a negative effect on the ability of the Company’s borrowers to make timely repayments of their loans, which would have an adverse impact on the Company’s earnings.  In addition, at the present, the vast majority of the Company’s loans are to individuals and businesses in the Company’s market area.  Consequently, any economic decline in the Company’s market area could have an adverse impact on the Company’s earnings. Further, we anticipate making a large amount of no-interest, 0% APR tax refund loans during the 2017 tax season in connection with various program agreements with national tax preparation companies. Although we have developed policies and procedures related to the underwriting and making of these loans, this is still a relatively new business line for us, and unexpected events could cause unanticipated losses or issues related to such loans.
 




54


Changes in interest rates could adversely affect the Company’s results of operations and financial condition.
 
The Company’s earnings depend substantially on the Company’s interest rate spread, which is the difference between (i) the rates we earn on loans, securities and other earning assets, and (ii) the interest rates we pay on deposits and other borrowings.  These rates are highly sensitive to many factors beyond the Company’s control, including general economic conditions and the policies of various governmental and regulatory authorities.  As market interest rates rise, we will have competitive pressures to increase the rates we pay on deposits, especially at our Retail Bank, which may result in a decrease of the Company’s net interest income.  Conversely, if interest rates fall, yields on loans and investments may fall.  Although the Bank continues to monitor its interest rate risk exposure and has undertaken additional analyses and implemented additional controls to improve its core earnings from interest income, the Bank can provide no assurance that its efforts will appropriately protect the Bank in the future from interest rate risk exposure.  For additional information, see Part II, Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.”
 
The Company operates in a highly regulated environment, and changes in laws and regulations to which we are subject may adversely affect the Company’s results of operations.
 
The Company and the Bank operate in a highly regulated environment and are subject to extensive regulation, supervision and examination by the OCC and the Federal Reserve.  In addition, the Bank is subject to regulation by the FDIC and the Bureau.  See Item 1 “Business – Regulation” herein.  Applicable laws and regulations may change and the enforcement of existing laws and regulations may vary when actions are evaluated by these regulators, and there is no assurance that such changes will not adversely affect the Company’s business.  Regulatory authorities have extensive discretion in connection with their supervisory and enforcement activities, including but not limited to the imposition of restrictions on the operation of an institution, the classification of assets by the institution and the adequacy of an institution’s allowance for loan losses.  Any change in such regulation and oversight, whether in the form of restrictions on activities, regulatory policy, regulations or legislation, could have a material impact on the Company’s operations.  Notwithstanding the recent Presidential election, it is unknown at this time to what extent new legislation will be passed into law or pending or new regulatory proposals will be adopted, or the effect that such passage or adoption will have, positively or negatively, on the banking industry or the Company.

Changes in technology could be costly.
 
The banking industry is undergoing technological innovation at a fast pace.  To keep up with its competition, the Company needs to stay abreast of innovations and evaluate those technologies that will enable it to compete on a cost-effective basis.  This is especially true with respect to our MPS division.  The cost of such technology, including personnel, has been high in both absolute and relative terms and additional funds continue to be used to enhance existing management information systems.  There can be no assurance, given the fast pace of change and innovation, that the Company’s technology, either purchased or developed internally, will meet the needs of the Company.
 
Risks Related to the Company’s Business
 
The OCC and Federal Reserve are our primary banking regulators and we may not be able to comply with applicable banking regulations to their satisfaction.
 
Our primary regulators have broad discretionary powers to enforce banking laws and regulations and may seek to take informal or formal supervisory action if they deem such actions are necessary or required.  If imposed in the future, corrective steps could result in additional regulatory requirements, operational restrictions, a consent order, enhanced supervision and/or civil money penalties.  If imposed, additional resources, both economic and in terms of personnel, would be expended by the Company and the Bank and such regulatory actions could have a material adverse effect on the Company.
 
The Bank has been named as a defendant in several class action lawsuits, the adverse resolution of which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

The Bank has been named as a defendant, along with other defendants, in several class action lawsuits filed in several federal district courts in October and November 2015.   See Part I, Item 3, “Legal Proceedings.” While most of these matters are now resolved, an adverse resolution in remaining litigation or other litigation could result in substantial damages, which could materially adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.




55


Contracts with third parties, some of which are material to the Company, may not be renewed, may be renegotiated on terms that are not as favorable, may not be fulfilled or could be subject to modification or cancellation by regulatory authorities.
 
The Bank has entered into numerous contracts with third parties with respect to the operations of its business.  In some instances, the third parties provide services to the Bank and its divisions; in other instances, the Bank and its divisions provide products and services to such third parties.  Were such agreements not to be renewed by the third party or were such agreements to be renewed on terms less favorable, such actions could have an adverse material impact on the Bank, its divisions and, ultimately, the Company.  Similarly, were one of these parties unable to meet their obligations to us for any reason (including but not limited to bankruptcy, computer or other technological interruptions or failures, personnel loss or acts of God); we may need to seek alternative service providers.
 
We may not be able to secure alternate service providers, and, even if we do, the terms with such alternate providers may not be as favorable as those currently in place.  In addition, were we to lose any of our important third-service providers, it could cause a material disruption in our own ability to service our customers, which also could have an adverse material impact on the Bank, its divisions and, ultimately, the Company.  Moreover, were the disruptions in our ability to provide services significant, this could negatively affect the perception of our business, which could result in a loss of confidence and other adverse effects on our business.

Additionally, our agreements with third-party vendors could come under scrutiny by our regulators.  If a regulator should raise an issue with, or object to, any term or provision in such agreement or any action taken by such third party vis-à-vis the Bank’s operations or customers, this could result in a material adverse effect to the Company including, but not limited to, the imposition of fines and/or penalties and the termination of such agreement.

Finally, we may be held responsible for actions of our third party vendors (e.g., EROs) for activity they undertake on behalf of the Bank, notwithstanding the Bank's onboarding and review program.
 
The Company operates in an extremely competitive market, and the Company’s business will suffer if it is unable to compete effectively.
 
The Company encounters significant competition in the Company’s market area from other commercial banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, mortgage banking firms, consumer finance companies, securities brokerage firms, insurance companies, money market mutual funds and other financial intermediaries.  Many of the Company’s competitors have substantially greater resources and lending limits and may offer services that the Company does not or cannot provide.  The Company’s profitability depends upon the Company’s continued ability to compete successfully in the Company’s market area. The Bank's divisions operate on a national scale against competitors with substantially greater resources.  The success of the Bank's divisions depends upon the Company’s, the Bank’s and the MPS division’s ability to compete in such an environment.
 
A substantial portion of the Company's deposit liabilities are classified as brokered deposits, and failure to maintain the Bank's status as a "well-capitalized" institution could have a serious adverse effect on the Company.

On January 5, 2015, the FDIC published industry guidance in the form of Frequently Asked Questions (“FAQs”) with respect to, among other things, the categorization of deposit liabilities as “brokered” deposits.  This guidance was later supplemented on November 13, 2015, and June 30, 2016. Based on the noted guidance, as of September 30, 2016, the Bank classified $1.48 billion, or 63.2%, of its deposit liabilities as brokered deposits. Due to the Bank’s current status as a “well-capitalized” institution under the FDIC’s prompt corrective action regulations, management believes the guidance does not pose a risk to the Bank. However, should the Bank ever fail to be well-capitalized in the future as a result of not meeting the well-capitalized requirements or the imposition of an individual minimum capital requirement or similar formal requirement, then, notwithstanding that the Bank has capital in excess of the well-capitalized minimum requirements, the Bank would be prohibited, absent waiver from the FDIC, from utilizing brokered deposits (i.e., no insured depository institution that is deemed to be less than “well-capitalized” may accept, renew or rollover brokered deposits absent a waiver from the FDIC).  In such event, unless the Bank were to receive a suitable waiver from the FDIC, such a result could produce serious material adverse consequences for the Bank with respect to liquidity and could also have serious material adverse effects on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.  Further, and in general, depending on the Bank’s condition in the future, the FDIC could increase the surcharge on our brokered deposits up to thirty basis points. For the year ended September 30, 2016, the Company estimates that the additional surcharge attributable to the Bank’s brokered deposits was approximately $0.5 million, after tax. The Company will monitor any future clarifications, rulings and interpretations, including whether institutions would be expected by the FDIC to amend prior call reports.  If we are required to amend previous call reports with respect to our level of brokered deposits, which the Company does not expect, or we are ever required to pay higher surcharge assessments with respect to these deposits, such payments could be material and therefore could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

56



We derive a significant percentage of our deposits, total assets and income from deposit accounts that we generate through MPS’ customer relationships, of which four are significant to our operations.
 
We derive a significant percentage of our deposits, total assets and income from deposit accounts we generate through program manager relationships between third parties and MPS.  Deposits related to our top four program managers (each, a significant program manager) totaled $1.24 billion at September 30, 2016.  We provide oversight and auditing of such third-party relationships and all such relationships must meet all internal and regulatory requirements.  We may exit these relationships if such requirements are not met or if required to do so by our regulators.  We perform liquidity reporting and planning daily and identify and monitor contingent sources of liquidity, such as national CDs, fed fund lines or public fund CDs.  If one of these significant program managers were to be terminated, it could materially reduce our deposits, assets and income.  Similarly, if a significant program manager was not replaced, we may be required to seek higher-rate funding sources as compared to the existing program manager, and interest expense might increase.  We may also be required to sell securities or other assets which would reduce revenues and potentially generate losses.
 
Our business strategy is utilized by other institutions with which we compete.
 
Several banking institutions have adopted business strategies that are similar to ours, particularly with respect to the MPS division.  As a consequence, we have encountered competition in this area and anticipate that we will continue to do so in the future.  This competition may increase our costs, reduce our revenues or revenue growth, or make it difficult for us to compete effectively in obtaining additional customer relationships.

Fraud and other illegal activity involving our tax preparation partners or products could lead to a regulatory investigation and reputational damage to us, reduce the use and acceptance of our cards and reload network, reduce the use of our services, and may adversely affect our financial position and results of operations.

Criminals are using increasingly sophisticated methods to engage in illegal activities involving prepaid cards, reload products, and tax refunds. Illegal activities involving such products and services include malicious social engineering schemes, where people are asked to provide a prepaid card or reload product in order to obtain a loan or purchase goods or services. Illegal activities may also include fraudulent payment or refund schemes and identity theft. We rely upon third party tax preparers for tax preparation and other services, which subjects us to risks related to the vulnerabilities of those third parties. Even a single significant instance of fraud could theoretically result in reputational damage to us, which could reduce the use and acceptance of our cards and other products and services, cause retail distributors or their customers to cease doing business with us or them, or could lead to greater regulation that would increase our compliance costs. Fraudulent activity could also result in the imposition of regulatory sanctions, including significant monetary fines, which could adversely affect our business, operating results and financial condition.

A data security breach by any third party entity involved in the tax refund advance program could expose use to liability and protracted and costly litigation, and could adversely affect our reputation and operating revenues.

Our tax preparation partners may experience security breaches involving the receipt, transmission and storage of confidential customer and other information. Improper access to our or the tax preparation partners systems or databases could result in the theft, publication, deletion or modification of confidential customer and other information. In addition, a data security breach at the tax preparation partners could result in significant reputational harm to us and cause the use and acceptance of our tax-related products and services to decline, either of which could have an adverse impact on our operating revenues and future growth prospects.

Agency, technological, or human error could lead to tax refund processing delays, which could adversely affect our reputation and operating revenues.

We and our tax preparation partners rely on the Internal Revenue Services (the “IRS”), technology, and employees when processing and preparing tax refunds and tax-related products and services. Any delays during the processing or preparation period could result in reputational damage to us or to our tax preparation partners, which could reduce the use and acceptance of our cards and tax-related products and services, either of which could have a significant adverse impact on our operating revenues and future growth prospects. An IRS delay in processing tax returns this season could result in a smaller percentage of expected revenues flowing into our third fiscal quarter.



57


Changes in laws and regulations to which we are subject, or to which we may become subject, may increase our costs of operation, decrease our operating revenues and disrupt our business.

The provision of tax refund processing services is highly regulated and, from time to time, the laws and regulations affecting these industries, and the manner in which they are interpreted, are subject to change. Such changes in laws and regulations or the interpretation or enforcement thereof could increase our compliance and other costs of doing business, require significant systems redevelopment, or render our products or services less profitable or obsolete, which could have an adverse effect on our results of operations.

Changes in laws and regulations, or our failure to comply with existing laws and regulations, applicable to our tax refund-related services could have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, results of operations and financial condition.

In the future, we could derive a significant portion of our total operating revenues and earnings from tax refund processing and settlement services. The tax preparation industry is highly regulated under a variety of statutes and regulations, all of which are subject to change, which may impose significant costs, limitations or prohibitions on the way we conduct or expand our tax refund processing and related services. Any new requirements or rules, new interpretations of existing requirements or rules, failure to follow requirements or rules, or future lawsuits or rulings could have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, results of operations, and financial condition.

Tax preparation products represent a significant credit risk, and if we are unable to collect a significant portion of its tax return advances, it would materially negatively impact earnings.

There is a credit risk associated with a tax refund advance because the funds are disbursed to the customer prior to the Company receiving the customer’s refund from the IRS. Because there is no recourse to the customer if the tax refund advance is not paid in full with the proceeds of the customer’s tax refund, the Company may not collect all of its payments related to the tax refund advances from the IRS and state revenue departments. Losses will generally occur on tax refund advances when the Company does not receive payment from the IRS or state revenue department due to a number of reasons, such as IRS revenue protection strategies including audits of returns, errors in the tax return, tax return fraud and tax debts not previously disclosed to the Company during its underwriting process. Although the Company’s underwriting takes these factors into consideration during the tax refund advance approval process, if the IRS significantly alters its revenue protection strategies for a given tax season, or the Company is incorrect in its underwriting assumptions, the Company could experience higher loan loss provisions above those projected. In addition, a consumer could exercise its rights and withdraw its ACH authorization provided in connection with a tax refund advance, meaning the Bank could no longer collect the payments related to the tax return advances via a direct debit to the designated bank account, which could result in additional losses.

Acquisitions could disrupt our business and harm our financial condition.
 
As part of our general growth strategy, we have expanded our business in part through acquisitions.  Since December 2014, we have completed the acquisition of substantially all of the commercial loan portfolio and related assets of AFS/IBEX Financial Services, Inc., and the more recently completed acquisition of the assets of Fort Knox Financial Services Corporation and its subsidiary, Tax Products Services LLC, in September 2015. In November 2016, we completed the acquisition of substantially all the assets and certain liabilities of EPS Financial.
 
In addition to the transactions noted above, we may engage in additional acquisitions that we believe provide a strategic or geographic fit with our business. We cannot predict the number, size or timing of acquisitions. To the extent that we grow through acquisitions, we cannot assure that we will be able to adequately and profitably manage this growth. Acquiring other businesses will involve risks commonly associated with acquisitions, including:
 
increased capital needs;

increased and new regulatory and compliance requirements;

implementation or remediation of controls, procedures and policies at the acquired company;

diversion of management time and focus from operation of our then-existing business to acquisition-integration challenges;

coordination of product, sales, marketing and program and systems management functions;


58


transition of the acquired company’s users and customers onto our systems;

retention of employees from the acquired company;

integration of employees from the acquired company into our organization;

integration of the acquired company’s accounting, information management, human resource and other administrative systems and operations with ours;

potential liability for activities of the acquired company prior to the acquisition, including violations of law, commercial disputes and tax and other known and unknown liabilities;

potential increased litigation or other claims in connection with the acquired company, including claims brought by terminated employees, customers, former stockholders, vendors, or other third parties; and

goodwill impairment

If we are unable to successfully integrate an acquired business or technology, or otherwise address these difficulties and challenges or other problems encountered in connection with an acquisition, we might not realize the anticipated benefits of that acquisition, we might incur unanticipated liabilities or we might otherwise suffer harm to our business generally, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, prospects, financial condition and results of operations. Unanticipated costs, delays, regulatory review and examination, or other operational or financial problems related to integrating the acquired company and business with our company, may result in the diversion of our management's attention from other business issues and opportunities. To integrate acquired businesses, we must implement our technology and compliance systems in the acquired operations and integrate and manage the personnel of the acquired operations. We also must effectively integrate the different cultures of acquired business organizations into our own in a way that aligns various interests and may need to enter new markets in which we have no or limited experience and where competitors in such markets have stronger market positions. Failures or difficulties in integrating the operations of the businesses that we acquire, including their personnel, technology, compliance programs, financial systems, distribution and general business operations and procedures, marketing, promotion and other relationships, may affect our ability to grow and may result in us incurring asset impairment or restructuring charges. Furthermore, acquisitions and investments are often speculative in nature and the actual benefits we derive from them could be lower or take longer to materialize than we expect.
 
To the extent we pay the consideration for any future acquisitions or investments in cash, it would reduce the amount of cash available to us for other purposes. Future acquisitions or investments could also result in dilutive issuances of our equity securities or the incurrence of debt, contingent liabilities, amortization expenses or impairment charges against goodwill on our balance sheet, any of which could harm our financial condition and negatively impact our stockholders.

An impairment charge of goodwill or other intangibles could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
Because we have recently grown in part through acquisitions, goodwill and intangible assets are now a portion of our consolidated assets. Our goodwill and intangible assets were $65.8 million as of September 30, 2016.  Under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States, or U.S. GAAP, we are required to test the carrying value of goodwill and intangible assets at least annually or sooner if events occur that indicate impairment could exist. These events or circumstances could include a significant change in the business climate, including sustained decline in a reporting unit’s fair value, legal and regulatory factors, operating performance indicators, competition and other factors. U.S. GAAP requires us to assign and then test goodwill at the reporting unit level. If over a sustained period of time we experience a decrease in our stock price and market capitalization, which may serve as an estimate of the fair value of our reporting unit, this may be an indication of impairment. If the fair value of our reporting unit is less than its net book value, we may be required to record goodwill impairment charges in the future. In addition, if the revenue and cash flows generated from any of our other intangible assets is not sufficient to support its net book value, we may be required to record an impairment charge. The amount of any impairment charge could be significant and could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations for the period in which the charge is taken.
 







59


New lines of business or new products and services may subject us to additional risks.
 
From time to time, we may implement new lines of business or offer new products and services within existing lines of business.  Substantial risks and uncertainties are associated with developing and marketing new lines of business or new products or services, particularly in instances where the markets are not fully developed, and we may be required to invest significant time and resources.  Initial timetables for the introduction and development of new lines of business or new products or services may not be achieved and price and profitability targets may not prove feasible.  External factors, such as regulatory reception, compliance with regulations and guidance (such as the OCC’s guidance released in August 2015 related to the offering of tax refund-related products), competitive alternatives and shifting market preferences, may also impact the successful implementation of a new line of business or a new product or service.  Furthermore, any new line of business or new product or service could have a significant impact on the effectiveness of our system of internal controls.  Failure to successfully manage these risks in the development and implementation of new lines of business or new products or services could reduce our revenues and potentially generate losses.
 
Existing insurance policies may not adequately protect the Company and its subsidiaries.
 
Fidelity, business interruption, cybersecurity and property insurance policies are in place with respect to the operations of the Company.  Should any event triggering such policies occur, however, it is possible that our policies would not fully reimburse us for the losses we could sustain due to deductible limits, policy limits, coverage limits or other factors.

The loss of key members of the Company’s senior management team could adversely affect the Company’s business.
 
We believe that the Company’s success depends largely on the efforts and abilities of the Company’s senior executive management team.  Their experience and industry contacts significantly benefit us.  The competition for qualified personnel in the financial services industry is intense, and the loss of any of the Company’s key personnel or an inability to continue to attract, retain and motivate key personnel could adversely affect the Company’s business.

The Company’s loan portfolio includes loans with a higher risk of loss.
 
The Company originates commercial mortgage loans, commercial loans, consumer loans, agricultural real estate loans, agricultural loans and residential mortgage loans.  Commercial mortgage, commercial, consumer, agricultural real estate and agricultural loans may expose a lender to greater credit risk than loans secured by residential real estate because the collateral securing these loans may not be sold as easily as residential real estate.  These loans also have greater credit risk than residential real estate for the following reasons:
 
Commercial Mortgage Loans.  Repayment is dependent upon income being generated in amounts sufficient to cover operating expenses and debt service.

Commercial Loans.  Repayment is dependent upon the successful operation of the borrower’s business.

Consumer Loans.  Consumer loans (such as personal lines of credit) are collateralized, if at all, with assets that may not provide an adequate source of payment of the loan due to depreciation, damage or loss.

Agricultural Loans.  Repayment is dependent upon the successful operation of the business, which is greatly dependent on many things outside the control of either the Bank or the borrowers.  These factors include weather, commodity prices and interest rates, among others.

Premium Finance Loans. Repayment is dependent upon the successful operations of the business. The risk is mitigated since the loan is secured by the unamortized portion of the underlying insurance policy.

Refund Advance Loans. Repayment is dependent upon an income tax refund being approved and paid by the Internal Revenue Service or a state tax authority.









60




Commercial premium financing activity may result in increased exposure to credit risk and fraud.
 
The Company acquired the premium finance loan portfolio and related assets of AFS/IBEX Financial Services, Inc., and continues, through that platform, to serve businesses and insurance agencies nationwide with commercial insurance premium financing. The Company is reliant on insurance agents and brokers to produce these commercial loans, which are made to borrowers who borrow funds to pay premiums on property and casualty insurance policies. Typically the financing arrangement with the borrower provides for periodic payments to the lender to secure the insurance policy with an insurer, and that the lender is entitled to any unearned premium due from the insurer in the event of policy cancellation with any excess returned to the insured/borrower after the loan has been paid off. The financing arrangement typically includes a limited power of attorney to permit the lender to cancel the insurance policy in the event of default.  Typically, premium finance loans are designed to amortize faster than the unearned premium that has been paid, either as a down payment, or periodically is earned, so that the value of the unearned premium exceeds the outstanding financed amount, providing collateral to the lender.  If the borrower fails to pay on the premium finance loan, then the financed insurance policy must be cancelled to avoid losses with respect to unearned premiums. The Company must consider both the creditworthiness of the borrower, and the creditworthiness of the insurer (for the ability to return the unearned premium).  There is also an operational risk of assuring that the insurance policy is cancelled on a timely basis to prevent unearned premium from dissipating once the policy can be cancelled.  Further, the Company is not involved in the production of the loans, and is therefore exposed to the risk of fraud by producers.
 
If the Company’s actual loan losses exceed the Company’s allowance for loan losses, the Company’s net income will decrease.
 
The Company makes various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of the Company’s loan portfolio, including the creditworthiness of the Company’s borrowers and the value of the real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the repayment of the Company’s loans.  Despite the Company’s underwriting and monitoring practices, the Company’s loan customers may not repay their loans according to their terms, and the collateral securing the payment of these loans may be insufficient to pay any remaining loan balance.  The Company may experience significant loan losses, which could have a material adverse effect on its operating results.  Because the Company must use assumptions regarding individual loans and the economy, the current allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover actual loan losses, and increases in the allowance may be necessary.  The Company may need to significantly increase the Company’s provision for losses on loans if one or more of the Company’s larger loans or credit relationships becomes impaired or if we continue to expand the Company’s commercial real estate and commercial lending.  In addition, federal and state regulators periodically review the Company’s allowance for loan losses and may require the Company to increase the Company’s provision for loan losses or recognize loan charge-offs.  Material additions to the Company’s allowance would materially decrease the Company’s net income.  The Company cannot assure you that its monitoring procedures and policies will reduce certain lending risks or that the Company’s allowance for loan losses will be adequate to cover actual losses.

If the Company forecloses on and takes ownership of real estate collateral property, it may be subject to the increased costs associated with the ownership of real property, resulting in reduced revenues.
 
The Company may have to foreclose on collateral property to protect its investment and may thereafter own and operate such property.  In such case, the Company will be exposed to the risks inherent in the ownership of real estate.  The amount that the Company, as a mortgagee, may realize after a default is dependent upon factors outside of the Company’s control, including, but not limited to:  (i) general or local economic conditions; (ii) neighborhood values; (iii) interest rates; (iv) real estate tax rates; (v) operating expenses of the mortgaged properties; (vi) supply of and demand for rental units or properties; (vii) ability to obtain and maintain adequate occupancy of the properties; (viii) zoning laws; (ix) governmental rules, regulations and fiscal policies; and (x) acts of God.  Certain expenditures associated with the ownership of real estate, principally real estate taxes and maintenance costs, may adversely affect the income from the real estate.  Therefore, the cost of operating a real property may exceed the rental income earned from such property, and the Company may have to advance funds in order to protect the Company’s investment, or may be required to dispose of the real property at a loss.  The foregoing expenditures and costs could adversely affect the Company’s ability to generate revenues, resulting in reduced levels of profitability.
 
Our agricultural loans are subject to factors beyond the Company’s control.
 
The agricultural community is subject to commodity price fluctuations.  Extended periods of low commodity prices, higher input costs or poor weather conditions could result in reduced profit margins, reducing demand for goods and services provided by agriculture-related businesses, which, in turn, could affect other businesses in the Company’s market area. Any combination of these factors could produce losses within the Company's agricultural loan portfolios.
 

61



Environmental liability associated with commercial lending could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations.
 
In the course of the Company’s business, it may acquire, through foreclosure, commercial properties securing loans that are in default.  There is a risk that hazardous substances could be discovered on those properties.  In this event, the Company could be required to remove the substances from and remediate the properties at its own cost and expense.  The cost of removal and environmental remediation could be substantial.  The Company may not have adequate remedies against the owners of the properties or other responsible parties and could find it difficult or impossible to sell the affected properties.  These events could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, financial condition and operating results.

New products and services are expensive to implement and are closely scrutinized by the OCC.

The Bank operates in an environment that is reliant upon innovative products and services that complement and enhance existing product and service offerings.  The investments we make in these new products and services are often expensive and we can never be certain that products or services will be acceptable to our regulators or will realize commercial success.  In addition, the OCC has stated as recently as December 2014, that new products and services must be undertaken only after the appropriate controls are in place (which can often be time-consuming and expensive to implement).

Our framework for managing risks may not be effective in mitigating risk and loss to us.
 
We have established processes and procedures intended to identify, measure, monitor, report and analyze the types of risk to which we are subject, including liquidity risk, credit risk, market risk, interest rate risk, operational risk, legal and compliance risk, and reputational risk, among others.  However, as with any risk management framework, there are inherent limitations to our risk management strategies as there may exist, or develop in the future, risks that we have not appropriately anticipated or identified.  For example, the 2008 financial and credit crisis and resulting regulatory reform highlighted both the importance and certain limitations of managing unanticipated risks.  If our risk management framework proves ineffective, we could suffer unexpected losses which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
A breach of information security, compliance breach, or error by one of the Company’s agents or vendors could negatively affect the Company’s reputation and business.
 
The Company depends on data processing, communication and information exchange on a variety of computing platforms and networks and over the Internet.  Despite safeguards, no system, including ours, is entirely free from vulnerability to attack or error.  Additionally, the Company relies on and does business with a variety of third-party service providers, agents and vendors with respect to the Company’s business, data and communications needs.  If information security is breached, or one of the Company’s agents or vendors breaches compliance procedures, or otherwise errs, information could be lost or misappropriated, resulting in financial loss or costs to the Company or damages to others.  These costs or losses could materially exceed the Company’s amount of insurance coverage, if any, which would adversely affect the Company’s business.
 
Other “high profile” data breaches during recent years have raised interest in new legislation at both the federal and state level.  To the extent additional requirements are imposed on the Bank as a result of such legislation, these costs could have an adverse impact on the Bank.


62


 
Changes in accounting policies or accounting standards, or changes in how accounting standards are interpreted or applied, could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition.
 
Our accounting policies are fundamental to determining and understanding our financial results and condition.  Some of these policies require use of estimates and assumptions that may affect the value of our assets or liabilities and financial results.  Any changes in our accounting policies could materially affect our financial statements.  From time to time, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) and the SEC change the financial accounting and reporting standards that govern the preparation of our financial statements.  In addition, accounting standard setters and those who interpret the accounting standards (such as the FASB, the SEC, banking regulators and our outside auditors) may change or even reverse their previous interpretations or positions on how these standards should be applied.  Changes in financial accounting and reporting standards and changes in current interpretations may be beyond our control, can be difficult to predict and could materially affect how we report our financial results and condition.  We may be required to apply a new or revised standard retroactively or apply an existing standard differently and retroactively, which may result in the Company being required to restate prior period financial statements in material amounts. In particular, the FASB issued a new rule requiring companies to estimate current expected credit losses. The rule, which is a major change for banking organizations, becomes effective for the Company on October 1, 2020. The new standard is likely to result in more timely recognition of credit losses than under the previous incurred loss model, and the Company is evaluating the extent to which the new rule will affect its results of operations.

Our network of tax preparation partners is extensive but it may be difficult to manage and retain such marketing partners because of competitive market forces.

As of the date of this filing, the Bank has a network of over 10,000 active EROs that utilize its services and it is expected that this number will increase for the 2017 tax season.  Although each ERO undergoes an analysis of its operations prior to marketing the Bank’s products, it is possible that certain EROs will facilitate or engage in tax-related malfeasance or offer the Bank's products and services in a manner that does not comply with law or contractual representations, warranties and covenants.  In addition, it is possible that the EROs may choose to offer the tax-related products of other companies who provide products and services similar to the Bank’s for pricing or other competitive reasons.  The effect of any of these events, were they to be realized in the future, could potentially result in material adverse consequences to the Company.

Risks Related to the Company’s Stock
 
The price of the Company’s common stock may be volatile, which may result in losses for investors.
 
The market price for shares of the Company’s common stock has been volatile in the past, and several factors could cause the price to fluctuate substantially in the future.  These factors include:
 
announcements of developments related to the Company’s business;

the initiation, pendency or outcome of litigation, regulatory reviews, inquiries and investigations, and any related adverse publicity;

fluctuations in the Company’s results of operations;

sales of substantial amounts of the Company’s securities into the marketplace;

general conditions in the Company’s banking niche or the worldwide economy;

a shortfall in revenues or earnings compared to securities analysts’ expectations;

lack of an active trading market for the common stock;

changes in analysts’ recommendations or projections; and

the Company’s announcement of new acquisitions or other projects.

The market price of the Company’s common stock may fluctuate significantly in the future, and these fluctuations may be unrelated to the Company’s performance.  General market price declines or market volatility in the future could adversely affect the price of the Company’s common stock, and the current market price may not be indicative of future market prices.

63


 
An investment in Company common stock is not an insured deposit.
 
Our common stock is not a bank deposit and, therefore, is not insured against loss by the FDIC, any other deposit insurance fund or by any other public or private entity.  Investment in our common stock is inherently risky for the reasons described in this “Risk Factors” section and is subject to market forces that affect the price of common stock in any company.  As a result, if you hold or acquire our common stock, it is possible that you may lose all or a portion of your investment.

The Company’s common stock is thinly traded, and thus your ability to sell shares or purchase additional shares of the Company’s common stock will be limited, and the market price at any time may not reflect true value.
 
Your ability to sell shares of the Company’s common stock or purchase additional shares largely depends upon the existence of an active market for the common stock.  The Company’s common stock is quoted on NASDAQ Global Market, but the volume of trades on any given day is relatively light, and you may be unable to find a buyer for shares you wish to sell or a seller of additional shares you wish to purchase.  In addition, a fair valuation of the purchase or sales price of a share of common stock also depends upon active trading, and thus the price you receive for a relatively thinly traded stock, such as the Company’s common stock, may not reflect its true value.
 
Future sales or additional issuances of the Company’s capital stock may depress prices of shares of the Company’s common stock or otherwise dilute the book value of shares then outstanding.
 
Sales of a substantial amount of the Company’s capital stock in the public market or the issuance of a significant number of shares could adversely affect the market price for shares of the Company’s common stock.  As of September 30, 2016, the Company was authorized to issue up to 15,000,000 shares of common stock, of which 8,523,641 shares were outstanding, and 0 shares were held as treasury stock.  The Company was also authorized to issue up to 3,000,000 shares of preferred stock and 3,000,000 of non-voting common stock, none of which is outstanding or reserved for issuance.  Future sales or additional issuances of stock may affect the market price for shares of the Company’s common stock.
 
Federal regulations and our organic corporate documents may inhibit a takeover, prevent a transaction you may favor or limit the Company’s growth opportunities, which could cause the market price of the Company’s common stock to decline.
 
Certain provisions of the Company’s charter documents and federal regulations could have the effect of making it more difficult for a third party to acquire, or of discouraging a third party from attempting to acquire, control of the Company.  In addition, the Company may need to obtain approval from regulatory authorities before it can acquire control of any other company.
 
The Company may not be able to pay dividends in the future in accordance with past practice.
 
The Company pays a quarterly dividend to stockholders.  The payment of dividends is subject to legal and regulatory restrictions.  Any payment of dividends in the future will depend, in large part, on the Company’s earnings, capital requirements, financial condition, regulatory review, and other factors considered relevant by the Company’s Board of Directors.
 
ATM fraud is becoming both more sophisticated and more prevalent.

Although the Bank has not been the subject of any widespread or concerted ATM attack, ATM fraud has shown a marked increase and threats to the network of entities that comprise ATM networks continue.  At this time, it is estimated that global losses from ATM skimming alone are approaching $2 billion annually and are expected to continue to grow.  Although most ATM fraud continues to involve skimming (whereby a skimmer reads a debit card's encoded mag stripe and a camera records the PIN that is entered by a customer), new frauds including those perpetrated by Wi-Fi scanners and the cracking of encryption software, are being perpetrated against global banks and their customers.  The Bank continues to monitor these developments and has a robust program in place to monitor for debit and credit card fraud.  Even with such policies and procedures in place, however, there can be no assurance that the Bank, its customers or the ATM networks in which it participates will not be the victims of an ATM-based crime.








64


Risks Related to the Bank's divisions
 
Our divisional products and services are highly regulated financial products subject to extensive supervision and regulation and are costly to maintain.
 
The products and services offered by several of our divisions are highly regulated by federal banking agencies, the Bureau and some state regulators.  Some of the laws and related regulations affecting its operations include consumer protection laws, escheat laws, privacy laws, anti-money laundering laws and data protection laws.  Compliance with the relevant legal paradigm in which our divisions operate is costly and requires significant personnel resources, as well as extensive contacts with outside lawyers and consultants to stay abreast of the applicable regulatory schemes. 
 
The Bureau's Prepaid Accounts Rule will affect the Bank’s offering of prepaid cards.

As described above, the Bureau issued a final rule on October 5, 2016, which supplemented the existing regulatory framework pursuant to which prepaid products (both cards and other delivery methods, including codes) are offered and serviced. The Prepaid Accounts Rule brought prepaid products fully within Regulation E, which implements the federal Electronic Funds Transfer Act, and, for prepaid products that have a “credit” component, within Regulation Z, which implements the federal Truth in Lending Act. The Prepaid Accounts Rule created tailored provisions which (1) created a definition for a “prepaid account” in Regulation E, (2) required certain disclosures to consumers before such consumer acquires a prepaid card account, (3) extended Regulation E’s limited liability and error resolution provisions to certain registered prepaid accounts, (4) regulated the provision of billing statements, and (5) extended Regulation Z’s credit card rules and disclosure requirements to prepaid accounts that provide
overdraft services and other credit features (the Bank currently issues a card with an overdraft feature that is marketed by a third party program manager.) The Prepaid Accounts Rule also required account issuers to post their publicly offered prepaid card program agreements on their own websites and make them available to consumers upon request and to provide copies of all publicly offered prepaid card program agreements to the Bureau. Although the Prepaid Accounts Rule does not go into effect until October 1, 2017, compliance with the Prepaid Accounts Rule will likely result in additional costs, which could be significant, and could adversely impact the Company’s and the Bank’s results of operations, financial condition, or liquidity.
 
In addition to the CFPB’s final prepaid regulation (discussed above), it is possible that new legislation or more stringent focus by banking agencies could further restrict our current operations or change the regulatory environment in which our customers operate.
 
Although it is possible that some legislation under consideration could have either a positive or de minimis impact on its operations and profitability, it is also possible that any new legislation affecting our operations or our customers, some of which are also regulated entities, would have a negative impact on the conduct of the relevant business.  There is no way to quantify the impact that such changes could have on our profitability or operations at this time given the unpredictable nature of the risk.
 
In addition to the relevant legal paradigm set forth above, it should also be noted that there has been concern within the bank regulatory environment over the use of credit and, in particular, prepaid cards as a means by which to illegally launder and move money.  The U.S. Treasury’s Financial Crimes Enforcement Network issued rules related to providers of “prepaid access” which have left certain issues unresolved related to its regulatory requirements.  It is likely that any changes to the regulatory environment related to the offering of prepaid cards will increase the Bank’s compliance and operational costs.  Although the Bank will continue to work with its regulators to provide information about its operations as well as the state of the prepaid card industry, we believe such concerns in general will continue for the foreseeable future for the entire banking industry, with a continued emphasis on heightened compliance expectations, resulting in higher compliance costs.  See “Business Regulation – Bank Supervision and Regulation” which is included in Item 1 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Bank owns or is seeking a number of patents, trademarks and other forms of intellectual property with respect to the operation of its business and the protection of such intellectual property may in the future require material expenditures.
 
In their operations, our divisions, through the Bank, seek protection for various forms of intellectual property from time to time.  No assurance can be given that such protection will be granted.  In addition, given the competitive market environment of its business, the Bank must be vigilant in ensuring that its patents and other intellectual property are protected and not exploited by unlicensed third parties.
 
The Bank must also protect itself and defend against intellectual property challenges initiated by third parties making various claims, against it.  With respect to these claims, regardless of whether we are pursuing our claims against perceived infringers or defending our intellectual property from third parties asserting various claims of infringement, it is possible that significant personnel time and monetary resources could be used to pursue or defend such claims.

65


 
It should also be noted that intellectual property risks extend to foreign countries whose protections of such property are not as extensive as those in the United States.  As such, the Bank may need to spend additional sums to ensure that its intellectual property protections are maximized globally.  Moreover, should there be a material, improper use of the Bank’s intellectual property, this could have an impact on our divisions' operations and the Bank.
 
Costs of conforming products and services to the Payment Card Industry Data Security Standards (the “PCI DSS”) are costly and could continue to affect the operations of MPS.
 
The PCI DSS is a multifaceted standard that includes data security management, policies and procedures as well as other protective measures, that was created by the largest credit card associations in the world in an effort to protect the nonpublic personal information of all types of cardholders, including prepaid cardholders and holders of network branded credit cards (such as Discover, MasterCard and Visa).  The PCI DSS mandates a prescribed technical foundation for the collection, storage and transmission of cardholder data and also contains significant provisions regarding the testing of security protections by various entities in the payment card industry, including MPS.  Compliance with the PCI DSS is costly and changes to the standards could have an equal, or greater, effect on profitability of the relevant business division.
 
The potential for fraud in the card payment industry is significant.
 
Issuers of prepaid and credit cards have suffered significant losses in recent years with respect to the theft of cardholder data that has been illegally exploited for personal gain.  The theft of such information is regularly reported and affects not only individuals but businesses as well.  Many types of credit card fraud exist, including the counterfeiting of cards and “skimming.”
 
Losses from fraud have been substantial for certain card industry participants.  Although fraud has not had a material impact on the profitability of the Bank, it is possible that such activity could adversely impact in the future, notwithstanding, our recent introduction of EMV (i.e., chip-enabled) cards and the broader acceptance of such cards in the U.S. and international markets.
 
Part of our business depends on sales agents who do not sell our products exclusively.
 
Our business model, to some degree, depends upon the use of sales agents who are not our employees.  These agents sell the products and services of many different processors to merchants and other parties in need of card services.  Failure to maintain good relations with such sales agents could have a negative impact on our business.

Products and services offered by MPS involve many business parties and the possibility of collusion exists.
 
As described above, the theft of cardholder data is a significant threat in the industry in which MPS operates.  This threat also includes the possibility that there is collusion between certain participants in the card system to act illegally.  Although MPS is not aware of any instances to date, it is possible that such activities could occur in the future, thereby impacting its operation and profitability.
 
Competition in the card industry is significant.  In order to maintain an edge to its products and offerings, MPS must invest significantly in technology and research and development.
 
The heavy emphasis upon technology in the products and services offered by MPS requires significant expenditures with respect to research and development both to exploit technological gains and to develop new products and services to meet customers’ needs.  As is common with most research and development, while some efforts may yield substantial benefits for the division, others will not, thereby resulting in expenditures for which profits will not be realized.  MPS is not able to predict with any degree of certainty as to the level of research and development that will be required in the future, how much those efforts will cost, or how profitable such developments will be for the division once undertaken.
 









66


Our business could suffer if there is a decline in the use of prepaid cards or there are adverse developments with respect to the prepaid financial services industry in general.
 
As the prepaid financial services industry evolves, consumers may find prepaid financial services to be less attractive than other financial services.  Consumers might not use prepaid financial services for any number of reasons.  For example, negative publicity surrounding the Company or other prepaid financial service providers could impact MPS’ business and prospects for growth to the extent it adversely impacts the perception of prepaid financial services.  If consumers do not continue or increase their usage of prepaid cards, MPS’ operating revenues may remain at current levels or decline.  Growth of prepaid financial services as an electronic payment mechanism may not occur or may occur more slowly than estimated.  If there is a shift in the mix of payment forms used by consumers (i.e., cash, credit cards, traditional debit cards and prepaid cards) away from products and services offered by MPS, such a shift could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
FTC legal action against a major program manager offering Bank-issued prepaid cards requires heightened review and
oversight

On November 10, 2016, the Federal Trade Commission filed suit in federal court in Georgia against NetSpend, a significant program manager for the Bank, alleging that NetSpend engaged in deceptive marketing and servicing in connection with Bank and other-branded prepaid cards issued pursuant to such program agreement. The complaint requests that the court issue a permanent injunction against NetSpend as well as equitable relief, including any and all relief necessary to redress consumers’ alleged injuries. No allegations against the Bank are included in the complaint.

Discover, MasterCard and Visa, as well as other electronic funds networks in which MPS operates, could change their rules.
 
Pursuant to the agreements between MPS and Discover, MasterCard, Visa and other card networks, these third parties typically have retained the right to prescribe certain business practices and procedures with respect to parties such as MPS.  Such prescribed terms include, but are not limited to, a contracting party’s level of capital as well as other business requirements.
 
Discover, MasterCard and Visa also retain the right in their agreements with industry participants such as MPS to unilaterally change the rules under which such transactions are processed with little or no advance warning.  This power includes the power to prevent MPS from accessing their networks in order to process transactions.  Should any third party choose to invoke this right unilaterally, such changes could materially impact the operations of MPS.

Our business is heavily dependent upon the Internet and any negative disruptions to its operation could negatively impact our business.
 
Much of our business, especially at the divisional level, depends upon transactions being processed through the Internet.  Like nearly all other commercial enterprises, we rely upon others to provide the Internet so that commerce can be conducted.  Were there to be a failure in the operation of the Internet or a significant impairment in our ability to move information on the Internet or our ability to do so in accordance with customer safeguard protocols, we would need to develop alternative processes during which time revenues and profitability may be lower.
 
Our ability to process transactions requires functioning communication and electricity lines.
 
The nature of the banking industry in general, and the credit card and debit card industry in particular, is that it must be operational every day of the week and every hour of the week.  Any disruption in the utilities utilized by the Bank or its divisions could have a negative effect on our operations and extensive disruptions could materially affect our operations, and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 












67


Data encryption technology has not been perfected and vigilance in MPS’ information technology systems is costly.
 
The Bank and its divisions hold holds sensitive business and personal information with respect to the products and services it offers.  This information, which is generally digitally encrypted, is passed along various technology channels, including the Internet.  Although we encrypt its customer and other sensitive information and expends significant financial and personnel resources to maintain the integrity of its technology networks and the confidentiality of nonpublic customer information, because such information may travel on public technology and other non-secure channels, the confidential information is potentially susceptible to hacking and other illegal intrusions.  Were such a security breach to occur, the provision of products and services to our customers would be impaired.  In addition, were a breach to occur, we could incur significant fines from the electronic funds associations involved, or from federal and/or state regulators, and be subject to other prohibitions, as well as extensive litigation from commercial parties and consumers affected by such breach, that would have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
Unclaimed funds represented by unused value on the cards presents compliance and other risks.
 
The concept of escheatment involves the reporting and delivery of property to states that is abandoned when its rightful owner cannot be readily located and/or identified.  In the context of prepaid cards, the funds in connection with such cards can sometimes be “abandoned” or unused for the relevant period of time set forth in each applicable state’s abandoned property laws.  MPS utilizes automated programs to ensure its operations are compliant with such applicable laws and regulations.  There appears, however, to be a movement among some state regulators to interpret definitions in escheatment statutes and regulations in a manner that is more aggressive.  Should such state regulators choose to do so, they may initiate collection or other litigation action against prepaid card issuers for unreported abandoned property.  Such actions may seek to assess fines and penalties.
 
Our divisions operate in a highly competitive environment and the ability to attract and retain qualified personnel may be difficult.
 
Our divisions compete in a highly competitive environment with other larger and better capitalized financial intermediaries.  In addition, the field of professionals involved in the design and production of products and services offered by our division is highly skilled and actively sought after by financial institutions, electronic card networks and other commercial entities.  As such, our divisions must spend significant sums to attract employees and executives and must monitor compensation and other employment trends to ensure that compensation packages both foster the necessary creative environment and appropriately compensate such individuals in order to retain them.

MPS Revenue Concentration.
 
MPS works with a large number of business partners to derive its revenue.  The Company believes four of its partners have reached a size that, should these partners’ business with the Company end or there is a significant decrease in revenues associated with any of these business relationships, the earnings attributable to them would have a material effect on the financial results of the Company.
 

Item 1B.    Unresolved Staff Comments
 
Not applicable.
 

Item 2.        Properties
 
The Bank is a federally chartered savings bank which operates 10 full-service branch banking offices in four market areas in Iowa and South Dakota:  Northwest Iowa, Brookings, Central Iowa and Sioux Empire, one non-retail service branch in Memphis, Tennessee, and three non-branch offices located in Texas, California and Kentucky related to the Bank's AFS/IBEX and Refund Advantage operations. The Bank’s home office, with Federal approval in 2015, has been moved from 121 East Fifth Street in Storm Lake, Iowa to 5501 South Broadband Lane in Sioux Falls, South Dakota.  Our Meta Payment Systems division offers prepaid cards, other payment industry products and services and tax payment industry products and services nationwide and operates out of Sioux Falls, South Dakota, with an office in Louisville, Kentucky. Our AFS/IBEX division provides nationwide commercial insurance premium financing for business and insurance agencies and has two agency offices, one in Dallas, Texas, and one in Southern California.
 

68


Of the 17 properties, the Company leases 10 of them, all on market terms. See Note 6 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Though the Company has experienced rapid growth, particularly as a result of growth of MPS, management believes current facilities are adequate to meet its present needs.
 
The Bank maintains an online database with a service bureau, whose primary business is providing such services to financial institutions.
 

Item 3.        Legal Proceedings
 
The Company and the Bank were named as defendants, along with other defendants, in four class action litigations commenced in three different federal district courts between October 23, 2015 and November 5, 2015: (1) Fuentes, et al. v. UniRush LLC, et al. (S.D.N.Y. Case No. 1:15-cv-08372-JPO); (2) Huff et al. v. UniRush, LLC et al. (E.D. Cal. Case No. 2:15-cv-02253-KJM-CMK); (3) Peterkin v. UniRush LLC, et al. (S.D.N.Y. Case No. 1:15-cv-08573-PAE); and (4) Jones v. UniRush, LLC et al. (E.D. Pa. Case No. 5:15-cv-05996-JLS). The same defendants, including the Company and the Bank, were also named as defendants in an additional class action litigation commenced in another federal district court on April 13, 2016: (5) Smith v. UniRush LLC, et al. (C.D. Cal. Case No. 2:16-cv-02533-SVW-E). The same defendants, including the Company and the Bank, were named as defendants in a lawsuit filed by an individual plaintiff in a Texas state court on June 24, 2016: (6) Jacobs v. UniRush LLC et al. (Harris County, Texas County Civ. Ct. Cause No. 1079432). The complaints in each of these six actions seek monetary damages for the alleged inability of customers of the prepaid card product RushCard to access the product for up to two weeks starting on or about October 12, 2015. In each case, the plaintiffs alleged claims for breach of contract, fraud, misrepresentation, negligence, unjust enrichment, conversion, and breach of fiduciary duty and violations of various state consumer protection statutes prohibiting unfair or deceptive acts or trade/business practices. In addition, the OCC and the CFPB are examining the events surrounding the allegations with respect to the Company and the other defendants, respectively. The OCC has broad supervisory powers with respect to the Bank and could seek to initiate supervisory action if it believes such action is warranted. A settlement was negotiated with class counsel in actions (1)-(4) under which neither the Company nor the Bank made any payment. Notice of the settlement was given to the approximately 425,000 class members, of which 70 opted out from the class, but not a single objection to the settlement was filed, either by any potential class member or any of the regulatory agencies who received notice of the settlement. At a September 12, 2016 hearing in the lead class action case, action (1), the Court granted final approval of the settlement, certified the Settlement Class and entered final judgment for actions (1)-(4). In the interim, action (5) was settled for a nominal amount, with no payment by the Company or the Bank, and the case was formally resolved with the filing of a dismissal notice on July 15, 2016. At this time, the petition in action (6) specifically alleges that the maximum damages, costs and attorneys’ fees that plaintiff seeks do not exceed $74,000.

The Bank was served on April 15, 2013, with a lawsuit captioned Inter National Bank v. NetSpend Corporation, MetaBank, BDO USA, LLP d/b/a BDO Seidman, Cause No. C-2084-12-I filed in the District Court of Hidalgo County, Texas. The Plaintiff’s Second Amended Original Petition and Application for Temporary Restraining Order and Temporary Injunction adds both MetaBank and BDO Seidman to the original causes of action against NetSpend. NetSpend acts as a prepaid card program manager and processor for both INB and MetaBank. According to the Petition, NetSpend has informed Inter National Bank (“INB”) that the depository accounts at INB for the NetSpend program supposedly contained $10.5 million less than they should. INB alleges that NetSpend has breached its fiduciary duty by making affirmative misrepresentations to INB about the safety and stability of the program, and by failing to timely disclose the nature and extent of any alleged shortfall in settlement of funds related to cardholder activity and the nature and extent of NetSpend’s systemic deficiencies in its accounting and settlement processing procedures. To the extent that an accounting reveals that there is an actual shortfall, INB alleges that MetaBank may be liable for portions or all of said sum due to the fact that funds have been transferred from INB to MetaBank, and thus MetaBank would have been unjustly enriched. The Bank is vigorously contesting this matter. In January 2014, NetSpend was granted summary judgment in this matter which is under appeal. Because the theory of liability against both NetSpend and the Bank is the same, the Bank views the NetSpend summary judgment as a positive in support of our position.  An estimate of a range of reasonably possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because discovery is still being conducted.

    





69


The Bank commenced action against C&B Farms, LLC, Dakota River Farms, LLC, Dakota Grain Farms, LLC, Heather Swenson and Tracy Clement in early July, 2015, in the Third Judicial Circuit Court of the State of South Dakota, seeking to collect upon certain delinquent loans made in connection with the 2014 farming operations of the three identified limited liability companies and the personal guaranties of Swenson and Clement. The three companies and Clement answered the Complaint and asserted a counterclaim against the Bank and a third-party claim against the Bank’s loan officer, alleging fraud and misrepresentation, as well as promissory estoppel.   On January 7, 2016, the Bank obtained a judgment for $6.1 million, the full amount due and owing on the delinquent loans, together with attorneys’ fees, costs and post-judgment interest.  On February 25, 2016, the Court entered an order and judgment in favor of the Bank granting the Bank’s renewed motion for summary judgment as to counterclaims and third party claim. Tracy Clement, the primary guarantor of the C&B Farms, Dakota Grain Farms, and Dakota River Farms indebtedness has filed a Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceeding in Minnesota. The Bank is an unsecured creditor in the bankruptcy proceeding. The Bank still has the right to collect from the three limited liability company debtors (C&B, Dakota Grain, and Dakota River). However, the Bank believes each entity is now insolvent and the collateral recovered and liquidated to the extent possible. The Bank has also settled with the other personal guarantor, Heather Swenson. The Bank commenced action against Interstate Commodities, Inc., on February 1, 2016, in the United States District Court for the District of South Dakota, Central Division. This matter arises out of the Bank’s loans to C&B Farms, which were guaranteed by Tracy Clement. The case alleges that Interstate Commodities has breached the terms of a subordination agreement entered into between Interstate Commodities and the Bank relating to the 2015 crops of C&B Farms, LLC. In March, 2015, the Bank sent a letter to C&B Farms and Interstate Commodities agreeing that the Bank would subordinate its first position lien in the farm products of C&B Farms once the Bank’s 2015 input advances in an agreed upon sum had been paid in full. Interstate Commodities entered into various agreements with C&B Farms in which they agreed to purchase grain at a future date and provided purchase price advance financing to C&B Farms. Interstate Commodities also partially performed under the subordination agreement by paying or allowing certain sums to flow back to the Bank to pay on the agreed upon inputs. Interstate Commodities terminated the payments to the Bank before allowing full repayment of the 2015 inputs financed by the Bank before the subordination agreement was reached. This large, non-performing agricultural relationship was partially charged off during fiscal year 2016 and has no remaining loan balance.

The Bank was served on October 14, 2016, with a lawsuit captioned Card Limited, LLC v. MetaBank dba Meta Payment Systems, Civil No. 2:16-cv-00980 in the United States District Court for the District of Utah. This action was initiated by former prepaid program manager of the Bank, which was terminated by the Bank earlier this year. Card Limited alleges that after all of the programs have been wound down, there are two accounts with a positive balance to which they are entitled. The Bank’s position is that Card Limited is not entitled to the funds contained in said accounts. The total amount to which Card Limited claims it is entitled is $1,579,398. The Bank intends to vigorously defend this claim. An estimate of a range of reasonably possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because discovery is still being conducted.

Other than the matters set forth above, there are no other new material pending legal proceedings or updates to which the Company or its subsidiaries is a party other than ordinary litigation routine to their respective businesses.

Item 4.        Mine Safety Disclosures
 
Not applicable.
 
PART II

Item 5.        Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
The Company’s common stock trades on the NASDAQ Global Market® under the symbol “CASH.”  Quarterly dividends for 2016 and 2015 were $0.13.  The high and low sales price of the common stock, as reported on the NASDAQ Global Market, was as follows:
 
 
Fiscal Year 2016
 
Fiscal Year 2015
 
Low
 
High
 
Low
 
High
First Quarter
$
39.10

 
$
49.67

 
$
33.76

 
$
38.47

Second Quarter
36.22

 
46.53

 
32.02

 
40.49

Third Quarter
43.55

 
53.76

 
38.41

 
43.81

Fourth Quarter
48.97

 
62.62

 
41.43

 
53.51



70


Prices disclose inter-dealer quotations without retail mark-up, mark-down or commissions and do not necessarily represent actual transactions.
 
Dividend payment decisions are made with consideration of a variety of factors including earnings, financial condition, market considerations and regulatory restrictions.
 
As of December 8, 2016, the Company had 9,188,292 shares of common stock outstanding, which were held by approximately 168 stockholders of record, and 123,562 shares subject to outstanding options.  The stockholders of record number does not reflect approximately 3,750 persons or entities that hold their stock in nominee or “street” name.
 
The transfer agent for the Company’s common stock is Computershare, 211 Quality Circle, Suite 210, College Station, TX 77845.
 
There were no purchases by the Company during the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, of equity securities that are registered by the Company pursuant to Section 12 of the Exchange Act.


71


Item 6.        Selected Financial Data
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
SELECTED FINANCIAL CONDITION DATA
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
4,006,419

 
$
2,529,705

 
$
2,054,031

 
$
1,691,989

 
$
1,648,898

Loans receivable, net
919,470

 
706,255

 
493,007

 
380,428

 
326,981

Securities available for sale
1,469,249

 
1,256,087

 
1,140,216

 
881,193

 
1,116,692

Securities held to maturity
619,853

 
345,744

 
282,933

 
288,026

 

Goodwill and intangible assets
65,849

 
70,505

 
2,588

 
2,339

 
2,035

Deposits
2,430,082

 
1,657,534

 
1,366,541

 
1,315,283

 
1,379,794

Total borrowings
1,187,578

 
561,317

 
497,721

 
216,456

 
47,710

Stockholders' equity
334,975

 
271,335

 
174,802

 
142,984

 
145,859

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Year Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
SELECTED OPERATIONS DATA
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

(Dollars in Thousands, Except Per Share Data)
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total interest income
$
81,396

 
$
61,607

 
$
48,660

 
$
38,976

 
$
37,297

Total interest expense
4,091

 
2,387

 
2,398

 
2,954

 
3,563

Net interest income
77,305

 
59,220

 
46,262

 
36,022

 
33,734

Provision for loan losses
4,605

 
1,465

 
1,150

 

 
1,049

Net interest income after provision for loan losses
72,700

 
57,755

 
45,112

 
36,022

 
32,685

Total non-interest income
100,770

 
58,174

 
51,738

 
55,503

 
69,574

Total non-interest expense
134,648

 
96,506

 
78,231

 
74,403

 
75,463

Income before income tax expense
38,822

 
19,423

 
18,619

 
17,122

 
26,796

Income tax expense
5,602

 
1,368

 
2,906

 
3,704

 
9,682

Net income
33,220

 
18,055

 
15,713

 
13,418

 
17,114

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
3.95

 
$
2.68

 
$
2.57

 
$
2.40

 
$
4.94

Diluted
$
3.92

 
$
2.66

 
$
2.53

 
$
2.38

 
$
4.92



72


Year Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
2013
 
2012
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
SELECTED FINANCIAL RATIOS AND OTHER DATA
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
PERFORMANCE RATIOS
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Return on average assets
1.10
%
 
0.78
%
 
0.81
%
 
0.78
%
 
1.22
%
Return on average equity
10.80
%
 
8.83
%
 
10.01
%
 
9.36
%
 
18.47
%
Net interest margin
3.19
%
 
3.03
%
 
2.80
%
 
2.48
%
 
2.56
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
QUALITY RATIOS
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Non-performing assets to total assets
0.03
%
 
0.31
%
 
0.05
%
 
0.05
%
 
0.16
%
Allowance for loan losses to non-performing loans
479
%
 
80
%
 
547
%
 
568
%
 
219
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
CAPITAL RATIOS
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Stockholders' equity to total assets
8.36
%
 
10.73
%
 
8.51
%
 
8.45
%
 
8.85
%
Average stockholders' equity to average assets
10.19
%
 
8.81
%
 
8.14
%
 
8.37
%
 
6.62
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
OTHER DATA
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Book value per common share outstanding at end of year
$
39.30

 
$
33.24

 
$
28.33

 
$
23.55

 
$
26.79

Tangible book value per common share outstanding at end of year
$
31.57

 
$
24.60

 
$
27.91

 
$
23.17

 
$
26.42

Dividends declared per share at end of year
0.52

 
0.52

 
0.52

 
0.52

 
0.52

Number of full-service offices at end of year
10

 
10

 
11

 
11

 
12

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Common Shares Outstanding
8,523,641

 
8,163,022

 
6,169,604

 
6,070,654

 
5,443,881


Item 7.        Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
This section should be read in conjunction with the following parts of this Form 10-K:  Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data,” Part II, Item 7A, “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk,” and Part I, Item 1 “Business.”
 
General
 
The Company, a registered unitary savings and loan holding company, is a Delaware corporation, the principal assets of which are all the issued and outstanding shares of the Bank, a federal savings bank.  Unless the context otherwise requires, references herein to the Company include Meta Financial and the Bank, and all subsidiaries of Meta Financial, direct or indirect, on a consolidated basis.
 
Overview of Corporate Developments

On December 17, 2015, Meta closed private placement transactions to accredited investors, issuing an aggregate of 266,430 shares of its common stock for consideration of approximately $11.7 million. Meta is using the net proceeds from this stock issuance to support increased balance sheet growth and costs associated with agreements with multiple payment solutions providers.

On May 10, 2016, MetaBank, through its MPS division, entered into a new multi-year agreement with Blackhawk Network, Inc., a leading global prepaid and payments company. Under the agreement, Blackhawk will continue to provide marketing, servicing, and processing services for a broad range of consumer and corporate financial products issued by MetaBank.

73


On May 20, 2016, Bank Director named MetaBank the #1 Top Growth Bank among all banks and thrifts determined by top-line growth over a five quarter period ending March 31, 2016. The ranking was established by the compound average growth rate in revenues over the five linked quarters.

On August 15, 2016, the Company announced that it had completed the public offering of $75 million of its 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures due August 15, 2026. Use of proceeds from the offering are for general purposes, acquisitions and investments in MetaBank as Tier 1 capital to support growth.

On October 26, 2016, MetaBank entered into an agreement with certain H&R Block® entities to provide funding capacity for up to $1.45 billion and retain up to $750 million of interest-free refund advance loans for H&R Block® tax preparation customers throughout the 2017 tax season. H&R Block® is the world's largest tax services provider with approximately 12,000 company-owned and franchise retail tax office locations.
On November 1, 2016, MetaBank, completed the acquisition of substantially all of the assets and certain liabilities of EPS Financial, LLC (“EPS”) from privately-held Drake Enterprises, Ltd. (“Drake”). The assets acquired by MetaBank in the EPS acquisition include the EPS trade name, operating platform, and other assets. The EPS management team and other employees have been hired by MetaBank and EPS operations will continue to be based out of Easton, PA. The purchase price for the acquisition of approximately $42.5 million included the payment of approximately $21.3 million in cash and the issuance of 369,179 shares of Meta Financial common stock to Drake. The cash portion of the purchase price was funded from the proceeds of the previously announced subordinated debt issuance.

On November 9, 2016, Meta Financial and MetaBank entered into an agreement with Specialty Consumer Services LP, (‘SCS”) to acquire substantially all of the assets, and assume specified liabilities, of SCS. In exchange, Meta Financial has agreed to pay SCS consideration of approximately $15,000,000, subject to adjustment. If certain performance targets are met after the closing of the transaction, SCS will be eligible to receive earnout payments consisting of up to an aggregate of $17,500,000 in cash and up to an aggregate of 264,431 shares of Meta Financial’s common stock. The transaction is expected to close in the fourth calendar quarter of 2016.

On November 28, 2016, MetaBank and Jackson Hewitt finalized an agreement whereby MetaBank will be originating Express Refund Advances to Jackson Hewitt customers.
    
The Company recorded net income of $33.2 million in fiscal 2016 compared to $18.1 million in fiscal 2015.  The primary reason for the increase in net income was a significant rise in non-interest income, bolstered by growth in net interest income. In fiscal 2016, non-interest income increased to $100.8 million from $58.2 million in fiscal 2015, due to tax product fee income and an increase in card fee income. The Company’s net interest income grew to $77.3 million in fiscal 2016, compared to $59.2 million in fiscal 2015. The increase was driven by growth in both loan and investment volumes as well as the expansion in yields on these interest-earning assets.  Additionally, the continuous improvement in the overall asset mix also contributed to the increased net interest income, which was highlighted by loan growth and purchases of highly rated tax-exempt municipal securities at relatively high tax equivalent yields. Partially offsetting the higher non-interest income and net interest income was non-interest expense, which rose $38.1 million, from $96.5 million in fiscal 2015, to $134.6 million in fiscal 2016 and income tax expense which rose from $19.4 million to $38.8 million year over year.

The Company's banking segment 2016 fiscal year income before tax was $16.1 million, compared to $14.8 million in fiscal 2015.  Retail Bank total loans increased $146.8 million during the fiscal year, or 25%, to $737.4 million, from strong growth in residential real estate and commercial and multi-family real estate. Retail Bank checking balances continued to grow from $88.7 million at September 30, 2015, to $97.7 million, or 10%, at September 30, 2016
 
The Company's payments segment 2016 fiscal year income before tax was $29.7 million, compared to $14.1 million in fiscal 2015.  This improvement was primarily the result of increases in card fee income from new and existing business partners along with tax product fee income.  Average MPS deposits increased $398.9 million during fiscal 2016, or 25%, to $2.00 billion, compared to fiscal 2015.
 
Overall, the cost of funds at MetaBank averaged 0.15% during fiscal 2016, compared to 0.11% for 2015.
 
Tangible book value per common share increased by $6.97, or 28%, to $31.57 per share at September 30, 2016, from $24.60 per share at September 30, 2015.  This growth is attributable to increases in net income and accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) along with higher additional paid-in capital due to the Company's first quarter capital raise of approximately $11.7 million. The tangible book value per common share, excluding (“AOCI”) was $28.89 as of September 30, 2016, compared to $24.30 as of September 30, 2015.  Book value per common share outstanding increased by $6.06, or 18%, to $39.30 per share at September 30, 2016, from $33.24 per share at September 30, 2015.
 

74



The Company’s non-performing assets (“NPAs”) were 0.03% of total assets at September 30, 2016, compared to 0.31% at September 30, 2015.  The decrease from September 2015 was mainly due to the previously reported partial charge-off of a large non-performing agriculture relationship, which has no remaining loan balance.  Excluding the AFS/IBEX portfolio, NPAs were 0.01% of total assets at September 30, 2016.
 
Financial Condition
 
As of September 30, 2016, the Company’s assets grew by $1.48 billion, or 58%, to $4.01 billion, compared to $2.53 billion at September 30, 2015.  The growth in assets resulted from a variety of factors, including increases in the Company’s cash and cash equivalents, loan balances, and investment securities portfolio.
 
Total cash and cash equivalents was $773.8 million at September 30, 2016, an increase of $746.1 million from $27.7 million at September 30, 2015.  The majority of this increase was related to a temporary repositioning of the balance sheet in September 2016 to prepare the Company for potential strategic opportunities, including the H&R Block® agreement signed in October 2016. The Company anticipated utilizing the excess cash it held at its fiscal year end to repay overnight borrowings in October 2016. In general, the Company maintains its cash investments in interest-bearing overnight deposits with the FHLB of Des Moines and the FRB of Minneapolis.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had no federal funds sold.

The total of MBS and investment securities increased $487.3 million, or 30%, to $2.09 billion at September 30, 2016, compared to September 30, 2015, as investment purchases exceeded related maturities, sales and principal pay downs. The Company’s portfolio of securities consists primarily of MBS, which have relatively short expected lives, non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions (“NBQ”) which mature in approximately 15 years or less, and other tax exempt municipal mortgage related pass through securities which have average lives much shorter than their stated final maturities.  All MBS held by the Company are issued by a U.S. Government agency or instrumentality.  Of the total $692.7 million of MBS, $558.9 million are classified as available for sale (“AFS”), and $133.8 million are classified as held to maturity (“HTM”).  Of the total $1.40 billion of investment securities, $910.3 million are classified as AFS and $486.1 million are classified as HTM.  During fiscal 2016, the Company purchased $416.7 million of MBS with an average life estimated at approximately five years or less or stated final maturities of approximately 30 years or less and sold MBS in the amount of $221.6 million.  In addition, the Company purchased $486.2 million of investment securities which are comprised of tax exempt municipal bonds primarily backed by and/or convertible into Ginnie Mae, Fannie Mae, or Freddie Mac MBS securities, government related and guaranteed floating rate securities, and smaller portions of other security types.  See Note 6 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
The Company’s portfolio of net loans receivable increased by $213.2 million, or 30%, to $919.5 million at September 30, 2016, from $706.3 million at September 30, 2015.  This growth was driven by increases in commercial and multi-family real estate loans, and one-to-four family real estate loans, of $112.7 million, and $37.3 million, respectively, along with growth in AFS/IBEX premium finance loans of $65.1 million. Consumer loans and commercial operating loans also increased with agricultural operating and agricultural real estate categories representing the only decreases.  See Note 3 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Through the Bank, the Company owns stock in the FHLB due to the Bank’s membership and participation in this banking system.  The FHLB requires a level of stock investment based on a pre-determined formula.  The Company’s investment in such stock increased $23.1 million, or 95%, to $47.5 million at September 30, 2016, from $24.4 million at September 30, 2015.  The increase directly correlates with the higher overnight federal funds purchased.
 
Total deposits increased by $772.5 million, or 47%, to $2.43 billion at September 30, 2016, from $1.66 billion at September 30, 2015.  Deposits attributable to MPS were up $706.7 million, or 50%, at September 30, 2016, as compared to September 30, 2015.  The increase is due to the addition of several new business partners during fiscal 2016, along with natural growth in existing programs.
 
The Company’s total borrowings increased $624.1 million, or 111%, from $563.5 million at September 30, 2015, to $1.19 billion at September 30, 2016, primarily due to the increase in federal funds purchased, which was done as part of a temporary repositioning of the balance sheet, as noted above.  The Company’s overnight federal funds purchased fluctuates on a daily basis due to the nature of a portion of its non-interest-bearing deposit base, primarily related to payroll processing timing with a higher volume of overnight federal funds purchased on Monday and Tuesday, which are typically paid down throughout the week.  This predictable fluctuation may be augmented near a month-end by a prefunding of certain programs. In addition, the issuance of $75 million in subordinated debentures during the fourth quarter of fiscal 2016 was also reflected as part of the increased borrowings.
 

75


See Notes 8 and 9 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which are included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

At September 30, 2016, the Company’s stockholders’ equity totaled $335.0 million, an increase of $63.7 million from $271.3 million at September 30, 2015.  Stockholders’ equity increased primarily as a result of an increase in retained earnings and unrealized gains on securities, which increased due to several factors, including the timing of purchases, movement in the market rates, changes in the makeup of the securities portfolio, and as a result of the private placement of securities in December 2015.  At September 30, 2016, the Bank continued to meet regulatory requirements for classification as a well-capitalized institution.  See Note 13 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Results of Operations
 
The Company’s results of operations are dependent on net interest income, provision for loan losses, non-interest income, non-interest expense, income tax expense and other comprehensive income or loss.  Net interest income is the difference, or spread, between the average yield on interest-earning assets and the average rate paid on interest-bearing liabilities.  The interest rate spread is affected by regulatory, economic and competitive factors that influence interest rates, loan demand and deposit flows.  Notwithstanding that a significant amount of the Company’s deposits, primarily those attributable to MPS, pay low rates of interest or none at all, the Company, like other financial institutions, is subject to interest rate risk to the extent that its interest-earning assets mature or reprice at different times, or on a different basis, than its interest-bearing liabilities.
 
The Company’s non-interest income is derived primarily from tax product fees, prepaid cards, credit products, ATM fees attributable to MPS and fees charged on bank loans and transaction accounts.  Non-interest income is also derived from net gains on the sale of securities available for sale as well as the Company’s holdings of bank-owned life insurance.  This income is offset by expenses, such as compensation and occupancy expenses associated with additional personnel and office locations as well as card processing expenses attributable to MPS.  Non-interest expense is also impacted by acquisition-related expenses, occupancy and equipment expenses, regulatory expenses, and legal and consulting expenses.

76



Average Balances, Interest Rates and Yields
 
The following table presents, for the periods indicated, the total dollar amount of interest income from average interest-earning assets and the resulting yields, as well as the interest expense on average interest-bearing liabilities, expressed both in dollars and rates. Only the yield/rate have tax equivalent adjustments.  Non-Accruing loans have been included in the table as loans carrying a zero yield.
Year Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
(Dollars in Thousands)
Average
Outstanding
Balance
 
Interest
Earned /
Paid
 
Yield /
Rate
 
Average
Outstanding
Balance
 
Interest
Earned /
Paid
 
Yield /
Rate
 
Average
Outstanding
Balance
 
Interest
Earned /
Paid
 
Yield /
Rate
Interest-earning assets:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans receivable
$
810,445

 
$
36,187

 
4.47
%
 
$
617,866

 
$
29,565

 
4.79
%
 
$
439,323

 
$
19,674

 
4.48
%
Mortgage-backed securities
728,738

 
15,771

 
2.16
%
 
695,539

 
13,979

 
2.01
%
 
694,510

 
15,343

 
2.21
%
Other investments and fed funds sold
1,284,209

 
29,438

 
3.29
%
 
905,384

 
18,063

 
2.89
%
 
721,141

 
13,643

 
2.68
%
Total interest-earning assets
2,823,392

 
$
81,396

 
3.34
%
 
2,218,789

 
$
61,607

 
3.14
%
 
1,854,974

 
$
48,660

 
2.93
%
Non-interest-earning assets
193,286

 
 

 
 

 
103,138

 
 
 
 
 
73,878

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
3,016,678

 
 

 
 

 
$
2,321,927

 
 
 
 
 
$
1,928,852

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest bearing deposits
$
2,017,977

 
$

 
%
 
$
1,632,130

 
$

 
—%

 
$
1,319,447

 
$

 
%
Interest-bearing liabilities:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing checking
36,317

 
97

 
0.27
%
 
35,610

 
88

 
0.25
%
 
33,353

 
96

 
0.29
%
Savings
59,670

 
24

 
0.04
%
 
34,129

 
40

 
0.12
%
 
28,882

 
47

 
0.16
%
Money markets
46,115

 
75

 
0.16
%
 
39,401

 
61

 
0.15
%
 
40,589

 
72

 
0.18
%
Time deposits
79,825

 
418

 
0.52
%
 
85,843

 
537

 
0.63
%
 
110,992

 
750

 
0.68
%
FHLB advances
61,454

 
709

 
1.15
%
 
7,000

 
495

 
7.07
%
 
7,000

 
495

 
7.07
%
Overnight fed funds purchased
339,035

 
1,607

 
0.47
%
 
234,025

 
691

 
0.30
%
 
185,440

 
538

 
0.29
%
Subordinated debentures
9,437

 
539

 
5.71
%
 

 

 
%
 

 

 
%
Other borrowings
14,575

 
622

 
4.26
%
 
21,193

 
475

 
2.24
%
 
20,433

 
400

 
1.96
%
Total interest-bearing liabilities
646,428

 
4,091

 
0.63
%
 
457,201

 
2,387

 
0.56
%
 
426,689

 
2,398

 
0.82
%
Total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities
2,664,405

 
$
4,091

 
0.15
%
 
2,089,331

 
$
2,387

 
0.11
%
 
1,746,136

 
$
2,398

 
0.14
%
Other non-interest bearing liabilities
44,786

 
 

 
 

 
28,009

 
 

 
 

 
25,748

 
 

 
 

Total liabilities
2,709,191

 
 

 
 

 
2,117,340

 
 

 
 

 
1,771,884

 
 

 
 

Stockholders' equity
307,487

 
 

 
 

 
204,587

 
 

 
 

 
156,968

 
 

 
 

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity
$
3,016,678

 
 

 
 

 
$
2,321,927

 
 

 
 

 
$
1,928,852

 
 

 
 

Net interest income and net interest rate spread including non-interest bearing deposits
 

 
$
77,305

 
3.18
%
 
 

 
$
59,220

 
3.03
%
 
 

 
$
46,262

 
2.79
%
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net interest margin
 

 
 

 
3.19
%
 
 

 
 

 
3.03
%
 
 

 
 

 
2.80
%


77


Rate / Volume Analysis

The following table presents the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for major components of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities.  It distinguishes between the change related to higher outstanding balances and the change due to the levels and volatility of interest rates.  For each category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities, information is provided on changes attributable to (i) changes in volume (i.e., changes in volume multiplied by old rate) and (ii) changes in rate (i.e., changes in rate multiplied by old volume).  For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume that cannot be segregated have been allocated proportionately to the change due to volume and the change due to rate.

Rate / Volume

Year Ended September 30,
 
2016 vs. 2015
 
2015 vs. 2014
 
 
Increase /
(Decrease)
Due to Volume

 
Increase /
(Decrease)
Due to Rate

 
Total
Increase /
(Decrease)

 
Increase /
(Decrease)
Due to Volume

 
Increase /
(Decrease)
Due to Rate

 
Total
Increase /
(Decrease)

Interest-earning assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans Receivable
 
$
8,736

 
$
(2,114
)
 
$
6,622

 
$
8,452

 
$
1,439

 
$
9,891

Mortgage-backed securities
 
687

 
1,105

 
1,792

 
23

 
(1,387
)
 
(1,364
)
Other investments
 
8,528

 
2,847

 
11,375

 
3,383

 
1,037

 
4,420

Total interest-earning assets
 
$
17,951

 
$
1,838

 
$
19,789

 
$
11,858

 
$
1,089

 
$
12,947

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing liabilities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest-bearing checking
 
$
2

 
$
7

 
$
9

 
$
6

 
$
(14
)
 
$
(8
)
Savings
 
21

 
(37
)
 
(16
)
 
7

 
(14
)
 
(7
)
Money markets
 
9

 
5

 
14

 
(2
)
 
(9
)
 
(11
)
Time deposits
 
(35
)
 
(84
)
 
(119
)
 
(161
)
 
(52
)
 
(213
)
FHLB advances
 
941

 
(727
)
 
214

 

 

 

Overnight fed funds purchased
 
400

 
517

 
917

 
135

 
18

 
153

Subordinated debentures
 
539

 

 
539

 

 

 

Other borrowings
 
(183
)
 
329

 
146

 
15

 
60

 
75

Total interest-bearing liabilities
 
$
1,694

 
$
10

 
$
1,704

 
$

 
$
(11
)
 
$
(11
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net effect on net interest income
 
$
16,257

 
$
1,828

 
$
18,085

 
$
11,858

 
$
1,100

 
$
12,958


Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended
September 30, 2016, and September 30, 2015
 
General.  The Company recorded net income of $33.2 million, or $3.92 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2016, compared to $18.1 million, or $2.66 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2015, an increase of $15.1 million.  The increase in net income was primarily caused by tax product fee income of $23.3 million, a $16.0 million increase in card fee income, a $13.2 million increase in interest income from the securities portfolio, and a $6.6 million increase in loan interest income. The net income increase was offset in part by an increase in compensation and benefits expense of $15.2 million, tax product expense of $8.6 million, and increased card processing expense of $5.8 million.
 
Net Interest Income. Net interest income for fiscal 2016 increased by $18.1 million, or 31%, to $77.3 million from $59.2 million for the prior year.  Net interest margin increased to 3.19% in fiscal 2016 as compared to 3.03% in 2015.  The increase was mainly due to growth in loans receivable and a higher volume of other investments (primarily high credit quality municipal bonds). An improved mix of earning assets complemented the higher volume of investments, adding to the overall increase.
 
The Company’s average earning assets increased $604.6 million, or 27%, to $2.82 billion during fiscal 2016 from $2.22 billion during 2015.  The increase is primarily the result of the increase in the Company’s investment securities and non-bank qualified, high-quality municipal portfolios as well as loans receivable.
 

78


Overall, when using a taxable equivalent yield (“TEY”), the Company’s interest earning asset yield increased by 20 basis points primarily driven by a shift in the earning asset mix due to increased volume in loans and investment securities and improved yields achieved within the securities portfolio. The improvement in volume on loans receivable reflects the outsized growth in premium finance loans as well as strong growth in the typical retail banking sectors. The yield on non-MBS investment securities increased by 12 basis points on a TEY basis.  The yield on government-related MBS increased 15 basis points while longer-term interest rates decreased materially throughout the fiscal year.  Average TEY on the securities portfolio increased by 26 basis points in fiscal 2016 compared to fiscal 2015.

The Company’s average total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities increased $575.1 million, or 28%, to $2.66 billion during fiscal 2016 from $2.09 billion during 2015.  The increase resulted mainly from an increase in the Company’s non-interest-bearing deposits.  The average outstanding balance of non-interest-bearing deposits increased from $1.63 billion in fiscal 2015 to $2.02 billion in fiscal 2016.  The Company’s cost of total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities increased four basis points to 0.15% during fiscal 2016 from 0.11% during 2015, primarily due to an increase in the overnight borrowing rate as well as the issuance of the Company's subordinated debt. Notwithstanding this increase, the Company believes that its growing, lower-cost deposit base gives it a distinct and significant competitive advantage, and even more so if interest rates rise, because the Company anticipates that its cost of funds will likely remain relatively low, increasing less than at many other banks.

Provision for Loan Losses. In fiscal 2016, the Company recorded $4.6 million in provision for loan loss, compared to $1.5 million in 2015.  The increased provision was primarily due to loan growth as well as seasonal charge-offs related to refund advance loan programs, and also partially due to a write down and eventual charge-off of a large agriculture relationship.
 
Management closely monitors economic developments, both regionally and nationwide, and considers these factors when assessing the appropriateness of its allowance for loan losses.  While the current economic environment is still slightly strained, it has continued to show signs of improvement over the last several years in the Company’s markets.  The Company’s average loss rates over the past three years have been relatively low for all loan segments, which is slightly offset by a current year charge off a significant loan relationship within the agricultural operating segment.  Notwithstanding these signs of improvement noted above, the Company does not believe it is likely these low loss conditions will continue indefinitely. Each loan segment is evaluated using both historical loss factors as well as other qualitative factors in order to determine the amount of risk the Company believes exist within that pool of loans.
 
The allowance for loan losses for the MPS division, which constitute a small portion of the Company’s loans, results from an estimation process that evaluates relevant characteristics of its credit portfolio(s).  MPS also considers other internal and external environmental factors such as changes in operations or personnel and economic events that may affect the adequacy of the allowance for credit losses. Adjustments to the allowance for loan losses are recorded periodically based on the result of this estimation process.  The exact methodology to determine the allowance for loan losses for each program will not be identical. Each program may have differing attributes including such factors as levels of risk, definitions of delinquency and loss, inclusion/exclusion of credit bureau criteria, roll rate migration dynamics and other factors. Similarly, the additional capital required to offset the increased risk in subprime lending activities may vary by credit program. Each program is evaluated separately.
 
Management believes that, based on a detailed review of the loan portfolio, historic loan losses, current economic conditions, the size of the loan portfolio and other factors, the current level of the allowance for loan losses at September 30, 2016, reflects an appropriate allowance against probable losses from the loan portfolio. Although the Company maintains its allowance for loan losses at a level that it considers to be adequate, investors and others are cautioned that there can be no assurance that future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods. In addition, the Company's determination of the allowance for loan losses is subject to review by its regulatory agencies, the OCC and the Federal Reserve, which can require the establishment of additional general or specific allowances.

Non‑Interest Income. Non-interest income increased by $42.6 million, or 73%, to $100.8 million for fiscal 2016 from $58.2 million for 2015 primarily due to tax product fee income of $23.3 million related to the acquisition of Refund Advantage in September 2015, an increase in fees earned on prepaid debit cards, credit products and other payment systems products of $16.0 million due to the addition of multiple new partners and growth in existing MPS programs. Loan fees also increased by $2.9 million from retail and premium finance loan growth. 
 








79


Non-Interest Expense. Non-interest expense increased by $38.1 million, or 40%, to $134.6 million for fiscal 2016 from $96.5 million for fiscal 2015. Compensation expense increased $15.2 million during fiscal 2016 compared to 2015, and occupancy and equipment increased $2.6 million. The increases in these categories were principally due to a full year of expenses associated with the Refund Advantage and AFS/IBEX operations and due to additional product development and IT developer staffing to support the Company’s growth initiatives and prepare for other business opportunities.  In addition, tax product expense increased $8.6 million due to the Refund Advantage acquisition, card-processing expense increased $5.8 million, and other expense increased $2.2 million primarily due to intangibles amortization and overall Company growth initiatives. A significant portion of the increase in card-processing expense was due to sales promotions from one of our largest partners and is a variable expense directly tied to the fee income growth.

Income Tax Expense. Income tax expense for fiscal 2016 was $5.6 million, resulting in an effective tax rate of 14%, compared to a tax expense of $1.4 million and an effective tax rate of 7%, in fiscal 2015.  The increase in the Company’s recorded income tax expense for 2016 was impacted primarily by an increase in earnings and also by higher year-to-date income than what was projected; however, the increase was partially reduced by an increase in tax-exempt income, highlighting one of the benefits of our growing tax-exempt municipal securities portfolio.
 
Comparison of Operating Results for the Years Ended
September 30, 2015, and September 30, 2014
 
General.  The Company recorded net income of $18.1 million, or $2.66 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2015, compared to $15.7 million, or $2.53 per diluted share, for the year ended September 30, 2014, an increase of $2.4 million. The increase in net income was primarily caused by a $9.9 million increase in loan income, a $5.8 million increase in card fee income, a $3.1 million increase related to the securities portfolio and a decrease in tax expense of $1.5 million. The net income increase was offset in part by an increase in compensation and benefits expense of $8.3 million, increased occupancy and equipment expense of $2.4 million, an increased loss on sale of securities of $1.7 million, increased intangible amortization expense of $1.3 million, increased regulatory expense of $1.1 million and increased card processing expense of $1.0 million.
 
Net Interest Income. Net interest income for fiscal 2015 increased by $12.9 million, or 28.0%, to $59.2 million from $46.3 million for the prior year.  Net interest margin increased to 3.03% in fiscal 2015 as compared to 2.80% in 2014.
 
The Company’s average earning assets increased $363.8 million, or 20.0%, to $2.2 billion during fiscal 2015 from $1.8 billion during 2014. The increase is primarily the result of the increase in the Company’s investment securities and non-bank qualified, high-quality municipal portfolios as well as loans receivable.

The Company’s average total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities increased $343.2 million, or 19.7%, to $2.1 billion during fiscal 2015 from $1.7 billion during 2014. The increase resulted mainly from an increase in the Company’s non-interest-bearing deposits and federal funds purchased. The average outstanding balance of non-interest-bearing deposits increased from $1.3 billion in fiscal 2014 to $1.6 billion in fiscal 2015. The Company’s cost of total deposits and interest-bearing liabilities declined three basis points to 0.11% during fiscal 2015 from 0.14% during 2014, primarily due to continued migration to low- and no-cost deposits provided by MPS.
Provision for Loan Losses. In fiscal 2015, the Company recorded $1.5 million in provision for loan loss, compared to $1.2 million in 2014.  The increased provision was primarily due to loan growth.
 
Non-Interest Income. Non-interest income increased by $6.4 million, or 12.4%, to $58.2 million for fiscal 2015 from $51.7 million for 2014 primarily due to an increase in fees earned on prepaid debit cards, credit products and other payment systems products of $5.8 million due to the addition of multiple new partners and growth in existing MPS programs. Loan fees also increased by $1.4 million from retail loan growth and the addition of AFS/IBEX. These increases in non-interest income were partially offset by an increased loss on the securities available for sale of $1.7 million sold primarily to fund the AFS/IBEX transaction.
 
Non-Interest Expense. Non-interest expense increased by $18.3 million, or 23.4%, to $96.5 million for fiscal 2015 from $78.2 million for fiscal 2014.
 
Compensation expense increased $8.3 million during fiscal 2015 compared to 2014, occupancy and equipment increased $2.4 million, and intangible amortization expense increased $1.3 million. These increases were principally due to the Refund Advantage and AFS/IBEX acquisitions and to additional product development and IT developer staffing to support the Company’s growth initiatives and prepare for other business opportunities. In addition, regulatory expense increased $1.1 million primarily relating to an increase in FDIC insurance due to brokered deposit classification guidance published in January 2015 and higher deposit balances.


80


Income Tax Expense. Income tax expense for fiscal 2015 was $1.4 million, resulting in an effective tax rate of 7.0%, compared to a tax expense of $2.9 million and an effective tax rate of 15.6%, in fiscal 2014. The decrease in the Company’s recorded income tax expense for 2015 was impacted primarily by an increase in the amount of tax-exempt municipal bond income as a percent of net income before tax.
 
Critical Accounting Estimates
 
The Company’s financial statements are prepared in accordance with U.S. Generally Accepted Accounting Principles (“GAAP”).  The financial information contained within these statements is, to a significant extent, financial information that is based on approximate measures of the financial effects of transactions and events that have already occurred.  Based on its consideration of accounting policies that:  (i) involve the most complex and subjective decisions and assessments which may be uncertain at the time the estimate was made, and (ii) different estimates that reasonably could have been used in the current period, or changes in the accounting estimate that are reasonably likely to occur from period to period, would have a material impact on the financial statements, management has identified the policies described below as Critical Accounting Policies.
 
Allowance for Loan Losses.  The Company’s allowance for loan loss methodology incorporates a variety of risk considerations, both quantitative and qualitative, in establishing an allowance for loan loss that management believes is appropriate at each reporting date.  Quantitative factors include the Company’s historical loss experience, delinquency and charge-off trends, collateral values, changes in non-performing loans and other factors.  Quantitative factors also incorporate known information about individual loans, including borrowers’ sensitivity to interest rate movements.  Qualitative factors include the general economic environment in the Company’s markets, including economic conditions throughout the Midwest and, in particular, the state of certain industries.  Size and complexity of individual credits in relation to loan structure, existing loan policies and pace of portfolio growth are other qualitative factors that are considered in the methodology.  Although management believes the levels of the allowance as of both September 30, 2016, and September 30, 2015, were adequate to absorb probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio, a decline in local economic conditions or other factors could result in increasing losses.
 
Goodwill and Intangible Assets.  Goodwill is recorded in business combinations under the purchase method of accounting. We assess goodwill for impairment on an annual basis or more frequently if significant changes occur. We initially perform a qualitative assessment of goodwill to test for impairment. If, based on our qualitative review, we conclude that more likely than not the fair value is less than its carrying amount, then we complete quantitative steps to determine if goodwill is impaired.

Intangible assets include customer relationships, patents, trademarks and non-compete agreements.  Intangible assets are tested annually for impairment or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment.
 
Determining the fair value of a reporting unit involves the use of significant estimates and assumptions.  These estimates and assumptions include revenue growth rates and operating margins used to calculate future cash flows, risk-adjusted discount rates, future economic and market conditions, comparison of the Company’s market value to book value and determination of appropriate market comparables.  Actual future results may differ from those estimates.
 
Each quarter, the Company evaluates the estimated useful lives of intangible assets and whether events or changes in circumstances warrant a revision to the remaining periods of amortization.  In accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 350, Intangibles – Goodwill and Other, recoverability of these assets is measured by comparison of the carrying amount of the asset to the future undiscounted cash flows the asset is expected to generate.  If the asset is considered to be impaired, the amount of any impairment is measured as the difference between the carrying value and the fair value of the impaired asset.
 
Assumptions and estimates about future values and remaining useful lives of the Company’s intangible and other long-lived assets are complex and subjective.  They can be affected by a variety of factors, including external factors such as industry and economic trends, and internal factors such as changes in the Company’s business strategy and internal forecasts.  Although the Company believes the historical assumptions and estimates used are reasonable and appropriate, different assumptions and estimates could materially impact the reported financial results.
 
Deferred Tax Assets and Liabilities.  The Company accounts for income taxes according to the asset and liability method.  Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax basis.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using the enacted tax rates applicable to income for the years in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled.  Deferred tax assets are recognized subject to management’s judgment that realization is more likely than not.  An estimate of probable income tax benefits that will not be realized in future years is required in determining the necessity for a valuation allowance.
 


81


Security Impairment.  Management continually monitors the investment securities portfolio for impairment on a security-by-security basis.  Management has a process in place to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary.  This process involves the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, monitoring changes in value, cash flow projections and the Company’s intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost which, in some cases, may extend to maturity.  To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized.  If the Company intends to sell a security or it is more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, the Company recognizes an other-than-temporary impairment in earnings for the difference between amortized cost and fair value.  If we do not expect to recover the amortized cost basis, we do not plan to sell the security and if it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, the recognition of the other-than-temporary impairment is bifurcated.  For those securities, the Company separates the total impairment into a credit loss component recognized in earnings, and the amount of the loss related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income net of taxes.

The amount of the credit loss component of a debt security impairment is estimated as the difference between amortized cost and the present value of the expected cash flows of the security.  The present value is determined using the best estimate of cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate implicit to the security at the date of purchase or the current yield to accrete an asset-backed or floating rate security.  Cash flow estimates for trust preferred securities are derived from scenario-based outcomes of forecasted default rates, loss severity, prepayment speeds and structural support.
 
In fiscal 2016, 2015 and 2014, there were no other-than-temporary impairment losses.
 
Level 3 Fair Value Measurement.  U.S. GAAP requires the Company to measure the fair value of financial instruments under a standard that describes three levels of inputs that may be used to measure fair value.  Level 3 measurement includes significant unobservable inputs that reflect the Company’s own assumptions about the assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset or liability.  Level 3 assets and liabilities include financial instruments whose value is determined using pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies or similar techniques, as well as instruments for which the determination of fair value requires significant management judgment or estimation.  Although management believes that it uses a best estimate of information available to determine fair value, due to the uncertainty of future events, the approach includes a process that may differ significantly from other methodologies and still produce an estimate that is in accordance with U.S. GAAP.
 
Interest Rate Risk (“IRR”)
 
Overview.  The Company actively manages interest rate risk, as changes in market interest rates can have a significant impact on reported earnings.  The Bank, like other financial institutions, is subject to interest rate risk to the extent that its interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more rapidly than its interest-earning assets.  The interest rate risk process is designed to compare income simulations in market scenarios designed to alter the direction, magnitude and speed of interest rate changes, as well as the slope of the yield curve.  The Company does not currently engage in trading activities to control interest rate risk although it may do so in the future, if deemed necessary, to help manage interest rate risk.
 
Earnings at risk and economic value analysis. As a continuing part of its financial strategy, the Bank considers methods of managing an asset/liability mismatch consistent with maintaining acceptable levels of net interest income.  In order to monitor interest rate risk, the Board of Directors has created an Investment Committee whose principal responsibilities are to assess the Bank’s asset/liability mix and implement strategies that will enhance income while managing the Bank’s vulnerability to changes in interest rates.
 
The Company uses two approaches to model interest rate risk: Earnings at Risk (“EAR analysis”) and Economic Value of Equity (“EVE analysis”).  Under EAR analysis, net interest income is calculated for each interest rate scenario to the net interest income forecast in the base case.  EAR analysis measures the sensitivity of interest-sensitive earnings over a one-year minimum time horizon.  The results are affected by projected rates, prepayments, caps and floors. Market-implied forward rates and various likely and extreme interest rate scenarios can be used for EAR analysis.  These likely and extreme scenarios can include rapid and gradual interest rate ramps, rate shocks and yield curve twists.
 
The EAR analysis used in the following table reflects the required analysis used no less than quarterly by management.  It models -100, +100, +200, +300 and +400 basis point parallel shifts in market interest rates over the next one-year period.  Due to the current low level of interest rates, only a ‑100 basis point parallel shift is represented.

The Company is within policy limits for all interest rate scenarios using the snapshot as of September 30, 2016, as required by regulation.  The table below shows the results of the scenarios as of September 30, 2016:
 

82


Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk as of September 30, 2016
 
Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk
Balances as of September 30, 2016
Standard (Parallel Shift) Year 1
 
Net Interest Income at Risk%
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Basis Point Change Scenario
-4.5
 %
 
0.5
 %
 
-0.9
 %
 
-2.2
 %
 
-2.8
 %
Board Policy Limits
-5.0
 %
 
-5.0
 %
 
-10.0
 %
 
-15.0
 %
 
-20.0
 %

The EAR analysis reported at September 30, 2016, shows that in an increasing +200, +300, and +400 interest rate environment, more liabilities (primarily due to the overnight federal funds purchased) than assets will reprice over the modeled one-year period.
 
IRR is a snapshot in time.  The Company’s business and deposits are very predictably cyclical on a weekly, monthly and yearly basis.  The Company’s static IRR results could vary depending on which day of the week and timing in relation to certain payrolls, as well as time of the month in regard to early funding of certain programs, when this snapshot is taken.  The Company’s overnight federal funds purchased fluctuates on a predictable daily and monthly basis due to fluctuations in a portion of its non-interest bearing deposit base, primarily related to payroll processing and timing of when certain programs are prefunded and when the funds are received. Fiscal fourth quarter 2016 results do not necessarily show the typical effect of day of week cyclicality due to the temporary repositioning of the balance sheet, as previously noted. Owing to the snapshot nature of IRR, as is required by regulators, in concert with the Company’s predictable weekly, monthly and yearly fluctuating deposit base and overnight borrowings, the results produced by static IRR analysis are not necessarily representative of what management, the Board of Directors and others would view as the Company’s true IRR positioning.  Management and the Board are aware of and understand these typical borrowing and deposit fluctuations as well as the point in time nature of IRR analysis and anticipated an outcome where the Company may temporarily be outside of Board policy limits based on a snapshot analysis.
 
For management to better understand the IRR position of the Bank, an alternative IRR run was completed which all September 30, 2016, values were utilized with the exception of overnight borrowings, non-interest bearing deposits, cash due from banks, non-earning assets, and non-paying liabilities. To diminish potential issues documented above, quarterly average balances were utilized for overnight borrowings, non-interest-bearing deposits, and cash due from banks. Non-earning assets and non-paying liabilities were used to balance the balance sheet. Management feels this view on IRR, while still subject to some yearly cyclicality, more accurately portrays the Banks IRR position.  As noted in the below chart, the alternative EAR results are more normalized and slightly improved in increasing rate scenarios as timing issues in deposits and overnight borrowings are diminished.

The Company would be within policy limits in all scenarios utilizing the alternative IRR scenario run for management purposes.  The table below highlights those results:
 
Alternative Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk
 
Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk
Alternative IRR Results
Standard (Parallel Shift) Year 1
 
Net Interest Income at Risk%
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Basis Point Change Scenario
-4.6
 %
 
0.9
 %
 
-0.2
 %
 
-1.2
 %
 
-1.4
 %
Board Policy Limits
-5.0
 %
 
-5.0
 %
 
-10.0
 %
 
-15.0
 %
 
-20.0
 %
 
The alternative EAR analysis reported at September 30, 2016 shows that in an increasing +200, +300, and +400 interest rate environment, more liabilities than assets will reprice over the modeled one-year period.
The alternative IRR results were somewhat lower in rising interest rate environments compared to the fiscal 2016 third quarter as a portion of the tax related deposits continued to decay and normalize, as expected, which resulted in somewhat higher average borrowings and a decreased average non-interest bearing deposit base in fiscal 2016 fourth quarter. The Company anticipates solid EAR results in a rising rate environment due to continued year-over-year non-interest bearing deposit growth, a significantly growing AFS/IBEX loan portfolio, and the sustained execution on its strategic plan.
 

83


Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk as of September 30, 2016
 
Balances as of September 30, 2016
 
 
% of
 
Change in Interest Income/Expense
for a given change in interest rates
 
Total Earning
 
Total Earning
 
Over / (Under) Base Case Parallel Ramp
Basis Point Change Scenario
Assets (in $000's)
 
Assets
 
-100
 
Base
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Total Loans
927,554

 
27.4
%
 
47,557

 
50,296

 
53,055

 
55,748

 
58,450

 
61,204

Total Investments (non-TEY) and other Earning Assets
2,456,581

 
72.6
%
 
41,796

 
48,982

 
58,845

 
66,987

 
75,145

 
84,021

Total Interest -Sensitive Income
3,384,135

 
100.0
%
 
89,353

 
99,278

 
111,900

 
122,735

 
133,595

 
145,225

Total Interest-Bearing Deposits
262,560

 
19.3
%
 
523

 
791

 
2,016

 
3,241

 
4,467

 
5,693

Total Borrowings
1,099,000

 
80.7
%
 
594

 
6,066

 
16,973

 
27,879

 
38,785

 
49,691

Total Interest-Sensitive Expense
1,361,560

 
100.0
%
 
1,117

 
6,857

 
18,989

 
31,120

 
43,252

 
55,384

 
Alternative Net Sensitive Earnings at Risk
 
Alternative IRR Results
 
 
 
% of
 
Change in Interest Income/Expense
for a given change in interest rates
 
Total Earning
 
Total Earning
 
Over / (Under) Base Case Parallel Ramp
Basis Point Change Scenario
Assets (in $000's)
 
Assets
 
-100
 
Base
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Total Loans
927,032

 
32.4
%
 
47,557

 
50,296

 
53,055

 
55,748

 
58,450

 
61,204

Total Investments (non-TEY) and other Earning Assets
1,937,062

 
67.6
%
 
41,239

 
45,715

 
50,382

 
53,332

 
56,300

 
59,988

Total Interest -Sensitive Income
2,864,094

 
100.0
%
 
88,796

 
96,011

 
103,437

 
109,080

 
114,750

 
121,192

Total Interest-Bearing Deposits
264,835

 
32.5
%
 
522

 
789

 
2,022

 
3,254

 
4,486

 
5,719

Total Borrowings
549,272

 
67.5
%
 
600

 
3,313

 
8,700

 
14,087

 
19,474

 
24,861

Total Interest-Sensitive Expense
814,107

 
100.0
%
 
1,122

 
4,102

 
10,722

 
17,341

 
23,960

 
30,580


The Company believes that its growing portfolio of non-interest bearing deposits provides a stable and profitable funding vehicle and a significant competitive advantage in a rising interest rate environment as the Company’s cost of funds will likely remain relatively low, with less increase expected relative to other banks. When not able to match loan growth to deposit growth, the Company continues to execute its investment strategy of primarily purchasing NBQ municipal bonds and agency MBS, however, the Bank reviews opportunities to add diverse, high quality securities at attractive relative rates when opportunities present themselves. The NBQ municipal bonds are tax exempt and as such have a tax equivalent yield higher than their book yield. The tax equivalent yield calculation for NBQ municipal bonds uses the Company’s cost of funds as one of its components. With the Company’s large volume of non-interest bearing deposits, the tax equivalent yield for these NBQ municipal bonds is higher than a similar term investment in other investment categories of similar risk and higher than most other banks can realize and sustain on the same or similar instruments. The above interest income figures are quoted on a pre-tax basis which is particularly notable due to the size of the Company’s tax-exempt municipal portfolio.
 
Under EVE analysis, the economic value of financial assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet instruments is derived under each rate scenario.  The economic value of equity is calculated as the difference between the estimated market value of assets and liabilities, net of the impact of off-balance sheet instruments.
 
The EVE analysis used in the following table reflects the required analysis used no less than quarterly by management.  It models immediate -100, +100, +200, 300 and +400 basis point parallel shifts in market interest rates.  Due to the current low level of interest rates, only a -100 basis point parallel shift is represented.
 
The Company is within Board policy limits for all scenarios. The table below shows the results of the scenario as of September 30, 2016:
 


84


Economic Value Sensitivity as of September 30, 2016
 
Balances as of September 30, 2016
Standard (Parallel Shift)
 
Economic Value of Equity at Risk%
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Basis Point Change Scenario
1.6
 %
 
-3.7
 %
 
-8.3
 %
 
-13.1
 %
 
-17.2
 %
Board Policy Limits
-10.0
 %
 
-10.0
 %
 
-20.0
 %
 
-30.0
 %
 
-40.0
 %
 
The EVE at risk reported at September 30, 2016, shows that as interest rates increase immediately, the economic value of equity position will decrease from the base, partially due to the degree of the economic value of its base asset size in relation to the economic value of its base liabilities.
 
The Company would be within policy limits in all scenarios utilizing the alternative IRR scenario run for management purposes.  The table below highlights those results:
 
Alternative Economic Value Sensitivity
 
Alternative IRR Results
Standard (Parallel Shift)
 
Economic Value of Equity at Risk%
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Basis Point Change Scenario
2.1
 %
 
-4.2
 %
 
-9.4
 %
 
-14.7
 %
 
-19.3
 %
Board Policy Limits
-10.0
 %
 
-10.0
 %
 
-20.0
 %
 
-30.0
 %
 
-40.0
 %

The EVE at risk reported using the alternative methodology used for management purposes shows that as interest rates increase immediately, the economic value of equity position will decrease from the base, partially due to the degree of the economic value of its base asset size in relation to the economic value of its base liabilities. These results are marginally lower than the static snapshot as the effects of the temporary balance sheet repositioning noted above are diminished.
 
Detailed Economic Value Sensitivity as of September 30, 2016
 
The following table details the economic value sensitivity to changes in market interest rates at September 30, 2016, for loans, investments, deposits, borrowings and other assets and liabilities (dollars in thousands).  The analysis reflects that in a -100 interest rate scenario, total assets are less sensitive than total liabilities and in the +200, +300, and +400 interest rate scenarios, total assets are more sensitive than total liabilities. This sensitivity is offset by the non-interest bearing deposits.
 
Balances as of September 30, 2016
 
 
% of
 
Change in Economic Value
for a given change in interest rates
 
Book
 
Total
 
Over / (Under) Base Case Parallel Ramp
Basis Point Change Scenario
Value (in $000's)
 
Assets
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Total Loans
927,554

 
23
%
 
1.6
%
 
-1.9
 %
 
-4.0
 %
 
-6.0
 %
 
-7.9
 %
Total Investment
2,456,581

 
61
%
 
4.6
%
 
-4.6
 %
 
-9.1
 %
 
-13.3
 %
 
-17.1
 %
Other Assets
611,563

 
15
%
 
%
 
 %
 
 %
 
 %
 
 %
Assets
3,995,698

 
100
%
 
3.5
%
 
-3.5
 %
 
-7.0
 %
 
-10.2
 %
 
-13.2
 %
Interest Bearing Deposits
262,560

 
7
%
 
2.4
%
 
-1.6
 %
 
-3.0
 %
 
-4.3
 %
 
-5.6
 %
Non-Interest Bearing Deposits
2,172,663

 
60
%
 
6.4
%
 
-5.9
 %
 
-11.2
 %
 
-16.1
 %
 
-20.6
 %
Total Borrowings & Other Liabilities
1,156,901

 
32
%
 
%
 
 %
 
 %
 
-0.1
 %
 
-0.1
 %
Liabilities
3,592,124

 
100
%
 
3.9
%
 
-3.5
 %
 
-6.7
 %
 
-9.6
 %
 
-12.3
 %
 
Detailed Alternative Economic Value Sensitivity
 
The following is EVE at risk reported using the alternative methodology used for management purposes, for loans, investments, deposits, borrowings, and other assets and liabilities (dollars in thousands). The analysis reflects that in all rising interest rate scenarios, total assets are more sensitive than total liabilities.

85


 
Alternative IRR Results
 
 
 
% of
 
Change in Economic Value
for a given change in interest rates
Economic Value Sensitivity
Book
 
Total
 
Over / (Under) Base Case Parallel Ramp
Basis Point Change Scenario
Value (in $000's)
 
Assets
 
-100
 
+100
 
+200
 
+300
 
+400
Total Loans
927,032

 
23
%
 
1.6
%
 
-1.9
 %
 
-4.0
 %
 
-6.1
 %
 
-7.9
 %
Total Investment
1,937,062

 
48
%
 
5.8
%
 
-5.8
 %
 
-11.3
 %
 
-16.5
 %
 
-21.2
 %
Other Assets
1,131,604

 
28
%
 
%
 
 %
 
 %
 
 %
 
 %
Assets
3,995,698

 
100
%
 
3.5
%
 
-3.5
 %
 
-7.0
 %
 
-10.2
 %
 
-13.2
 %
Interest Bearing Deposits
264,835

 
7
%
 
2.5
%
 
-1.6
 %
 
-3.1
 %
 
-4.4
 %
 
-5.7
 %
Non-Interest Bearing Deposits
2,226,772

 
60
%
 
6.5
%
 
-5.9
 %
 
-11.3
 %
 
-16.2
 %
 
-20.8
 %
Total Borrowings & Other Liabilities
1,239,360

 
33
%
 
%
 
 %
 
 %
 
-0.1
 %
 
-0.1
 %
Liabilities
3,730,967

 
100
%
 
3.7
%
 
-3.4
 %
 
-6.5
 %
 
-9.3
 %
 
-11.9
 %

Certain shortcomings are inherent in the method of analysis discussed above and as presented in the table. For example, although certain assets and liabilities may have similar maturities or periods to repricing, they may react in different degrees to changes in market interest rates. Also, the interest rates on certain types of assets and liabilities may fluctuate in advance of changes in market interest rates, while interest rates on other types may lag behind changes in market rates. Additionally, certain assets, such as adjustable rate mortgage loans, have features that restrict changes in interest rates on a short-term basis and over the life of the asset. Furthermore, although management has estimated changes in the levels of prepayments and early withdrawal in these rate environments, such levels would likely deviate from those assumed in calculating the table. Finally, the ability of some borrowers to service their debt may decrease in the event of an interest rate increase. 
Asset Quality
 
It is management’s belief, based on information available at the end of fiscal 2016, that the Company’s current asset quality is satisfactory.  At September 30, 2016, non-performing assets, consisting of impaired/non-accruing loans, accruing loans delinquent 90 days or more, foreclosed real estate and repossessed consumer property totaled $1.2 million, or 0.03% of total assets, compared to $7.8 million, or 0.31% of total assets, at September 30, 2015.  The noted change in NPAs is primarily due to the charge-off of a large agricultural relationship in 2016. The majority of the past due receivables related to AFS/IBEX is due to the notification requirements and processing time by most insurance carriers while the insurer is processing the return of the unearned premium. Management will continue to accrue interest until maturity as the unearned premium is ordinarily sufficient to pay off the outstanding balance and the contractual interest due.
 
Non-accruing loans at September 30, 2016, totaled approximately $83,000. The Company had a repossessed asset of approximately $76,000 at September 30, 2016.
 
The Company maintains an allowance for loan losses because it is probable that some loans may not be repaid in full.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had an allowance for loan losses of $5.6 million as compared to $6.2 million at September 30, 2015. This decrease was mainly due to a fiscal 2016 third quarter partial charge-off of a large, non-performing agricultural relationship, which has no remaining outstanding loan balance. Management’s periodic review of the allowance for loan losses is based on various subjective and objective factors including the Company’s past loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral and current economic conditions.  While management may allocate portions of the allowance for specifically identified problem loan situations, the majority of the allowance is based on both subjective and objective factors related to the overall loan portfolio and is available for any loan charge-offs that may occur.  As stated previously, there can be no assurance future losses will not exceed estimated amounts, or that additional provisions for loan losses will not be required in future periods.  In addition, the Bank is subject to review by the OCC, which has the authority to require management to make changes to the allowance for loan losses, and the Company is subject to similar review by the Federal Reserve.
 
In determining the allowance for loan losses, the Company specifically identifies loans it considers to have potential collectability problems.  Based on criteria established by ASC 310, Receivables, some of these loans are considered to be “impaired” while others are not considered to be impaired, but possess weaknesses that the Company believes merit additional analysis in establishing the allowance for loan losses.  All other loans are evaluated by applying estimated loss ratios to various pools of loans.  The Company then analyzes other qualitative factors (such as economic conditions) in determining the aggregate amount of the allowance needed.


86


At September 30, 2016, $10,000 of the allowance for loan losses was allocated to impaired loans, representing 1.7% of the related loan balances.  See Note 3 of the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  $0.9 million of the allowance was allocated to other identified problem loan situations, representing 1.9% of the related loan balances, and $4.7 million, representing 0.5% of the related loan balances, was allocated to the remaining overall loan portfolio based on historical loss experience and qualitative factors.  At September 30, 2015, $3.5 million of the allowance for loan losses was allocated to impaired loans, representing 52.8% of the related loan balances.  $0.2 million was allocated to other identified problem loan situations, and $3.0 million was allocated against losses from the overall loan portfolio based on historical loss experience and qualitative factors.
 
The Company maintains an internal loan review and classification process which involves multiple officers of the Company and is designed to assess the general quality of credit underwriting and to promote early identification of potential problem loans.  All loan officers are charged with the responsibility of risk rating all loans in their portfolios and updating the ratings, positively or negatively, on an ongoing basis as conditions warrant.
 
The level of potential problem loans is another predominant factor in determining the relative level of risk in the loan portfolio and in determining the appropriate level of the allowance for loan losses.  Potential problem loans are generally defined by management to include loans rated as substandard by management but that are not considered impaired (i.e., nonaccrual loans and accruing troubled debt restructurings); however, there are circumstances present to create doubt as to the ability of the borrower to comply with present repayment terms.  The decision of management to include performing loans in potential problem loans does not necessarily mean that the Company expects losses to occur, but that management recognizes a higher degree or risk associated with these loans.  The loans that have been reported as potential problem loans are predominantly commercial loans covering a diverse range of businesses and real estate property types.  At September 30, 2016, potential problem loans totaled $8.9 million, compared to $5.8 million at September 30, 2015.  The $3.1 million increase in potential problem loans since September 30, 2015, was primarily due to a net increase in the agricultural operating category, due to the downgrading of several loans during fiscal 2016.
 
Liquidity and Capital Resources
 
On August 15, 2016, the Company announced that it had completed the public offering of $75 million of its 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures due August 15, 2026. Use of proceeds from the offering are for general purposes, acquisitions and investments in MetaBank as Tier 1 capital to support growth

The Company’s primary sources of funds are deposits, derived principally through its MPS division, and to a lesser extent through its Retail Bank division, borrowings, principal and interest payments on loans and mortgage-backed securities, and maturing investment securities.  While scheduled loan repayments and maturing investments are relatively predictable, deposit flows and early loan repayments are influenced by the level of interest rates, general economic conditions and competition.
 
The Company relies on advertising, quality customer service, convenient locations and competitive pricing to attract and retain its Retail Bank deposits and primarily solicits these deposits from its core market areas.  Based on its experience, the Company believes that its consumer checking, savings and money market accounts are relatively stable sources of deposits.  The Company’s ability to attract and retain time deposits has been, and will continue to be, affected by market conditions.  However, the Company does not foresee any significant Retail Bank funding issues resulting from the sensitivity of time deposits to such market factors.
 
The Company is aware that the low-cost checking deposits generated through MPS may carry a greater degree of concentration risk than traditional consumer checking deposits but, based on experience, believes that MPS‑generated deposits are a stable source of funding.  To date, the Company has not experienced any material net outflows related to MPS‑generated deposits, though no assurance can be given that this will continue to be the case.

The Bank is required by regulation to maintain sufficient liquidity to assure its safe and sound operation.  In the opinion of management, the Bank is in compliance with this requirement.
 
Liquidity management is both a daily and long-term function of the Company’s management strategy.  The Company adjusts its investments in liquid assets based upon management’s assessment of (i) expected loan demand, (ii) the projected availability of purchased loan products, (iii) expected deposit flows, (iv) yields available on interest-bearing deposits and (v) the objectives of its asset/liability management program.  Excess liquidity is generally invested in interest-earning overnight deposits and other short-term government agency or instrumentality obligations.  If the Company requires funds beyond its ability to generate them internally, it has additional borrowing capacity with the FHLB and other wholesale funding sources.  The Company is not aware of any significant trends in the Company’s liquidity or its ability to borrow additional funds if needed.
 


87


The primary investing activities of the Company are the origination of loans, acquisition of new companies and purchase of securities.  During the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Company originated loans totaling $968.4 million, $672.8 million and $472.4 million, respectively.  Purchases of loans totaled $0, $74.1 million and $0.3 million during the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.  During the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, the Company purchased mortgage-backed securities and other securities in the amount of $902.9 million, $894.3 million and $506.5 million, respectively.  Of these purchases in 2016, 2015 and 2014, $298.9 million, $75.8 million and $15.1 million, respectively, were securities designated as held to maturity.
 
At September 30, 2016, the Company had unfunded loan commitments of $182.9 million.  See Note 14 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  Certificates of deposit scheduled to mature in one year or less from September 30, 2016 totaled $107.1 million.  Based on its historical experience, management believes that a significant portion of such deposits will remain with the Company; however, there can be no assurance that the Company can retain all such deposits.  Management believes that loan repayment and other sources of funds will be adequate to meet the Company’s foreseeable short- and long-term liquidity needs.
 
The following table summarizes the Company’s significant contractual obligations at September 30, 2016 (dollars in thousands)
 
Contractual Obligations
Total
 
Less than 1 year
 
1 to 3 years
 
3 to 5 years
 
More than 5 years
Time deposits
$
125,992

 
$
107,116

 
$
13,640

 
$
5,203

 
$
33

Long-term debt
92,460

 

 
6,938

 
2,000

 
83,522

Short-term debt
1,095,118

 
1,095,118

 

 

 

Operating leases
29,815

 
2,175

 
4,195

 
4,049

 
19,396

Data processing services
25,576

 
2,839

 
10,297

 
9,105

 
3,335

Total
$
1,368,961

 
$
1,207,248

 
$
35,070

 
$
20,357

 
$
106,286


During July 2001, the Company’s unconsolidated trust subsidiary, First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I, sold $10.3 million in floating-rate cumulative preferred securities. Proceeds from the sale were used to purchase trust preferred securities of the Company, which mature in 2031, and are redeemable at any time after five years. The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has the option to redeem them earlier. The Company used the proceeds for general corporate purposes.  See Note 9 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

The Company and the Bank met regulatory requirements for classification as well-capitalized institutions at September 30, 2016.  See Note 13 to the “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
The payment of dividends and repurchase of shares have the effect of reducing stockholders’ equity.  Prior to authorizing such transactions, the Board of Directors considers the effect the dividend or repurchase of shares would have on liquidity and regulatory capital ratios.
 
The Board of Directors approved a goal, reflected in its capital plan, for the Bank to stay at or above an 8% Tier 1 capital to adjusted total assets ratio during fiscal 2016.
 
Management and the Board of Directors are also mindful of new capital rules that will increase bank and holding company capital requirements and liquidity requirements.  No assurance can be given that our regulators will consider our liquidity level, or our capital level, though substantially in excess of current rules pursuant to which we are considered “well-capitalized,” to be sufficiently high in the future.
 
Off-Balance Sheet Financing Arrangements
 
For discussion of the Company’s off-balance sheet financing arrangements, see Note 14 of “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K.  Depending on the extent to which the commitments or contingencies described in Note 14 occur, the effect on the Company’s capital and net income could be significant.
 

88



Impact of Inflation and Changing Prices
 
The Consolidated Financial Statements and Notes thereto presented in this Annual Report have been prepared in accordance with U.S. GAAP, which require the measurement of financial position and operating results in terms of historical dollars without considering the change in the relative purchasing power of money over time due to inflation.  The primary impact of inflation is reflected in the increased cost of the Company’s operations.  Unlike most industrial companies, virtually all the assets and liabilities of the Company are monetary in nature.  As a result, interest rates generally have a more significant impact on a financial institution’s performance than do the effects of general levels of inflation.  Interest rates do not necessarily move in the same direction, or to the same extent, as the prices of goods and services.
 
Impact of New Accounting Standards
 
See Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for information regarding recently issued accounting pronouncements.
 

Item 7A.        Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
As stated above, the Company derives a portion of its income from the excess of interest collected over interest paid.  The rates of interest the Company earns on assets and pays on liabilities generally are established contractually for a period of time.  Market interest rates change over time.  Accordingly, the Company’s results of operations, like those of most financial institutions, are impacted by changes in interest rates and the interest rate sensitivity of its assets and liabilities.  The risk associated with changes in interest rates and the Company’s ability to adapt to these changes is known as interest rate risk and is the Company’s only significant “market” risk.

The Company monitors and measures its exposure to changes in interest rates in order to comply with applicable government regulations and risk policies established by the Board of Directors, and in order to preserve stockholder value.  In monitoring interest rate risk, the Company analyzes assets and liabilities based on characteristics including size, coupon rate, repricing frequency, maturity date and likelihood of prepayment.
 
If the Company’s assets mature or reprice more rapidly or to a greater extent than its liabilities, then economic value of equity and net interest income would tend to increase during periods of rising rates and decrease during periods of falling interest rates.  Conversely, if the Company’s assets mature or reprice more slowly or to a lesser extent than its liabilities, then economic value of equity and net interest income would tend to decrease during periods of rising interest rates and increase during periods of falling interest rates.
 
The Company currently focuses lending efforts toward originating and purchasing competitively priced adjustable-rate and fixed-rate loan products with short to intermediate terms to maturity, generally five years or less.  This theoretically allows the Company to maintain a portfolio of loans that will have relatively little sensitivity to changes in the level of interest rates, while providing a reasonable spread to the cost of liabilities used to fund the loans.
 
The Company’s primary objective for its investment portfolio is to provide a source of liquidity for the Company.  In addition, the investment portfolio may be used in the management of the Company’s interest rate risk profile.  The investment policy generally calls for funds to be invested among various categories of security types and maturities based upon the Company’s need for liquidity, desire to achieve a proper balance between minimizing risk while maximizing yield, the need to provide collateral for borrowings and to fulfill the Company’s asset/liability management goals.
 
The Company’s cost of funds responds to changes in interest rates due to the relatively short-term nature of its deposit portfolio, and due to the relatively short-term nature of its borrowed funds.  The Company believes that its growing portfolio of low-cost deposits provides a stable and profitable funding vehicle, but also subjects the Company to greater risk in a falling interest rate environment than it would otherwise have without this portfolio.  This risk is due to the fact that, while asset yields may decrease in a falling interest rate environment, the Company cannot significantly reduce interest costs associated with these deposits, which thereby compresses the Company’s net interest margin.  As a result of the Company’s interest rate risk exposure in this regard, the Company has elected not to enter into any new longer-term wholesale borrowings, and generally has not emphasized longer-term time deposit products.
 
The Board of Directors and relevant government regulations establish limits on the level of acceptable interest rate risk at the Company, to which management adheres.  There can be no assurance, however, that, in the event of an adverse change in interest rates, the Company’s efforts to limit interest rate risk will be successful.

89


Item 8.        Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

 
Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
Consolidated Financial Statements
Statements of Financial Condition
Statements of Operations
Statements of Comprehensive Income
Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity
Statements of Cash Flows
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

90


KPMG LLP
2500 Ruan Center
666 Grand Avenue
Des Moines, IA 50309

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 

The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Meta Financial Group, Inc.:
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial condition of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries (the Company) as of September 30, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three‑year period ended September 30, 2016. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 2016 and 2015, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three‑year period ended September 30, 2016, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), Meta Financial Group, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO), and our report dated December 14, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 
/s/ KPMG LLP
 
 
Des Moines, Iowa
 
December 14, 2016
 


91


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
ASSETS
September 30, 2016
 
September 30, 2015
Cash and cash equivalents
$
773,830

 
$
27,658

Investment securities available-for-sale
910,309

 
679,504

Mortgage-backed securities available-for-sale
558,940

 
576,583

Investment securities held to maturity
486,095

 
279,167

Mortgage-backed securities held to maturity
133,758

 
66,577

Loans receivable - net of allowance for loan losses of $5,635 at September 30, 2016 and $6,255 at September 30, 2015
919,470

 
706,255

Federal Home Loan Bank stock, at cost
47,512

 
24,410

Accrued interest receivable
17,199

 
13,352

Premises, furniture, and equipment, net
18,626

 
17,393

Bank-owned life insurance
57,486

 
45,830

Foreclosed real estate and repossessed assets
76

 

Goodwill
36,928

 
36,928

Intangible assets
28,921

 
33,577

Prepaid assets
9,443

 
9,360

Deferred taxes

 
6,997

MPS accounts receivable
6,334

 
5,337

Other assets
1,492

 
777

 
 
 
 
Total assets
$
4,006,419

 
$
2,529,705

 
 
 
 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
LIABILITIES
 

 
 

Non-interest-bearing checking
$
2,167,522

 
$
1,449,101

Interest-bearing checking
38,077

 
33,320

Savings deposits
50,742

 
41,720

Money market deposits
47,749

 
42,222

Time certificates of deposit
125,992

 
91,171

Total deposits
2,430,082

 
1,657,534

Short-term debt
1,095,118

 
544,007

Long-term debt
92,460

 
19,453

Accrued interest payable
875

 
272

Contingent liability

 
331

Deferred taxes
4,600

 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
48,309

 
36,773

Total liabilities
3,671,444

 
2,258,370

 
 
 
 
STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY
 

 
 

Preferred stock, 3,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued or outstanding at September 30, 2016 and 2015, respectively

 

Common stock, $.01 par value; 15,000,000 shares authorized, 8,523,641 and 8,183,272 shares issued, 8,523,641 and 8,163,022 shares outstanding at September 30, 2016 and 2015, respectively
85

 
82

Additional paid-in capital
184,780

 
170,749

Retained earnings
127,190

 
98,359

Accumulated other comprehensive income
22,920

 
2,455

Treasury stock, no common shares, at cost, at September 30, 2016 and 20,250 common shares at September 30, 2015

 
(310
)
Total stockholders’ equity
334,975

 
271,335

 
 
 
 
Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity
$
4,006,419

 
$
2,529,705


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

92


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC
AND SUBSIDIARIES
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Interest and dividend income:
 
 
 
 
 
Loans receivable, including fees
$
36,187

 
$
29,565

 
$
19,674

Mortgage-backed securities
15,771

 
13,979

 
15,343

Other investments
29,438

 
18,063

 
13,643

 
81,396

 
61,607

 
48,660

Interest expense:
 

 
 

 
 

Deposits
614

 
726

 
965

FHLB advances and other borrowings
3,477

 
1,661

 
1,433

 
4,091

 
2,387

 
2,398

Net interest income
77,305

 
59,220

 
46,262

Provision for loan losses
4,605

 
1,465

 
1,150

Net interest income after provision for loan losses
72,700

 
57,755

 
45,112

Non-interest income:
 

 
 

 
 

Tax product fees
23,347

 

 

Card fees
70,533

 
54,542

 
48,738

Bank-owned life insurance income
4,949

 
2,030

 
1,139

Loan fees
1,656

 
2,348

 
981

Deposit fees
603

 
593

 
616

Gain (loss) on sale of securities available-for-sale, net (Includes ($326), ($1,634), and $107 reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for net gains (losses) on available for sale securities for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively)
(326
)
 
(1,634
)
 
107

Gain (loss) on foreclosed real estate

 
28

 
(93
)
Other income
8

 
267

 
250

Total non-interest income
100,770

 
58,174

 
51,738

 
 
 
 
 
 
Non-interest expense:
 

 
 

 
 

Compensation and benefits
61,675

 
46,493

 
38,155

Tax product expense
8,648

 

 

Card processing expense
22,263

 
16,508

 
15,487

Occupancy and equipment expense
13,999

 
11,399

 
8,979

Legal and consulting expense
4,824

 
4,978

 
4,145

Data processing expense
1,972

 
1,347

 
1,316

Marketing expense
1,334

 
1,537

 
1,034

Amortization expense
4,828

 
1,349

 
77

Other expense
15,105

 
12,895

 
9,038

Total non-interest expense
134,648

 
96,506

 
78,231

 
 
 
 
 
 
Income before income tax expense
38,822

 
19,423

 
18,619

Income tax expense (Includes ($118), ($597), and $39 income tax expense (benefit) reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively)
5,602

 
1,368

 
2,906

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings per common share:
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
3.95

 
$
2.68

 
$
2.57

Diluted
$
3.92

 
$
2.66

 
$
2.53


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

93


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income
(Dollars in Thousands)

 
For Years Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

 
 
 
 
 
 
Other comprehensive income:
 

 
 

 
 

Change in net unrealized gain on securities
31,965

 
7,723

 
26,790

Losses (gains) realized in net income
326

 
1,634

 
(107
)
 
32,291

 
9,357

 
26,683

Deferred income tax effect
11,826

 
3,493

 
9,807

Total other comprehensive income
20,465

 
5,864

 
16,876

Total comprehensive income
$
53,685

 
$
23,919

 
$
32,589


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.


94


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders' Equity
For the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2015 and 2016
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
 
 
 
Common
Stock

 
 
 
Additional
Paid-in
Capital

 
 
 
 
Retained
Earnings

 
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss),
Net of Tax

 
 
 
 
Treasury
Stock

 
 
 
Total
Stockholders’
Equity

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2013
$
61

 
$
92,963

 
$
71,268

 
$
(20,285
)
 
$
(1,023
)
 
$
142,984

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($0.52 per share)

 

 
(3,184
)
 

 

 
(3,184
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares from the sales of equity securities
1

 
(52
)
 

 

 

 
(51
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares due to issuance of stock options and restricted stock

 
2,080

 

 

 
296

 
2,376

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock compensation

 
88

 

 

 

 
88

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities, net of income taxes

 

 

 
16,876

 

 
16,876

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income

 

 
15,713

 

 

 
15,713

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2014
$
62

 
$
95,079

 
$
83,797

 
$
(3,409
)
 
$
(727
)
 
$
174,802

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2014
$
62

 
$
95,079

 
$
83,797

 
$
(3,409
)
 
$
(727
)
 
$
174,802

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($0.52 per share)

 

 
(3,493
)
 

 

 
(3,493
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares from the sales of equity securities
14

 
50,737

 

 

 
417

 
51,168

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares due to issuance of stock options and restricted stock

 
378

 

 

 

 
378

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares due to acquisition
6

 
24,297

 

 

 

 
24,303

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock compensation

 
258

 

 

 

 
258

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities, net of income taxes

 

 

 
5,864

 

 
5,864

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income

 

 
18,055

 

 

 
18,055

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2015
$
82

 
$
170,749

 
$
98,359

 
$
2,455

 
$
(310
)
 
$
271,335

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2015
$
82

 
$
170,749

 
$
98,359

 
$
2,455

 
$
(310
)
 
$
271,335

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash dividends declared on common stock ($0.52 per share)

 

 
(4,389
)
 

 

 
(4,389
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares from the sales of equity securities
2

 
11,498

 

 

 

 
11,500

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Issuance of common shares due to issuance of stock options and restricted stock
1

 
2,046

 

 

 
310

 
2,357

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Stock compensation

 
487

 

 

 

 
487

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in unrealized gains (losses) on securities, net of income taxes

 

 

 
20,465

 

 
20,465

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income

 

 
33,220

 

 

 
33,220

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Balance, September 30, 2016
$
85

 
$
184,780

 
$
127,190

 
$
22,920

 
$

 
$
334,975


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

95


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Cash flows from operating activities:
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:
 

 
 

 
 

Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
35,617

 
28,882

 
18,147

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
4,605

 
1,465

 
1,150

Provision (recovery) for deferred taxes
(230
)
 
(3,896
)
 
(1,755
)
(Gain) loss on other assets
104

 
6

 
(43
)
(Gain) loss on foreclosed real estate

 
(28
)
 
93

(Gain) loss on sale of securities available-for-sale, net
326

 
1,634

 
(107
)
Capital lease obligations interest expense
125

 
131

 

Net change in accrued interest receivable
(3,847
)
 
(2,130
)
 
(2,640
)
Change in bank-owned life insurance value
(1,656
)
 
(1,225
)
 
(1,639
)
Net change in other assets
(1,968
)
 
(672
)
 
(807
)
Net change in accrued interest payable
603

 
(46
)
 
27

Net change in accrued expenses and other liabilities
11,112

 
6,780

 
(2,326
)
Net cash provided by operating activities
78,011

 
48,956

 
25,813

 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flows from investing activities:
 

 
 

 
 

Purchase of securities available-for-sale
(603,995
)
 
(810,624
)
 
(491,416
)
Proceeds from sales of securities available-for-sale
285,508

 
566,371

 
166,804

Proceeds from maturities and principal repayments of securities available-for-sale
116,333

 
124,558

 
81,754

Purchase of securities held to maturity
(298,869
)
 
(72,759
)
 
(15,117
)
Proceeds from maturities and principal repayments of securities held to maturity
20,465

 
9,879

 
16,802

Purchase of bank-owned life insurance
(10,000
)
 
(10,000
)
 
(500
)
Proceeds from bank-owned life insurance death benefit

 
864

 

Loans purchased

 

 
(343
)
Loans sold
(89
)
 
(5,462
)
 
(11,747
)
Net change in loans receivable
(217,807
)
 
(135,187
)
 
(101,639
)
Proceeds from sales of foreclosed real estate

 
86

 
8

Cash paid for acquisitions

 
(125,314
)
 

Cash received upon acquisitions

 
9,768

 

Federal Home Loan Bank stock purchases
(860,902
)
 
(544,324
)
 
(445,971
)
Federal Home Loan Bank stock redemptions
837,800

 
541,160

 
434,720

Proceeds from the sale of premises and equipment
55

 
2,100

 
1,178

Purchase of premises and equipment
(6,979
)
 
(5,031
)
 
(2,329
)
Net cash used in investing activities
(738,480
)
 
(453,915
)
 
(367,796
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash flows from financing activities:
 

 
 

 
 

Net change in checking, savings, and money market deposits
737,727

 
334,375

 
48,304

Net change in time deposits
34,821

 
(43,382
)
 
2,954

Proceeds from FHLB
100,000

 

 

Net change in federal funds
452,000

 
70,000

 
280,000

Net change in securities sold under agreements to repurchase
(969
)
 
(6,404
)
 
1,265

Proceeds from long term debt
75,000

 

 

Payment of debt issuance costs
(1,767
)
 

 

Principal payments on capital lease obligations
(126
)
 
(116
)
 

Cash dividends paid
(4,389
)
 
(3,493
)
 
(3,184
)
Stock compensation
487

 
258

 
88

Proceeds from issuance of common stock
13,857

 
51,547

 
2,325

Net cash provided by financing activities
1,406,641

 
402,785

 
331,752

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
746,172

 
(2,174
)
 
(10,231
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year
27,658

 
29,832

 
40,063

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year
$
773,830

 
$
27,658

 
$
29,832


96


META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
AND SUBSIDIARIES
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows (Con't.)
(Dollars in Thousands)

 
For the Years Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
Supplemental disclosure of cash flow information
 
 
 
 
 
Cash paid during the year for:
 
 
 
 
 
Interest
$
3,488

 
$
2,433

 
$
2,371

Income taxes
5,898

 
5,277

 
4,451

Franchise taxes
98

 
98

 
109

Other taxes
79

 
48

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
Supplemental disclosure of non-cash investing and financing activities:
 

 
 

 
 

Common stock issued for acquisition
$

 
$
(24,303
)
 
$

Capital lease obligation
$

 
$
(2,259
)
 
$

Securities transferred from available-for-sale to held to maturity
$

 
$
310

 
$

Purchase of available-for-sale securities accrued, not paid
$

 
$
(7,877
)
 
$

Purchase of held-to-maturity securities accrued, not paid
$

 
$
(3,000
)
 
$

Loans transferred to foreclosed real estate
$
76

 
$
54

 
$


See Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.


97



NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

NOTE 1.  SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
PRINCIPLES OF CONSOLIDATION
 
The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Meta Financial Group, Inc. (the “Company”), a unitary savings and loan holding company located in Sioux Falls, South Dakota, and its wholly-owned subsidiaries which include MetaBank (the “Bank”), a federally chartered savings bank whose primary federal regulator is the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and First Services Financial Limited, which offered noninsured investment products and was dissolved on December 3, 2013.  The Company also owns 100% of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I (the “Trust”), which was formed in July 2001 for the purpose of issuing trust preferred securities.  The Trust is not included in the consolidated financial statements of the Company.  All significant intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.
 
NATURE OF BUSINESS AND INDUSTRY SEGMENT INFORMATION
 
The primary source of income relates to payment processing services for prepaid debit cards, ATM sponsorship, tax refund transfer and other money transfer systems and services.  Additionally, a significant source of income for the Company is interest from the purchase or origination of consumer, commercial, agricultural, commercial real estate, residential real estate, and premium finance loans.  The Company accepts deposits from customers in the normal course of business primarily in northwest and central Iowa, and eastern South Dakota and on a national basis for the MPS division.  The Company operates in the banking industry, which accounts for the majority of its revenues and assets.  The Company uses the “management approach” for reporting information about segments in annual and interim financial statements.  The management approach is based on the way the chief operating decision-maker organizes segments within a company for making operating decisions and assessing performance.  Reportable segments are based on products and services, geography, legal structure, management structure and any other manner in which management disaggregates a company.  Based on the management approach model, the Company has determined that its business is comprised of three reporting segments.
 
USE OF ESTIMATES IN PREPARING FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period.  Actual results could differ from those estimates.  Certain significant estimates include the allowance for loan losses, the valuation of goodwill and intangible assets and the fair values of securities and other financial instruments.  These estimates are reviewed by management regularly; however, they are particularly susceptible to significant changes in the future.
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AND FEDERAL FUNDS SOLD
 
For purposes of reporting cash flows, cash and cash equivalents is defined to include the Company’s cash on hand and due from financial institutions and short-term interest-bearing deposits in other financial institutions.  The Company reports cash flows net for customer loan transactions, securities purchased under agreement to resell, federal funds purchased, deposit transactions, securities sold under agreements to repurchase, and FHLB advances with terms less than 90 days.  The Bank is required to maintain reserve balances in cash or on deposit with the FRB, based on a percentage of deposits.  The total of those reserve balances was $0 and $4.1 million at September 30, 2016, and 2015, respectively.  The Company at times maintains balances in excess of insured limits at various financial institutions including the FHLB, the FRB and other private institutions.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had no interest-bearing deposits held at the FHLB and $512.9 million in interest-bearing deposits held at the FRB.  At September 30, 2016, the Company had no federal funds sold.  The Company does not believe these instruments carry a significant risk of loss, but cannot provide assurances that no losses could occur if these institutions were to become insolvent.

SECURITIES
 
GAAP require that, at acquisition, an enterprise classify debt securities into one of three categories: Available for Sale (“AFS”), Held to Maturity (“HTM”) or trading. AFS securities are carried at fair value on the consolidated statements of financial condition, and unrealized holding gains and losses are excluded from earnings and recognized as a separate component of equity in accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) (“AOCI”). HTM debt securities are measured at amortized cost. Both AFS and HTM are subject to review for other-than-temporary impairment. Meta Financial has no trading securities.

98


 
The Company classifies the majority of its securities as AFS.  AFS securities are those the Company may decide to sell if needed for liquidity, asset-liability management or other reasons. Prior to June 30, 2013, the Basel III Accord was finalized and clarified that unrealized losses and gains on securities will not affect regulatory capital for those companies that opt out of the requirement, which the Company has done.
 
Gains and losses on the sale of securities are determined using the specific identification method based on amortized cost and are reflected in results of operations at the time of sale.  Interest and dividend income, adjusted by amortization of purchase premium or discount over the estimated life of the security using the level yield method, is included in income as earned.
 
The fair values of securities available for sale are determined by obtaining quoted prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges (Level 1 inputs), or based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which significant assumptions are observable in the market (Level 2 inputs).  The Company considers these valuations supplied by a third-party provider that utilizes several sources for valuing fixed-income securities.  Sources utilized by the third-party provider include pricing models that vary based on asset class and include available trade, bid, and other market information.  This methodology includes broker quotes, proprietary models, descriptive terms and conditions databases, as well as extensive quality control programs.

Securities Impairment
 
Management continually monitors the investment securities portfolio for impairment on a security-by-security basis and has a process in place to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary.  This process involves the consideration of the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, review of available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, monitoring the rating of the security, monitoring changes in value, cash flow projections, and the Company’s intent to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost, which, in some cases, may extend to maturity.  To the extent the Company determines that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized.  If the Company intends to sell a security or it is more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell a security before the recovery of its amortized cost, the Company recognizes an other-than-temporary impairment for the difference between amortized cost and fair value.  If the Company does not expect to recover the amortized cost basis, does not plan to sell the security and if it is not more likely than not that the Company would be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost, the recognition of the other-than-temporary impairment is bifurcated.  For those securities, the Company separates the total impairment into a credit loss component recognized in net income, and the amount of the loss related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income, net of taxes.
 
The amount of the credit loss component of a debt security impairment is estimated as the difference between amortized cost and the present value of the expected cash flows of the security.  The present value is determined using the best estimate of cash flows discounted at the effective interest rate implicit to the security at the date of purchase or the current yield to accrete an asset-backed or floating rate security.  In fiscal 2016, 2015 and 2014, there was no other-than-temporary impairment recorded.
 
LOANS RECEIVABLE
 
Loans receivable that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or pay-off are reported at their outstanding principal balances reduced by the allowance for loan losses and any deferred fees or costs on originated loans.
 
Interest income on loans is accrued over the term of the loans based upon the amount of principal outstanding except when serious doubt exists as to the collectability of a loan, in which case the accrual of interest is discontinued.  Interest income is subsequently recognized only to the extent that cash payments are received until, in management’s judgment, the borrower has demonstrated a continued ability to make contractual interest and principal payments, in which case the loan is returned to accrual status.
 
Loan fees and certain direct loan origination costs are deferred, and the net fee or cost is recognized as an adjustment to interest income using the interest method.
 




99


As part of the Company’s ongoing risk management practices, management attempts to work with borrowers when necessary to extend or modify loan terms to better align with their current ability to repay.  Extensions and modifications to loans are made in accordance with internal policies and guidelines which conform to regulatory guidance.  Each occurrence is unique to the borrower and is evaluated separately.  In a situation where an economic concession has been granted to a borrower that is experiencing financial difficulty, the Company identifies and reports that loan as a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”).  Management considers regulatory guidelines when restructuring loans to ensure that prudent lending practices are followed.  As such, qualification criteria and payment terms consider the borrower’s current and prospective ability to comply with the modified terms of the loan.  Additionally, the Company structures loan modifications with the intent of strengthening repayment prospects.
 
The Company considers whether a borrower is experiencing financial difficulties, as well as whether a concession has been granted to a borrower determined to be troubled, when determining whether a modification meets the criteria of being a TDR.  For such purposes, evidence which may indicate that a borrower is troubled includes, among other factors, the borrower’s default on debt, the borrower’s declaration of bankruptcy or preparation for the declaration of bankruptcy, the borrower’s forecast that entity-specific cash flows will be insufficient to service the related debt, or the borrower’s inability to obtain funds from sources other than existing creditors at an effective interest rate equal to the current market interest rate for similar debt for a non-troubled debtor.  If a borrower is determined to be troubled based on such factors or similar evidence, a concession will be deemed to have been granted if a modification of the terms of the debt occurred that management would not otherwise consider.  Such concessions may include, among other modifications, a reduction of the stated interest for the remaining original life of the debt, an extension of the maturity date at a stated interest rate lower than the current market rate for new debt with similar risk, a reduction of accrued interest, or a reduction of the face amount or maturity amount of the debt.

Loans that are reported as TDRs apply the identical criteria in the determination of whether the loan should be accruing or not accruing.  The event of classifying the loan as a TDR due to a modification of terms may be independent from the determination of accruing interest on a loan.
 
Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent 90 days or more for Retail Bank or 210 days or more for Premium Finance or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is reversed against current income.  The loan will remain on a non-accrual status until six months of good payment history.
 
MORTGAGE SERVICING AND TRANSFERS OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
 
The Company, from time to time, sells loan participations, generally without recourse.  Sold loans are not included in the consolidated financial statements.  The Bank generally retains the right to service the sold loans for a fee.  At September 30, 2016 and 2015, the Bank was servicing loans for others with aggregate unpaid principal balances of $19.4 million and $22.2 million, respectively.
 
ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN LOSSES
 
The allowance for loan losses represents management’s estimate of probable loan losses that have been incurred as of the date of the consolidated financial statements.  The allowance for loan losses is increased by a provision for loan losses charged to expense and decreased by charge-offs (net of recoveries).  Estimating the risk of loss and the amount of loss on any loan is necessarily subjective.  Management’s periodic evaluation of the appropriateness of the allowance is based on the Company’s and peer group’s past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral, and current economic conditions.  While management may periodically allocate portions of the allowance for specific problem loan situations, the entire allowance is available for any loan charge-offs that occur.  The allowance consists of specific, general and unallocated components.
 
The specific component relates to impaired loans.  Loans are considered impaired if full principal or interest payments are not probable in accordance with the contractual loan terms.  Often this is associated with a delay or shortfall in payments of 210 days or more for premium finance loans and 90 days or more for other loan categories.  Non-accrual loans and all TDRs are considered impaired.  Impaired loans, or portions thereof, are charged off when deemed uncollectible.  Impaired loans are carried at the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate or at the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.  For such loans, an allowance is established when the discounted cash flows (or collateral value or observable market price) of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of that loan.
 



100


The general reserve covers loans not considered impaired and is comprised of both quantitative and qualitative analysis.  A separate general reserve analysis is performed for individual classified non-impaired loans and for non-classified smaller-balance homogeneous loans.  The three main assumptions for the quantitative components for 2016 and 2015 are historical loss rates, the look back period (“LBP”) and the loss emergence period (“LEP”).

The historical loss experience is determined by portfolio segment and is based on the actual loss history of the Company over the past seven years.  For the individual classified loans, historic charge-off rates for the Company’s classified loan population are utilized.

In prior periods, management utilized a five-year historical loss experience methodology. A seven-year LBP is appropriate as it captures the Company’s ability to workout troubled loans or relationships while continuing to factor in the loss experience resulting from varying economic cycles and other factors.

The weighted average LEP is an estimate of the average amount of time from the point the Company identifies a credit event of the borrower to the point the loss is confirmed by the Company weighted by the dollar value of the write off.  The LEP is only applied to the non-classified loan general reserve.
 
Qualitative adjustment considerations for the general reserve include considerations of changes in lending policies and procedures, changes in national and local economic and business conditions and developments, changes in the nature and volume of the loan portfolio, changes in lending management and staff, trending in past due, classified, nonaccrual, and other loan categories, changes in the Company’s loan review system and oversight, changes in collateral values, credit concentration risk, and the regulatory and legal requirements and environment.
 
An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses.  The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio.
 
FORECLOSED REAL ESTATE AND REPOSSESSED ASSETS
 
Real estate properties and repossessed assets acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure are initially recorded at fair value less selling costs at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis.  Any reduction to fair value from the carrying value of the related loan at the time of acquisition is accounted for as a loan loss and charged against the allowance for loan losses.  Valuations are periodically performed by management and valuation allowances are increased through a charge to income for reductions in fair value or increases in estimated selling costs.
 
INCOME TAXES
 
The Company records income tax expense based on the amount of taxes due on its tax return plus deferred taxes computed based on the expected future tax consequences of temporary differences between the carrying amounts and tax bases of assets and liabilities, using enacted tax rates.  Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.

In accordance with ASC 740, Income Taxes, the Company recognizes a tax position as a benefit only if it is more likely than not that the tax position would be sustained in a tax examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur.  The amount recognized is the largest amount of tax benefit that is greater than 50% likely of being realized upon examination.  For tax positions not meeting the more likely than not test, no tax benefit is recorded.  The Company recognizes interest and/or penalties related to income tax matters in income tax expense.
 
PREMISES, FURNITURE AND EQUIPMENT
 
Land is carried at cost.  Buildings, furniture, fixtures, leasehold improvements and equipment are carried at cost, less accumulated depreciation and amortization.  Capital leases, where we are the lessee, are included in premises and equipment at the capitalized amount less accumulated amortization.  We primarily use the straight-line method of depreciation over the estimated useful lives of the assets, which range from 10 to 40 years for buildings, and 2 to 15 years for leasehold improvements, and for furniture, fixtures and equipment. We amortize capitalized leased assets on a straight-line basis over the lives of the respective leases. Assets are reviewed for impairment when events indicate the carrying amount may not be recoverable.
 


101


TRANSFERS OF FINANCIAL ASSETS
 
Transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales when control over the assets has been surrendered.  Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1)the assets have been legally isolated from the Company, (2)the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and (3)the Company does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.
 
BANK-OWNED LIFE INSURANCE
 
Bank-owned life insurance represents the cash surrender value of investments in life insurance contracts.  Earnings on the contracts are based on the earnings on the cash surrender value, less mortality costs.
 
EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP PLAN (“ESOP”)
 
The cost of shares issued to the ESOP, but not yet allocated to participants, are presented in the consolidated statements of financial condition as a reduction of stockholders’ equity.  Compensation expense is recorded based on the market price of the shares as they are committed to be released for allocation to participant accounts.  The difference between the market price and the cost of shares committed to be released is recorded as an adjustment to additional paid-in capital.  Dividends on allocated ESOP shares are recorded as a reduction of retained earnings.  Dividends on unallocated shares are used to reduce the accrued interest and principal amount of the ESOP’s loan payable to the Company.  At September 30, 2016 and 2015, all shares in the ESOP were allocated.
 
FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK
 
The Company, in the normal course of business, makes commitments to make loans which are not reflected in the consolidated financial statements.

INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
Intangible assets other than goodwill are amortized over their respective estimated lives. All intangible assets are subject to an impairment test at least annually or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment.
 
SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE
 
The Company enters into sales of securities under agreements to repurchase with primary dealers only, which provide for the repurchase of the same security.  Securities sold under agreements to repurchase identical securities are collateralized by assets which are held in safekeeping in the name of the Bank or by the dealers who arranged the transaction.  Securities sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as financings, and the obligations to repurchase such securities are reflected as a liability.  The securities underlying the agreements remain in the asset accounts of the Company.
 
REVENUE RECOGNITION
 
Interest revenue from loans and investments is recognized on the accrual basis of accounting as the interest is earned according to the terms of the particular loan or investment.  Income from service and other customer charges is recognized as earned.  Revenue within the MPS division is recognized as services are performed and service charges are earned in accordance with the terms of the various programs.
 
EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE (“EPS”)
 
Basic EPS is based on the net income divided by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Allocated ESOP shares are considered outstanding for earnings per common share calculations, as they are committed to be released; unallocated ESOP shares are not considered outstanding.  Diluted EPS shows the dilutive effect of additional potential common shares issuable under stock option plans.
 





102


COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)
 
Comprehensive income (loss) consists of net income and other comprehensive income or loss.  Other comprehensive income includes the change in net unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, net of reclassification adjustments and tax effects.  Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) is recognized as a separate component of stockholders’ equity.
 
STOCK COMPENSATION
 
Compensation expense for share-based awards is recorded over the vesting period at the fair value of the award at the time of grant.  The exercise price of options or fair value of nonvested shares granted under the Company’s incentive plans is equal to the fair market value of the underlying stock at the grant date.  The Company utilizes projections for forfeitures on its stock-based compensation.

RECLASSIFICATION OF PRIOR PERIOD BALANCES

The Company reclassified borrowings during the fourth quarter of fiscal year 2016 into Short-term debt and Long-term debt. Short-term debt are classified as borrowings being due in one year or less, while Long-term debt are borrowings that have a maturity date of greater than one year. All prior year amounts have also been reclassified to conform to the new presentation.


NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS

Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2016-13, Financial Instruments - Credit Losses (Topic 326): Measurement of Credit Losses on Financial Instruments

This ASU requires organizations to replace the incurred loss impairment methodology with a methodology reflecting expected credit losses with considerations for a broader range of reasonable and supportable information to substantiate credit loss estimates. This ASU is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2019, and the Company is currently undertaking a data analysis and ensuring our systems are capturing data applicable to the standard.

ASU No. 2016-04, Extinguishment of liabilities (Subtopic 405-20): Recognition of Breakage for Certain Prepaid Stored-Value Products

This ASU requires organizations to derecognize the deposit liabilities for unredeemed prepaid stored-value products (i.e. – breakage) consistently with breakage guidance in Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers. This ASU is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017, and the Company is currently assessing the potential impact to the consolidated financial statements.
 
ASU No. 2016-02, Leases (Topic 842): Amendments to the Leases Analysis

This ASU requires organizations to recognize lease assets and lease liabilities on the balance sheet, along with disclosing key information about leasing arrangements. This update is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2018, including interim periods within that reporting period, and the Company is currently taking inventory of all leases and analyzing what their treatment will be under the new guidance.

ASU No 2015-16 – Business Combinations (Topic 805):  Simplifying the Accounting for Measurement-Period Adjustments
 
This ASU provides guidance regarding recognizing adjustments to provisional goodwill identified during the measurement period in the reporting period in which the adjustment is determined.  Income statement effects, if any, will also need to be recorded in the period in which the adjustment is determined, as if the accounting had been completed at the acquisition date.  This update is in effect for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2015, and the Company has adopted the standard and it had an immaterial impact.
 






103


ASU No. 2014-9, Revenue Recognition – Revenue from Contracts with Customers (Topic 606)
 
This ASU provides guidance on when to recognize revenue from contracts with customers.  The objective of this ASU is to eliminate diversity in practice related to this topic and to develop guidance that would streamline and enhance revenue recognition requirements.  The ASU defines five steps to recognize revenue, including identify the contract with a customer, identify the performance obligations in the contract, determine a transaction price, allocate the transaction price to the performance obligations and then recognize the revenue when or as the entity satisfies a performance obligation.  This update is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2017, including interim periods within that reporting period, and the Company is currently assessing our different prepaid card programs and income streams to ascertain how breakage will be recognized under the standard.
 
ASU No. 2015-01, Income Statement, Extraordinary and Unusual Items (Subtopic 225-20): Simplifying Income Statement Presentation by Eliminating the Concept of Extraordinary Items
 
This ASU eliminates the concept of extraordinary items from U.S. GAAP.  The ASU does not affect disclosure guidance for events or transactions that are unusual in nature or infrequent in their occurrence.  This update is in effect for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2015, and has had an immaterial impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.

ASU No. 2015-2, Consolidation (Topic 810): Amendments to the Consolidation Analysis
 
This ASU changes the way reporting enterprises evaluate whether (a) they should consolidate limited partnerships and similar entities, (b) fees paid to a decision maker or service provider are variable interests in a variable interest entity (“VIE”), and (c) variable interests in a VIE held by related parties of the reporting enterprise require the reporting enterprise to consolidate the VIE. It also eliminates the VIE consolidation model based on majority exposure to variability that applied to certain investment companies and similar entities.  This update is in effect for annual and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2015, and has had an immaterial impact to the Company's consolidated financial statements.

ASU No. 2015-03, Interest-Imputation of Interest (Subtopic 835-30): Simplifying the Presentation of Debt Issuance Costs

This ASU provides guidance on balance sheet presentation requirements for debt issuance costs and debt discount and premium. The objective of this ASU is to simplify presentation of debt issuance costs by requiring that debt issuance costs related to a recognized debt liability be presented in the balance sheet as a direct deduction from the carrying amount of that debt liability, consistent with debt discounts. This update is effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2015, including interim periods within that reporting period, and the Company is currently assessing the potential impact to the consolidated financial statements.
ASU 2015-17, Income Taxes (Topic 740): Balance Sheet Classification of Deferred Taxes
This ASU requires entities with a classified balance sheet to present all deferred tax assets and liabilities as noncurrent. This update is effective for annual and interim periods in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2016, and the Company is currently assessing the potential impact to the consolidated financial statements.
ASU 2016-09, Compensation - Stock Compensation (Topic 718): Improvements to Employee Share-Based Payment Accounting
This ASU provides guidance to improve the accounting for share-based payment transactions as part of the FASB’s simplification initiative. The ASU changes seven aspects of the accounting for share-based payment award transactions, including: (1) accounting for income taxes; (2) classification of excess tax benefits on the statement of cash flows; (3) forfeitures; (4) minimum statutory tax withholding requirements; (5) classification of employee taxes paid on the statement of cash flows when an employer withholds shares for tax-withholding purposes; (6) practical expedient - expected term (nonpublic only); and (7) intrinsic value (nonpublic only). This update is effective for annual and interim periods in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2016, and the Company is currently assessing the potential impact to the consolidated financial statements.
        



104


ASU 2016-15, Statement of Cash Flows (Topic 230): Classification of Certain Cash Receipts and Cash Payments
This ASU addresses eight classification issues related to the statement of cash flows including; debt prepayment or debt extinguishment costs, settlement of zero-coupon bonds, contingent consideration payments made after a business combination, proceeds from the settlement of insurance claims, proceeds from the settlement of corporate-owned life insurance policies, including bank-owned life insurance policies, distributions received from equity method investees, beneficial interests in securitization transactions, and separately identifiable cash flows and application of the predominance principle. This update is effective for annual and interim periods in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2017, and the Company is currently assessing the potential impact to the consolidated financial statements.

NOTE 2.  ACQUISITIONS
 
The Company completed two acquisitions for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2015. The two purchase transactions are detailed below.
 
AFS/IBEX
 
On December 2, 2014, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, MetaBank, purchased substantially all of the commercial loan portfolio and related assets of AFS/IBEX Financial Services, Inc. (“AFS/IBEX”), an insurance premium finance company based in Dallas, Texas.  Following the acquisition, MetaBank established its AFS/IBEX division, which provides short-term, collateralized financing to facilitate the purchase of insurance for commercial property, casualty, and liability risk through a network of over 1,300 independent insurance agencies throughout the United States.  In addition to its operations at the Bank’s main office, the AFS/IBEX division has two agency offices, one in Dallas, Texas, and one in southern California.
 
Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the aggregate purchase price, which was based upon the December 2, 2014 tangible book value of AFS/IBEX, was approximately $99.3 million, all of which was paid in cash.  The Company acquired assets with approximate fair values of $6.9 million for cash and cash equivalents, $74.1 million net loans receivable, $0.7 million other assets, $8.2 million intangible assets including customer relationships, trademark, and non-compete agreements, and $11.6 million goodwill.  The Company also assumed liabilities of $2.2 million consisting of accrued expenses and other liabilities.  All amounts are at estimated fair market values.

The following table represents the approximate fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed of AFS/IBEX on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 2, 2014:
 
 
As of December 2, 2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fair value of consideration paid
 
Cash
$
99,255

Total consideration paid
99,255

 
 

Fair value of assets acquired
 

Cash and cash equivalents
6,947

Loans receivable, net
74,120

Prepaid assets
156

Furniture and equipment, net
449

Intangible assets
8,213

Other assets
6

Total assets
89,891

Fair value of liabilities assumed
 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
2,214

Total liabilities assumed
2,214

Fair value of net assets acquired
87,677

Goodwill resulting from acquisition
$
11,578


105



The AFS/IBEX transaction has been accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting.  The assets and liabilities, both tangible and intangible, were recorded at their estimated fair values as of the transaction date.  The Company made significant estimates and exercised judgment in estimating fair values and accounting for such acquired assets and liabilities.
 
The Company recognized goodwill of $11.6 million, which is calculated as the excess of both the consideration exchanged and the liabilities assumed as compared to the fair value of identifiable assets acquired.  Goodwill resulted from expected operational synergies, an enhanced market area, and expanded product lines and is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.  The intangible assets consist primarily of customer relationships that will be amortized over 30 years and will be deductible for tax purposes. See Note 20 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information on goodwill.
 
Acquired loans were recorded at fair value based on a discounted cash flow valuation which considered default rates, loss given defaults, and recovery rates, among other things.  No allowance for credit losses was carried over on December 2, 2014.  The Company recorded $7.6 million in revenue and $0.8 million in net income for AFS/IBEX during fiscal 2015.  In addition, the Company incurred transaction costs of approximately $0.6 million in 2015 in connection with the acquisition, which are included in legal and consulting and other expenses on our consolidated statement of operations for the year ended September 30, 2015.
 
This acquisition is not deemed significant to the overall Company’s financial statements.
 
REFUND ADVANTAGE
 
On September 8, 2015, the Company, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, MetaBank, purchased substantially all the assets and related liabilities of Fort Knox Financial Services Corporation and its subsidiary, Tax Product Services LLC (together “Refund Advantage”). Refund Advantage is a provider of integrated tax refund processing services.

Under the terms of the purchase agreement, the aggregate purchase price was approximately $50.4 million, of which $26.1 million was paid in cash and $24.3 million was issued in Meta common stock.  The Company acquired assets with approximate fair values of $2.8 million for cash and cash equivalents, $0.5 million other assets, $24.1 million intangible assets including customer relationships, trademark, and non-compete agreements, and $25.4 million goodwill.  The Company also assumed liabilities of $2.5 million consisting of accrued expenses and other liabilities.  All amounts are at estimated fair market values.
 
The following table represents the approximate fair value of assets acquired and liabilities assumed of Refund Advantage on the consolidated balance sheet as of September 8, 2015:


106


 
As of September 8, 2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fair value of consideration paid
 
Cash
$
26,060

Stock issued
$
24,303

Total consideration paid
50,363

 
 

Fair value of assets acquired
 

Cash and cash equivalents
2,821

Prepaid assets
23

Furniture and equipment, net
55

Intangible assets
24,119

Other assets
457

Total assets
27,475

Fair value of liabilities assumed
 

Accrued expenses and other liabilities
2,463

Total liabilities assumed
2,463

Fair value of net assets acquired
25,012

Goodwill resulting from acquisition
$
25,351


The Refund Advantage transaction has been accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting.  The assets and liabilities, both tangible and intangible, were recorded at their estimated fair values as of the transaction date.  The Company made significant estimates and exercised judgment in estimating fair values and accounting for such acquired assets and liabilities.
 
The Company recognized goodwill of $25.4 million, which is calculated as the excess of both the consideration exchanged and the liabilities assumed as compared to the fair value of identifiable assets acquired.  Goodwill resulted from expected operational synergies, an enhanced market area, and expanded product lines and is expected to be deductible for tax purposes.  The intangible assets consist primarily of customer relationships that will be amortized over between 12 and 20 years and the Refund Advantage trademark, which will be amortized over 15 years and will be deductible for tax purposes. See Note 20 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further information on goodwill.
 
We incurred transaction costs of approximately $0.9 million in connection with the acquisition, which are included in legal and consulting and other expenses on our consolidated statement of operations for the year ended September 30, 2015.



107



NOTE 3.  LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET

 Year-end loans receivable were as follows:
 
 
September 30, 2016
 
September 30, 2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
162,298

 
$
125,021

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
422,932

 
310,199

Agricultural Real Estate
63,612

 
64,316

Consumer
37,094

 
33,527

Commercial Operating
31,271

 
29,893

Agricultural Operating
37,083

 
43,626

Premium Finance
171,604

 
106,505

Total Loans Receivable
925,894

 
713,087

 
 
 
 
Less:
 

 
 

Allowance for Loan Losses
(5,635
)
 
(6,255
)
Net Deferred Loan Origination Fees
(789
)
 
(577
)
Total Loans Receivable, Net
$
919,470

 
$
706,255


Annual activity in the allowance for loan losses was as follows:
 
Year ended September 30,
2016

 
2015

 
2014

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Beginning balance
$
6,255

 
$
5,397

 
$
3,930

Provision for loan losses
4,605

 
1,465

 
1,150

Recoveries
147

 
123

 
367

Charge offs
(5,372
)
 
(730
)
 
(50
)
Ending balance
$
5,635

 
$
6,255

 
$
5,397



108


Allowance for Loan Losses and Recorded Investment in loans at September 30, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:
 
 
1-4 Family
Real Estate
 
Commercial and
Multi-Family
Real Estate
 
Agricultural
Real Estate
 
Consumer
 
Commercial
Operating
 
Agricultural
Operating
 
Premium
Finance
 
Unallocated
 
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Year Ended September 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance
$
278

 
$
1,187

 
$
163

 
$
20

 
$
28

 
$
3,537

 
$
293

 
$
749

 
$
6,255

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
408

 
1,369

 
(21
)
 
748

 
338

 
1,045

 
914

 
(196
)
 
4,605

Charge offs
(32
)
 
(385
)
 

 
(728
)
 
(249
)
 
(3,252
)
 
(726
)
 

 
(5,372
)
Recoveries

 
27

 

 
11

 

 
2

 
107

 

 
147

Ending balance
$
654

 
$
2,198

 
$
142

 
$
51

 
$
117

 
$
1,332

 
$
588

 
$
553

 
$
5,635

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
10

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
10

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
644

 
2,198

 
142

 
51

 
117

 
1,332

 
588

 
553

 
5,625

Total
$
654

 
$
2,198

 
$
142

 
$
51

 
$
117

 
$
1,332

 
$
588

 
$
553

 
$
5,635

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
162

 
433

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
595

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
162,136

 
422,499

 
63,612

 
37,094

 
31,271

 
37,083

 
171,604

 

 
925,299

Total
$
162,298

 
$
422,932

 
$
63,612

 
$
37,094

 
$
31,271

 
$
37,083

 
$
171,604

 
$

 
$
925,894

 

109


 
1-4 Family
Real
Estate
 
Commercial and
Multi-Family
Real Estate
 
Agricultural
Real Estate
 
Consumer
 
Commercial
Operating
 
Agricultural
Operating
 
Premium
Finance
 
Unallocated
 
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Year Ended September 30, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allowance for loan losses:
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Beginning balance
$
552

 
$
1,575

 
$
263

 
$
78

 
$
93

 
$
719

 
$

 
$
2,117

 
$
5,397

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
(229
)
 
(180
)
 
(100
)
 
(58
)
 
(68
)
 
3,004

 
464

 
(1,368
)
 
1,465

Charge offs
(45
)
 
(214
)
 

 

 

 
(186
)
 
(285
)
 

 
(730
)
Recoveries

 
6

 

 

 
3

 

 
114

 

 
123

Ending balance
$
278

 
$
1,187

 
$
163

 
$
20

 
$
28

 
$
3,537

 
$
293

 
$
749

 
$
6,255

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

 
241

 

 

 

 
3,252

 

 

 
3,493

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
278

 
946

 
163

 
20

 
28

 
285

 
293

 
749

 
2,762

Total
$
278

 
$
1,187

 
$
163

 
$
20

 
$
28

 
$
3,537

 
$
293

 
$
749

 
$
6,255

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment
121

 
1,350

 

 

 
11

 
5,132

 

 

 
6,614

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment
124,900

 
308,849

 
64,316

 
33,527

 
29,882

 
38,494

 
106,505

 

 
706,473

Total
$
125,021

 
$
310,199

 
$
64,316

 
$
33,527

 
$
29,893

 
$
43,626

 
$
106,505

 
$

 
$
713,087



The asset classification of loans at September 30, 2016, and 2015, are as follows:
 
September 30, 2016
1-4 Family
Real Estate
 
Commercial and
Multi-Family
Real Estate
 
Agricultural
Real Estate
 
Consumer
 
Commercial
Operating
 
Agricultural
Operating
 
Premium
Finance
 
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Pass
$
161,255

 
$
421,577

 
$
34,421

 
$
37,094

 
$
30,574

 
$
19,669

 
$
171,604

 
$
876,194

Watch
200

 
72

 
2,934

 

 
184

 
4,625

 

 
8,015

Special Mention
666

 
962

 
25,675

 

 

 
5,407

 

 
32,710

Substandard
177

 
321

 
582

 

 
513

 
7,382

 

 
8,975

Doubtful

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
162,298

 
$
422,932

 
$
63,612

 
$
37,094

 
$
31,271

 
$
37,083

 
$
171,604

 
$
925,894



110


September 30, 2015
1-4 Family
Real Estate
 
Commercial and
Multi-Family
Real Estate
 
Agricultural
Real Estate
 
Consumer
 
Commercial
Operating
 
Agricultural
Operating
 
Premium
Finance
 
Total
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Pass
$
124,775

 
$
307,876

 
$
35,106

 
$
33,527

 
$
29,052

 
$
29,336

 
$
106,505

 
$
666,177

Watch
212

 
1,419

 
26,703

 

 
712

 
1,079

 

 
30,125

Special Mention
10

 

 
877

 

 

 
4,014

 

 
4,901

Substandard
24

 
904

 
1,630

 

 
129

 
9,197

 

 
11,884

Doubtful

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 
$
125,021

 
$
310,199

 
$
64,316

 
$
33,527

 
$
29,893

 
$
43,626

 
$
106,505

 
$
713,087


Federal regulations provide for the classification of loans and other assets such as debt and equity securities considered by our regulator, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (the “OCC”), to be of lesser quality as “substandard,” “doubtful” or “loss.”  The loan classification and risk rating definitions are as follows:
 
Pass- A pass asset is of sufficient quality in terms of repayment, collateral and management to preclude a special mention or an adverse rating.
 
Watch- A watch asset is generally a credit performing well under current terms and conditions but with identifiable weakness meriting additional scrutiny and corrective measures.  Watch is not a regulatory classification but can be used to designate assets that are exhibiting one or more weaknesses that deserve management’s attention.  These assets are of better quality than special mention assets.
 
Special Mention- Special mention assets are a credit with potential weaknesses deserving management’s close attention and, if left uncorrected, may result in deterioration of the repayment prospects for the asset.  Special mention assets are not adversely classified and do not expose an institution to sufficient risk to warrant adverse classification.  Special mention is a temporary status with aggressive credit management required to garner adequate progress and move to watch or higher.
 
The adverse classifications are as follows:
 
Substandard- A substandard asset is inadequately protected by the net worth and/or repayment ability or by a weak collateral position.  Assets so classified will have well-defined weaknesses creating a distinct possibility the Bank will sustain some loss if the weaknesses are not corrected.  Loss potential does not have to exist for an asset to be classified as substandard.

Doubtful- A doubtful asset has weaknesses similar to those classified substandard, with the degree of weakness causing the likely loss of some principal in any reasonable collection effort.  Due to pending factors, the asset’s classification as loss is not yet appropriate.
 
Loss- A loss asset is considered uncollectible and of such little value that the asset’s continuance on the Bank’s balance sheet is no longer warranted.  This classification does not necessarily mean an asset has no recovery or salvage value leaving room for future collection efforts.
 
Generally, when a loan becomes delinquent 90 days or more for Retail Bank or 210 days or more for Premium Finance or when the collection of principal or interest becomes doubtful, the Company will place the loan on a non-accrual status and, as a result, previously accrued interest income on the loan is reversed against current income.
 

111


Past due loans at September 30, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:
 
September 30, 2016
30-59 Days
Past Due
 
60-89 Days
Past Due
 
Greater Than
90 Days
 
Total Past
Due
 
Current
 
Non-Accrual
Loans
 
Total Loans
Receivable
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
1-4 Family Real Estate
$

 
$
30

 
$

 
$
30

 
$
162,185

 
$
83

 
$
162,298

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate

 

 

 

 
422,932

 

 
422,932

Agricultural Real Estate

 

 

 

 
63,612

 

 
63,612

Consumer

 

 
53

 
53

 
37,041

 

 
37,094

Commercial Operating
151

 
354

 

 
505

 
30,766

 

 
31,271

Agricultural Operating

 

 

 

 
37,083

 

 
37,083

Premium Finance
1,398

 
275

 
965

 
2,638

 
168,966

 

 
171,604

Total
$
1,549

 
$
659

 
$
1,018

 
$
3,226

 
$
922,585

 
$
83

 
$
925,894


September 30, 2015
30-59 Days
Past Due
 
60-89 Days
Past Due
 
Greater Than
90 Days
 
Total Past
Due
 
Current
 
Non-Accrual
Loans
 
Total Loans
Receivable
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
142

 
$

 
$

 
$
142

 
$
124,855

 
$
24

 
$
125,021

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate

 

 

 

 
309,295

 
904

 
310,199

Agricultural Real Estate

 

 

 

 
64,316

 

 
64,316

Consumer
152

 

 
13

 
165

 
33,362

 

 
33,527

Commercial Operating

 

 

 

 
29,893

 

 
29,893

Agricultural Operating

 

 

 

 
38,494

 
5,132

 
43,626

Premium Finance
702

 
362

 
1,728

 
2,792

 
103,713

 

 
106,505

Total
$
996

 
$
362

 
$
1,741

 
$
3,099

 
$
703,928

 
$
6,060

 
$
713,087


When analysis of borrower operating results and financial condition indicates that underlying cash flows of the borrower’s business are not adequate to meet its debt service requirements, the loan is evaluated for impairment.  Often this is associated with a delay or shortfall in payments of 210 days or more for Premium Finance loans and 90 days or more for other loan categories.  As of September 30, 2016, there were no Premium Finance loans greater than 210 days past due.

Impaired loans at September 30, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:

 
Recorded
Balance
 
Unpaid Principal
Balance
 
Specific
Allowance
September 30, 2016
(Dollars in Thousands)
Loans without a specific valuation allowance
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
84

 
$
84

 
$

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
433

 
433

 

      Total
$
517

 
$
517

 
$

Loans with a specific valuation allowance
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate
$
78

 
$
78

 
$
10

      Total
$
78

 
$
78

 
$
10



112


 
Recorded
Balance
 
Unpaid Principal
Balance
 
Specific
Allowance
September 30, 2015
(Dollars in Thousands)
Loans without a specific valuation allowance
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
121

 
$
121

 
$

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
446

 
446

 

Commercial Operating
11

 
11

 

Total
$
578

 
$
578

 
$

Loans with a specific valuation allowance
 

 
 

 
 

1-4 Family Real Estate
$

 
$

 
$

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
904

 
904

 
241

Agricultural Operating
5,132

 
5,282

 
3,252

Total
$
6,036

 
$
6,186

 
$
3,493


Cash interest collected on impaired loans was not material during the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015.

The following table provides the average recorded investment in impaired loans for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015.
 
 
Year Ended September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
Average
Recorded
Investment
 
Average
Recorded
Investment
1-4 Family Real Estate
$
144

 
$
238

Commercial and Multi-Family Real Estate
1,117

 
2,114

Commercial Operating
6

 
17

Agricultural Operating
2,919

 
3,559

Total
$
4,186

 
$
5,928


For fiscal 2016 and 2015, the Company’s TDRs (which involved forgiving a portion of interest or principal on any loans or making loans at a rate materially less than that of market rates) are included in the table above.
 
No TDRs were recorded during fiscal 2016 or 2015.  Also, no TDRs which had been modified during the 12-month period prior to default had a payment default during fiscal 2016 or 2015.
 
Virtually all of the Company’s originated loans are to Iowa- and South Dakota-based individuals and organizations.  The Company’s purchased loans totaled $6.4 million at September 30, 2016, which were secured by properties located, as a percentage of total loans, as follows: less than 1% combined in Oregon, North Dakota, North Carolina, and Connecticut.
 
The Company originates and purchases commercial real estate loans.  These loans are considered by management to be of somewhat greater risk of not being collected due to the dependency on income production.  The Company’s commercial real estate loans include $65.4 million of loans secured by hotel properties and $112.6 million of multi-family properties at September 30, 2016.  The Company’s commercial real estate loans include $51.1 million of loans secured by hotel properties and $99.6 million of multi-family properties at September 30, 2015.  The remainder of the commercial real estate portfolio is diversified by industry.  The Company’s policy for requiring collateral and guarantees varies with the creditworthiness of each borrower.
 
Non-accruing loans were $83,000 and $6.1 million at September 30, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  There were $1.0 million and $1.7 million accruing loans delinquent 90 days or more at September 30, 2016 and 2015, respectively.  For the year ended September 30, 2016, gross interest income which would have been recorded had the non-accruing loans been current in accordance with their original terms amounted to approximately $2,000, of which none was included in interest income.


113


NOTE 4.  LOAN SERVICING
 
Loans serviced for others are not reported as assets.  The unpaid principal balances of these loans at year-end were as follows:
 
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Mortgage loan portfolios serviced for Fannie Mae
$
3,980

 
$
5,055

 
$
5,948

Other
15,452

 
17,156

 
16,576

 
$
19,432

 
$
22,211

 
$
22,524


NOTE 5.  EARNINGS PER COMMON SHARE
 
Basic EPS is based on the net income divided by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Allocated Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) shares are considered outstanding for EPS calculations, as they are committed to be released; unallocated ESOP shares are not considered outstanding.  All ESOP shares were allocated as of September 30, 2016, and September 30, 2015.  Diluted EPS shows the dilutive effect of additional common shares issuable pursuant to stock option agreements.
 
A reconciliation of the net income and common stock share amounts used in the computation of basic and diluted EPS for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 is presented below.
 
 
2016

 
2015

 
2014

 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
Earnings
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

 
 
 
 
 
 
Basic EPS
 

 
 

 
 

Weighted average common shares outstanding
8,443,956

 
6,730,086

 
6,117,577

Less weighted average nonvested shares
(29,125
)
 
(4,237
)
 
(4,301
)
Weighted average common shares outstanding
8,414,831

 
6,725,849

 
6,113,276

 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings Per Common Share
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
3.95

 
$
2.68

 
$
2.57

 
 
 
 
 
 
Diluted EPS
 

 
 

 
 

Weighted average common shares outstanding for basic earnings per common share
8,414,831

 
6,725,849

 
6,113,276

Add dilutive effect of assumed exercises of stock options, net of tax benefits
66,590

 
68,951

 
85,133

Weighted average common and dilutive potential common shares outstanding
8,481,421

 
6,794,800

 
6,198,409

 
 
 
 
 
 
Earnings Per Common Share
 

 
 

 
 

Diluted
$
3.92

 
$
2.66

 
$
2.53


All stock options were considered in computing diluted EPS for the year ended September 30, 2016. Stock options totaling 28,891 and 29,984 were not considered in computing diluted earnings per common share for the years ended September 30, 2015 and 2014, respectively, because they were anti-dilutive.


114


NOTE 6.  SECURITIES
 
Securities available for sale were as follows:
 
Available For Sale
 
 
GROSS

 
GROSS

 
 
 
AMORTIZED

 
UNREALIZED

 
UNREALIZED

 
FAIR

At September 30, 2016
COST

 
GAINS

 
(LOSSES)

 
VALUE

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$
14,935

 
$

 
$
(1,957
)
 
$
12,978

Small business administration securities
78,431

 
2,288

 

 
80,719

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
668,628

 
30,141

 
(97
)
 
698,672

Asset-backed securities
117,487

 
73

 
(745
)
 
116,815

Mortgage-backed securities
555,036

 
4,382

 
(478
)
 
558,940

Total debt securities
1,434,517

 
36,884

 
(3,277
)
 
1,468,124

Common equities and mutual funds
755

 
373

 
(3
)
 
1,125

Total available for sale securities
$
1,435,272

 
$
37,257

 
$
(3,280
)
 
$
1,469,249


 
AMORTIZED

 
GROSS
UNREALIZED

 
GROSS
UNREALIZED

 
FAIR

At September 30, 2015
COST

 
GAINS

 
(LOSSES)

 
VALUE

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$
16,199

 
$
8

 
$
(2,263
)
 
$
13,944

Small business administration securities
54,493

 
1,563

 

 
56,056

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
603,165

 
7,240

 
(1,815
)
 
608,590

Mortgage-backed securities
580,165

 
1,283

 
(4,865
)
 
576,583

Total debt securities
1,254,022

 
10,094

 
(8,943
)
 
1,255,173

Common equities and mutual funds
639

 
283

 
(8
)
 
914

Total available for sale securities
$
1,254,661

 
$
10,377

 
$
(8,951
)
 
$
1,256,087


Securities held to maturity were as follows:
 
Held to Maturity
 
 
GROSS

 
GROSS

 
 
 
AMORTIZED

 
UNREALIZED

 
UNREALIZED

 
FAIR

At September 30, 2016
COST

 
GAINS

 
(LOSSES)

 
VALUE

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
20,626

 
$
355

 
$
(44
)
 
$
20,937

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
465,469

 
11,744

 
(11
)
 
477,202

Mortgage-backed securities
133,758

 
708

 
(31
)
 
134,435

Total held to maturity securities
$
619,853

 
$
12,807

 
$
(86
)
 
$
632,574



115


 
AMORTIZED

 
GROSS
UNREALIZED

 
GROSS
UNREALIZED

 
FAIR

At September 30, 2015
COST

 
GAINS

 
(LOSSES)

 
VALUE

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
19,540

 
$
60

 
$
(187
)
 
$
19,413

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
259,627

 
2,122

 
(419
)
 
261,330

Mortgage-backed securities
66,577

 

 
(473
)
 
66,104

Total held to maturity securities
$
345,744

 
$
2,182

 
$
(1,079
)
 
$
346,847


Included in securities available for sale are trust preferred securities as follows:
 
At September 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
Issuer(1)
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized
Gain (Loss)
 
S&P
Credit Rating
 
Moody's
Credit Rating
 
 (Dollars in Thousands)
Key Corp. Capital I
$
4,987

 
$
4,189

 
$
(798
)
 
BB+
 
Baa2
Huntington Capital Trust II SE
4,981

 
4,077

 
(904
)
 
BB
 
Baa2
PNC Capital Trust
4,968

 
4,712

 
(256
)
 
BBB-
 
Baa1
Total
$
14,936

 
$
12,978

 
$
(1,958
)
 
 
 
  

(1) 
Trust preferred securities are single-issuance.  There are no known deferrals, defaults or excess subordination.

At September 30, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
     
Issuer(1)
Amortized Cost
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized
Gain (Loss)
 
S&P
Credit Rating
 
Moody's
Credit Rating
 
 (Dollars in Thousands)
Key Corp. Capital I
$
4,986

 
$
4,189

 
$
(797
)
 
BB+
 
Baa2
Huntington Capital Trust II SE
4,979

 
4,076

 
(903
)
 
BB
 
Baa2
PNC Capital Trust
4,965

 
4,402

 
(563
)
 
BBB-
 
Baa1
Total
$
14,930

 
$
12,667

 
$
(2,263
)
 
 
 
  

(1) 
Trust preferred securities are single-issuance.  There are no known deferrals, defaults or excess subordination.

Management has implemented processes to identify securities that could potentially have a credit impairment that is other-than-temporary.  This process can include, but is not limited to, evaluating the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, reviewing available information regarding the financial position of the issuer, interest or dividend payment status, monitoring the rating of the security, monitoring changes in value, and projecting cash flows.  Management also determines whether the Company intends to sell a security or whether it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security before the recovery of its amortized cost basis which, in some cases, may extend to maturity.  To the extent we determine that a security is deemed to be other-than-temporarily impaired, an impairment loss is recognized.
 
For all securities considered temporarily impaired, the Company does not intend to sell these securities and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost, which may occur at maturity.  The Company believes collection will occur for all principal and interest due on all investments with amortized cost in excess of fair value and considered only temporarily impaired.
 
Generally accepted accounting principles require that, at acquisition, an enterprise classify debt securities into one of three categories: Available for sale, Held to Maturity or trading. AFS securities are carried at fair value on the consolidated statements of financial condition, and unrealized holding gains and losses are excluded from earnings and recognized as a separate component of equity in accumulated other comprehensive income.  HTM debt securities are measured at amortized cost. Both AFS and HTM are subject to review for other-than-temporary impairment. Meta Financial has no trading securities.

116



Gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time that individual securities have been in continuous unrealized loss position at September 30, 2016, and 2015, are as follows:
 
Available For Sale
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
 
OVER 12 MONTHS
 
TOTAL
At September 30, 2016
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$

 
$

 
$
12,978

 
$
(1,957
)
 
$
12,978

 
$
(1,957
)
Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
8,481

 
(58
)
 
2,688

 
(39
)
 
11,169

 
(97
)
Asset-backed securities
89,403

 
(745
)
 

 

 
89,403

 
(745
)
Mortgage-backed securities
54,065

 
(230
)
 
36,979

 
(248
)
 
91,044

 
(478
)
Total debt securities
151,949

 
(1,033
)
 
52,645

 
(2,244
)
 
204,594

 
(3,277
)
Common equities and mutual funds

 

 
125

 
(3
)
 
125

 
(3
)
Total available for sale securities
$
151,949

 
$
(1,033
)
 
$
52,770

 
$
(2,247
)
 
$
204,719

 
$
(3,280
)

 
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
 
OVER 12 MONTHS
 
TOTAL
At September 30, 2015
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities


 


 


 


 


 


Small Business Administration securities

 

 
12,667

 
(2,263
)
 
12,667

 
(2,263
)
Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
97,006

 
(860
)
 
42,583

 
(955
)
 
139,589

 
(1,815
)
Mortgage-backed securities
448,988

 
(4,301
)
 
48,079

 
(564
)
 
497,067

 
(4,865
)
Total debt securities
545,994

 
(5,161
)
 
103,329

 
(3,782
)
 
649,323

 
(8,943
)
Common equities and mutual funds

 

 
121

 
(8
)
 
121

 
(8
)
Total available for sale securities
$
545,994

 
$
(5,161
)
 
$
103,450

 
$
(3,790
)
 
$
649,444

 
$
(8,951
)


117


Held To Maturity
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
 
OVER 12 MONTHS
 
TOTAL
At September 30, 2016
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
2,909

 
$
(13
)
 
$
2,256

 
$
(31
)
 
$
5,165

 
$
(44
)
Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
1,294

 
(11
)
 

 

 
1,294

 
(11
)
Mortgage-backed securities
20,061

 
(31
)
 

 

 
20,061

 
(31
)
Total held to maturity securities
$
24,264

 
$
(55
)
 
$
2,256

 
$
(31
)
 
$
26,520

 
$
(86
)

 
LESS THAN 12 MONTHS
 
OVER 12 MONTHS
 
TOTAL
At September 30, 2015
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
Fair
Value
 
Unrealized
(Losses)
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Obligations of states and political subdivisions
$
5,528

 
$
(34
)
 
$
7,964

 
$
(153
)
 
$
13,492

 
$
(187
)
Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
78,663

 
(365
)
 
4,136

 
(54
)
 
82,799

 
(419
)
Mortgage-backed securities
5,509

 
(43
)
 
60,595

 
(430
)
 
66,104

 
(473
)
Total held to maturity securities
$
89,700

 
$
(442
)
 
$
72,695

 
$
(637
)
 
$
162,395

 
$
(1,079
)

As of September 30, 2016 and 2015, the investment portfolio included securities with current unrealized losses which have existed for longer than one year.  All of these securities are considered to be acceptable credit risks.  Because the declines in fair value were due to changes in market interest rates, not in estimated cash flows, and the Company does not intend to sell these securities (has not made a decision to sell) and it is not more likely than not that the Company will be required to sell the security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, which may occur at maturity, no other-than-temporary impairment was recorded at September 30, 2016 and 2015.
 
The amortized cost and fair value of debt securities by contractual maturity are shown below.  Certain securities have call features which allow the issuer to call the security prior to maturity.  Expected maturities may differ from contractual maturities in mortgage-backed securities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.  Therefore, mortgage-backed securities are not included in the maturity categories in the following maturity summary.  The expected maturities of certain Small Business Administration securities may differ from contractual maturities because the borrowers may have the right to prepay the obligation. However, certain prepayment penalties may apply.

118


Available For Sale
 
AMORTIZED
COST

 
FAIR
VALUE

At September 30, 2016
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
$

 
$

Due after one year through five years
17,370

 
17,897

Due after five years through ten years
426,034

 
446,771

Due after ten years
436,077

 
444,516

 
879,481

 
909,184

Mortgage-backed securities
555,036

 
558,940

Common equities and mutual funds
755

 
1,125

Total available for sale securities
$
1,435,272

 
$
1,469,249


 
AMORTIZED
COST

 
FAIR
VALUE

At September 30, 2015
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
$

 
$

Due after one year through five years
1,174

 
1,207

Due after five years through ten years
370,087

 
376,394

Due after ten years
302,596

 
300,989

 
673,857

 
678,590

Mortgage-backed securities
580,165

 
576,583

Common equities and mutual funds
639

 
914

Total available for sale securities
$
1,254,661

 
$
1,256,087


Held To Maturity
AMORTIZED
COST

 
FAIR
VALUE

At September 30, 2016
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
$
472

 
$
471

Due after one year through five years
12,502

 
12,696

Due after five years through ten years
157,944

 
163,806

Due after ten years
315,177

 
321,166

 
486,095

 
498,139

Mortgage-backed securities
133,758

 
134,435

Total held to maturity securities
$
619,853

 
$
632,574



119


 
AMORTIZED
COST

 
FAIR
VALUE

At September 30, 2015
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Due in one year or less
$
95

 
$
96

Due after one year through five years
8,411

 
8,430

Due after five years through ten years
140,145

 
140,505

Due after ten years
130,516

 
131,712

 
279,167

 
280,743

Mortgage-backed securities
66,577

 
66,104

Total held to maturity securities
$
345,744

 
$
346,847


Activities related to the sale of securities available for sale are summarized below.
 
 
2016
 
2015
 
2014
September 30,
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Proceeds from sales
$
285,508

 
$
566,371

 
$
166,804

Gross gains on sales
1,459

 
2,753

 
2,292

Gross losses on sales
1,785

 
4,387

 
2,185


NOTE 7.  PREMISES, FURNITURE AND EQUIPMENT, NET
 
Year-end premises and equipment were as follows:
 
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Land
$
1,578

 
$
1,578

Buildings
10,482

 
10,315

Furniture, fixtures, and equipment
41,756

 
35,571

Capitalized leases
2,259

 
2,259

 
56,075

 
49,723

Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization
(37,449
)
 
(32,330
)
Net book value
$
18,626

 
$
17,393


Depreciation expense of premises, furniture and equipment included in occupancy and equipment expense was approximately $5.4 million, $4.6 million and $3.5 million for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively. Amortization expense on capitalized leases for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015, was $0.2 million and $0.1 million, respectively, and is included in occupancy and equipment expense. For the year ended September 30, 2014, there was no amortization expense on capitalized leases.









120



NOTE 8.  TIME CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSITS
 
Time certificates of deposits in denominations of $250,000 or more were approximately $44.5 million and $38.5 million at September 30, 2016, and 2015, respectively.
 
At September 30, 2016, the scheduled maturities of time certificates of deposits were as follows for the years ending:
 
As of September 30,
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
2017
$
107,116

2018
8,967

2019
4,673

2020
3,364

2021
1,839

Thereafter
33

Total Certificates
$
125,992


Under the Dodd-Frank Act, IRA and non-IRA deposit accounts are permanently insured up to $250,000 by the DIF under management of the FDIC.

NOTE 9.  SHORT TERM DEBT AND LONG TERM DEBT

Short Term Debt
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
 
 
 
Overnight federal funds purchased
$
992,000

 
$
540,000

Short-term FHLB advances
100,000

 

Short-term capital lease
79

 

Repurchase agreements
3,039

 
4,007

     Total
1,095,118

 
544,007


The Company had $992.0 million of overnight federal funds purchased from the FHLB as of September 30, 2016. The Company had $540.0 million in overnight federal funds purchased from the FHLB at September 30, 2015. At September 30, 2016, the Company’s short-term advances from the FHLB totaled $100 million and carried a fixed rate of 0.46%. The Company had no short-term advances from the FHLB at September 30, 2015.
 
The Bank has executed blanket pledge agreements whereby the Bank assigns, transfers, and pledges to the FHLB and grants to the FHLB a security interest in all mortgage collateral and securities collateral.  The Bank has the right to use, commingle, and dispose of the collateral it has assigned to the FHLB.  Under the agreement, the Bank must maintain “eligible collateral” that has a “lending value” at least equal to the “required collateral amount,” all as defined by the agreement.
 
At year-end 2016 and 2015, the Bank pledged securities with fair values of approximately $824.5 million and $625.2 million, respectively, against specific FHLB advances.  In addition, qualifying mortgage loans of approximately $501.0 million, and $369.6 million were pledged as collateral at September 30, 2016, and 2015, respectively.

As of September 30, 2016, the Company had three capital leases, two equipment leases and one property lease.  At September 30, 2016, the portion of the liability expected to be expensed and amortized over the next 12 months is approximately $79,000.


121



Securities sold under agreements to repurchase totaled approximately $3.0 million and $4.0 million at September 30, 2016, and 2015, respectively.

An analysis of securities sold under agreements to repurchase follows:

September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
Highest month-end balance
$
3,468

 
$
17,400

Average balance
2,179

 
10,883

Weighted average interest rate for the year
0.60
%
 
0.52
%
Weighted average interest rate at year end
0.61
%
 
0.58
%

The Company pledged securities with fair values of approximately $9.2 million at September 30, 2016, as collateral for securities sold under agreements to repurchase.  There were $20.6 million of securities pledged as collateral for securities sold under agreements to repurchase at September 30, 2015.

Long Term Debt

September 30,
2016
 
2015
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
Long-term FHLB advances
$
7,000

 
$
7,000

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,310

Subordinated debentures (net of issuance costs)
73,211

 

Long-term capital lease
1,939

 
2,143

     Total
92,460

 
19,453


At September 30, 2016, the Company’s long-term advances from the FHLB totaled $7.0 million had carried a weighted-average rate of 6.98%. The weighted average rate of the Company's long-term advances was 6.98% at September 30, 2015.

The scheduled maturities of the Company's long-term debt are as follows for the years ending:
September 30,
 
 
 
 
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Long-term FHLB advances
Trust preferred securities
Subordinated debentures
Long-term capital lease
Total
2017
$

$

$

$

$

2018



61

61

2019
5,000



64

5,064

2020
2,000



72

2,072

2021



77

77

Thereafter

10,310

73,211

1,665

85,186

Total long-term debt
$
7,000

$
10,310

$
73,211

$
1,939

$
92,460


Trust preferred securities are due to First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I, a 100%-owned nonconsolidated subsidiary of the Company.  The securities were issued in 2001 in conjunction with the Trust’s issuance of 10,000 shares of Trust Preferred Securities.  The securities bear the same interest rate and terms as the trust preferred securities.  The securities are included on the consolidated balance sheets as liabilities.
 


122


The Company issued all of the 10,310 authorized shares of trust preferred securities of First Midwest Financial Capital Trust I holding solely securities.  Distributions are paid semi-annually.  Cumulative cash distributions are calculated at a variable rate of London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 3.75% (4.99% at September 30, 2016, and 4.28% at September 30, 2015), not to exceed 12.5%.  The Company may, at one or more times, defer interest payments on the capital securities for up to 10 consecutive semi-annual periods, but not beyond July 25, 2031.  At the end of any deferral period, all accumulated and unpaid distributions are required to be paid.  The capital securities are required to be redeemed on July 25, 2031; however, the Company has a semi-annual option to shorten the maturity date.  The redemption price is $1,000 per capital security plus any accrued and unpaid distributions to the date of redemption.
 
Holders of the capital securities have no voting rights, are unsecured and rank junior in priority of payment to all of the Company’s indebtedness and senior to the Company’s common stock.
 
Although the securities issued by the Trust are not included as a component of stockholders’ equity, the securities are treated as capital for regulatory purposes, subject to certain limitations.

The Company completed the public offering of $75.0 million of 5.75% fixed-to-floating rate subordinated debentures during fiscal year 2016. These notes are due August 15, 2026. The subordinated debentures were sold at par, resulting in net proceeds of approximately $73.9 million. At September 30, 2016, the Company had $73.2 million in subordinated debentures, net of issuance costs of $1.8 million. Accumulated interest expense on the subordinated debentures was $0.5 million as of September 30, 2016.

As of September 30, 2016, the Company had three capital leases, two equipment leases and one property lease.  At September 30, 2016, the portion of the liability expected to be expensed and amortized beyond 12 months is $1.9 million.  The majority of the $1.9 million is related to the Urbandale, Iowa retail branch location.


NOTE 10.  EMPLOYEE STOCK OWNERSHIP AND PROFIT SHARING PLANS
 
The Company maintains an Employee Stock Ownership Plan (“ESOP”) for eligible employees who have 1000 hours of employment with the Bank, have worked one year at the Bank and who have attained age 21.  ESOP expense of $1,150,000, $994,000 and $703,000 was recorded for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.  Contributions of $1,174,682, $992,038 and $850,406 were made to the ESOP during the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, respectively.
 
Contributions to the ESOP and shares released from suspense are allocated among ESOP participants on the basis of compensation in the year of allocation.  Benefits generally become 100% vested after seven years of credited service.  Prior to the completion of seven years of credited service, a participant who terminates employment for reasons other than death or disability receives a reduced benefit based on the ESOP’s vesting schedule.  Forfeitures are reallocated among remaining participating employees in the same proportion as contributions.  Benefits are payable in the form of stock upon termination of employment.  The Company’s contributions to the ESOP are not fixed, so benefits payable under the ESOP cannot be estimated.
 
For the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, 19,381 shares, 23,750 shares and 24,125 shares with a fair value of $60.61, $41.77 and $35.25 per share, respectively, were released. For the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, allocated shares and total ESOP shares reflect 15,502 shares, 10,294 shares and 10,643 shares, respectively, withdrawn from the ESOP by participants who are no longer with the Company or by participants diversifying their holdings.  At September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014, there were 2,710, 2,974 and 2,529 shares purchased, respectively, for dividend reinvestment.

Year-end ESOP shares are as follows:
 
At September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Allocated shares
262,872

 
256,283

 
239,879

Unearned shares

 

 

Total ESOP shares
262,872

 
256,283

 
239,879

Fair value of unearned shares
$

 
$

 
$


123



The Company also has a profit sharing plan covering substantially all full-time employees.  Contribution expense to the profit sharing plan, included in compensation and benefits, for the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 was $1.26 million, $1.1 million and $0.9 million, respectively.
 
NOTE 11.  SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION PLANS
 
The Company maintains the 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, as amended and restated, which, among other things, provides for the awarding of stock options and nonvested (restricted) shares to certain officers and directors of the Company.  Awards are granted by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors based on the performance of the award recipients or other relevant factors.
 
The following table shows the effect to income, net of tax benefits, of share-based expense recorded in the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014.
 
Year Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Total employee stock-based compensation expense recognized in income, net of tax effects of $192, $66 and $51, respectively
$
559

 
$
334

 
$
120


As of September 30, 2016, stock-based compensation expense not yet recognized in income totaled $0.2 million, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted-average remaining period of 1.86 years.
 
At grant date, the fair value of options awarded to recipients is estimated using a Black-Scholes valuation model.  The exercise price of stock options equals the fair market value of the underlying stock at the date of grant.  Options are issued for 10-year periods with 100% vesting generally occurring either at grant date or over a four-year period.  No options were granted during the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014.  The intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 were $1.5 million, $0.9 million and $1.4 million, respectively.
 
Shares are granted each year to executives and senior leadership members under the Company incentive plan. These shares vest at various times ranging from immediately to four years based on circumstances at time of grant. The fair value is determined based on the fair market value of the Company’s stock on the grant date.  Director shares are issued to the Company’s directors, and these shares vest immediately.  The total fair value of director’s shares granted during the years ended September 30, 2016, 2015 and 2014 was $0.2 million, $0.1 million and $0.1 million, respectively.
 
In addition to the Company’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, the Company also maintains the 1995 Stock Option and Incentive Plan.  No new options were, or could have been, awarded under the 1995 plan during the year ended September 30, 2016; however, previously awarded options were exercised under this plan during the year.

The following tables show the activity of options and nonvested (restricted) shares granted, exercised or forfeited under all of the Company’s option and incentive plans during the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015.
 

124


 
Number
of
Shares

 
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

 
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term (Yrs)

 
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value

 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options outstanding, September 30, 2015
189,088

 
$
25.74

 
3.16

 
$
3,027

Granted

 

 

 

Exercised
(63,528
)
 
25.77

 

 
1,510

Forfeited or expired

 

 

 

Options outstanding, September 30, 2016
125,560

 
$
25.73

 
2.68

 
$
4,379

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options exercisable end of year
125,560

 
$
25.73

 
2.68

 
$
4,379


 
Number
of
Shares

 
Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

 
Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term (Yrs)

 
Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value

 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options outstanding, September 30, 2014
235,766

 
$
25.20

 
3.78

 
$
2,507

Granted

 

 

 

Exercised
(46,678
)
 
22.98

 

 
925

Forfeited or expired

 

 

 

Options outstanding, September 30, 2015
189,088

 
$
25.74

 
3.16

 
$
3,027

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Options exercisable end of year
189,088

 
$
25.74

 
3.16

 
$
3,027


 
Number of
Shares

 
Weighted Average
Fair Value At Grant

 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
 
 
 
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2015
44,002

 
$
40.80

Granted
8,154

 
42.49

Vested
(33,666
)
 
40.93

Forfeited or expired
2,166

 
46.98

Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2016
20,656

 
$
41.37


 
Number of
Shares

 
Weighted Average
Fair Value At Grant

 
(Dollars in Thousands, Except Share and Per Share Data)
 
 
 
 
Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2014
4,000

 
$
28.61

Granted
51,217

 
41.10

Vested
(11,215
)
 
37.81

Forfeited or expired

 

Nonvested shares outstanding, September 30, 2015
44,002

 
$
40.80


125



NOTE 12.  INCOME TAXES

The Company and its subsidiaries file a consolidated federal income tax return on a fiscal year basis. The provision for income taxes consists of:
 
Years ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Federal:
 
 
 
 
 
Current
$
4,410

 
$
4,217

 
$
3,787

Deferred
(440
)
 
(3,896
)
 
(1,765
)
 
3,970

 
321

 
2,022

 
 
 
 
 
 
State:
 

 
 

 
 

Current
1,422

 
1,048

 
874

Deferred
210

 
(1
)
 
10

 
1,632

 
1,047

 
884

 
 
 
 
 
 
Income tax expense
$
5,602

 
$
1,368

 
$
2,906


Total income tax expense differs from the statutory federal income tax rate as follows:
 
Years ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income tax expense at federal tax rate
$
13,588

 
$
6,798

 
$
6,517

Increase (decrease) resulting from:
 

 
 

 
 

State income taxes net of federal benefit
933

 
692

 
575

Nontaxable buildup in cash surrender value
(580
)
 
(711
)
 
(399
)
Incentive stock option expense
(66
)
 
(37
)
 
(187
)
Tax exempt income
(8,257
)
 
(5,230
)
 
(3,594
)
Nondeductible expenses
196

 
188

 
120

Other, net
(212
)
 
(332
)
 
(126
)
Total income tax expense
$
5,602

 
$
1,368

 
$
2,906



126


The components of the net deferred tax asset (liability) at September 30, 2016 and 2015 are:
 
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Deferred tax assets:
 
 
 
Bad debts
$
2,044

 
$
2,286

Deferred compensation
1,345

 
1,040

Stock based compensation
165

 
235

Operational reserve
540

 
453

AMT Credit
5,563

 
4,490

Intangibles
393

 
573

Indirect tax benefits of unrecognized tax positions
216

 
384

Other assets
1,462

 
1,293

 
11,728

 
10,754

 
 
 
 
Deferred tax liabilities:
 

 
 

FHLB stock dividend
(411
)
 
(414
)
Premises and equipment
(1,913
)
 
(1,222
)
Patents
(988
)
 
(967
)
Prepaid expenses
(668
)
 
(633
)
Net unrealized gains on securities available for sale
(12,348
)
 
(521
)
 
(16,328
)
 
(3,757
)
 
 
 
 
Net deferred tax assets (liabilities)
$
(4,600
)
 
$
6,997


As of September 30, 2016 and 2015, the Company had a gross deferred tax asset of $921,000 and $829,000, respectively, for separate company state cumulative net operating loss carryforwards, which was fully reserved for as the Company does not anticipate any state taxable income at the holding company level in future periods.

Finally, management believes that the realization of its deferred tax assets is more likely than not based on the expectations as to future taxable income; therefore, there was no deferred tax valuation allowance at September 30, 2016, and 2015 with the exception of the state cumulative net operating loss carryforwards discussed above.
 
Federal income tax laws provided savings banks with additional bad debt deductions through September 30, 1987, totaling 6.7 million for the Bank.  Accounting standards do not require a deferred tax liability to be recorded on this amount, which liability otherwise would total approximately $2.3 million at September 30, 2016 and 2015.  If the Bank were to be liquidated or otherwise cease to be a bank, or if tax laws were to change, the $2.3 million would be recorded as expense.
 
The provisions of ASC 740, Income Taxes, address the determination of how tax benefits claimed or expected to be claimed on a tax return should be recorded in the consolidated financial statements.  Under ASC 740, the Company recognizes the tax benefits from an uncertain tax position only if it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained upon examination, with a tax examination being presumed to occur, including the resolution of any related appeals or litigation.  The tax benefits recognized in the consolidated financial statements from such a position are measured as the largest benefit that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate resolution.
 
The Company’s tax reserves reflect management’s judgment as to the resolution of the issues involved if subject to judicial review.  While the Company believes that its reserves are adequate to cover reasonably expected tax risks, there can be no assurance that, in all instances, an issue raised by a tax authority will be resolved at a financial cost that does not exceed its related reserve.  With respect to these reserves, the Company’s income tax expense would include (i) any changes in tax reserves arising from material changes during the period in the facts and circumstances surrounding a tax issue, and (ii) any difference from the Company’s tax position as recorded in the consolidated financial statements and the final resolution of a tax issue during the period.
 

127


The tax years ended September 30, 2013 and later remain subject to examination by the Internal Revenue Service.  For state purposes, the tax years ended September 30, 2013 and later remain open for examination, with few exceptions.
 
A reconciliation of the beginning and ending balances for liabilities associated with unrecognized tax benefits for the years ended September 30, 2016, and 2015 follows:
 
September 30,
2016

 
2015

 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Balance at beginning of year
$
974

 
$
983

Additions for tax positions related to the current year
63

 
49

Additions for tax positions related to the prior years

 
4

Reductions for tax positions due to settlement with taxing authorities
(372
)
 
(62
)
Reductions for tax positions related to prior years
(140
)
 

Balance at end of year
$
525

 
$
974

 
The total amount of unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would impact the effective rate was $347,000 as of September 30, 2016.  The Company recognizes interest related to unrecognized tax benefits as a component of income tax expense.  The amount of accrued interest related to unrecognized tax benefits was $110,000 as of September 30, 2016.  The Company does not anticipate any significant change in the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits within the next 12 months.

NOTE 13.  CAPITAL REQUIREMENTS AND RESTRICTIONS ON RETAINED EARNINGS
 
In July 2013, the Company’s primary federal regulator, the Federal Reserve and the Bank’s primary federal regulator, the OCC, approved final rules (the “Basel III Capital Rules”) establishing a new comprehensive capital framework for U.S. banking organizations. The Basel III Capital Rules generally implement the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s (the “Basel Committee”) December 2010 final capital framework referred to as “Basel III” for strengthening international capital standards.  The Basel III Capital Rules substantially revise the risk-based capital requirements applicable to financial institution holding companies and their depository institution subsidiaries, including us and the Bank, as compared to the current U.S. general risk-based capital rules. The Basel III Capital Rules revise the definitions and the components of regulatory capital, as well as address other issues affecting the numerator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios.  The Basel III Capital Rules also address asset risk weights and other matters affecting the denominator in banking institutions’ regulatory capital ratios and replace the existing general risk-weighting approach, which was derived from the Basel Committee’s 1988 “Basel I” capital accords, with a more risk-sensitive approach based, in part, on the “standardized approach” in the Basel Committee’s 2004 “Basel II” capital accords. In addition, the Basel III Capital Rules implement certain provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act, including the requirements of Section 939A to remove references to credit ratings from the federal agencies’ rules. The Basel III Capital Rules became effective for us and the Bank on January 1, 2015, subject to phase-in periods for certain of their components and other provisions.
 
Pursuant to the Basel III Capital Rules, our Company and Bank, respectively, are subject to new regulatory capital adequacy requirements promulgated by the Federal Reserve and the OCC. Failure by our Company or Bank to meet minimum capital requirements could result in certain mandatory and discretionary actions by our regulators that could have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial statements. Prior to January 1, 2015, our Bank was subject to capital requirements under Basel I and there were no capital requirements for our Company. Under the capital requirements and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, our Company and Bank must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of our Company’s and Bank’s assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices. Our Company’s and Bank’s capital amounts and classifications are also subject to qualitative judgments by regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.

128



Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Company and the Bank to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the table below) of total risk-based capital and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined), and a leverage ratio consisting of Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined).  At September 30, 2015, both the Bank and the Company exceeded federal regulatory minimum capital requirements to be classified as well-capitalized under the prompt corrective action requirements.  The Company and the Bank took the accumulated other comprehensive income (“AOCI”) opt-out election; under the rule, non-advanced approach banking organizations were given a one-time option to exclude certain AOCI components.  The table below includes certain non-GAAP financial measures that are used by investors, analysts and bank regulatory agencies to assess the capital position of financial services companies.  Management reviews these measures along with other measures of capital as part of its financial analyses and has included this non-GAAP financial information, and the corresponding reconciliation to total equity.
 
Company (Actual)
 
Bank (Actual)
 
Minimum
Requirement For
Capital Adequacy
Purposes
 
Minimum Requirement
To Be Well Capitalized
Under Prompt
Corrective Action
Provisions
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
Ratio
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
September 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tier 1 (core) capital (to adjusted total assets)
$
263,555

 
8.35
%
 
$
324,142

 
10.35
%
 
$
10,542

 
4.00
%
 
$
13,178

 
5.00
%
Common equity Tier 1 (to risk-weighted assets)
255,543

 
17.28

 
324,142

 
21.95

 
11,499

 
4.50

 
16,610

 
6.50

Tier 1 (core) capital (to risk-weighted assets)
263,555

 
17.82

 
324,142

 
21.95

 
15,813

 
6.00

 
21,084

 
8.00

Total qualifying capital (to risk-weighted assets)
342,589

 
23.17

 
329,965

 
22.35

 
27,407

 
8.00

 
34,259

 
10.00

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
September 30, 2015
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Tangible capital (to tangible assets)
$
224,426

 
9.36
%
 
$
213,220

 
8.89
%
 
$
8,977

 
4.00
%
 
$
11,221

 
5.00
%
Tier 1 (core) capital (to adjusted total assets)
216,931

 
19.85

 
213,220

 
19.52

 
9,762

 
4.50

 
14,101

 
6.50

Tier 1 (core) capital (to risk-weighted assets)
224,426

 
20.54

 
213,220

 
19.52

 
13,466

 
6.00

 
17,954

 
8.00

Total risk based capital (to risk-weighted assets)
230,820

 
21.12

 
219,614

 
20.11

 
18,466

 
8.00

 
23,082

 
10.00



129


The following table provides a reconciliation of the amounts included in the table above for the Company.
 
 
Standardized Approach (1)
September 30, 2016
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
 
Total equity
$
334,975

Adjustments:
 

LESS: Goodwill, net of associated deferred tax liabilities
35,713

LESS: Certain other intangible assets
17,352

LESS: Net deferred tax assets from operating loss and tax credit carry-forwards
3,447

LESS: Net unrealized gains (losses) on available-for-sale securities
22,920

Common Equity Tier 1 (1)
255,543

Long-term debt and other instruments qualifying as Tier 1
10,310

LESS: Additional tier 1 capital deductions
2,298

Total Tier 1 capital
263,555

Allowance for loan losses
5,823

Subordinated debentures (net of issuance costs)
73,211

Total qualifying capital
342,589


(1) 
The Basel III Capital Rules revised the definition of capital, increased minimum capital ratios, and introduced a minimum CET1 ratio.  Those changes became effective for the Company on January 1, 2015, and are being fully phased in through the end of 2021.  The capital ratios were determined using the Basel III Capital Rules that became effective on January 1, 2015.

Beginning January 1, 2016, Basel III implemented a requirement for all banking organizations to maintain a capital conservation buffer above the minimum risk-based capital requirements in order to avoid certain limitations on capital distributions, stock repurchases and discretionary bonus payments to executive officers. The capital conservation buffer is exclusively composed of Common Equity Tier 1 capital, and it applies to each of the three risk-based capital ratios but not the leverage ratio. On January 1, 2016, our Company and Bank were expected to comply with the capital conservation buffer requirement, which increased the three risk-based capital ratios by 0.625% each year through 2019, at which point the Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based, Tier 1 risk-based and total risk-based capital ratios will be 7.0%, 8.5% and 10.5%, respectively.

NOTE 14.  COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
In the normal course of business, the Bank makes various commitments to extend credit which are not reflected in the accompanying consolidated financial statements.
 
At September 30, 2016 and 2015, unfunded loan commitments approximated $182.9 million and $158.3 million, respectively, excluding undisbursed portions of loans in process.  Unfunded loan commitments at September 30, 2016 and 2015 were principally for variable rate loans.  Commitments, which are disbursed subject to certain limitations, extend over various periods of time.  Generally, unused commitments are cancelled upon expiration of the commitment term as outlined in each individual contract.
 
The Company had no commitments to purchase securities at September 30, 2016. At September 30, 2015, the Company had two commitments to purchase securities available for sale totaling $7.9 million and three commitments to purchase securities held to maturity totaling $3.0 million.
 
The exposure to credit loss in the event of non-performance by other parties to financial instruments for commitments to extend credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments.  The same credit policies and collateral requirements are used in making commitments and conditional obligations as are used for on-balance-sheet instruments. Management monitors several factors when estimating its allowance for uncollectible off-balance-sheet credit exposures, including, but not limited to, economic developments and historical loss rates.
 

130


Since certain commitments to make loans and to fund lines of credit expire without being used, the amount does not necessarily represent future cash commitments.  In addition, commitments used to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.
 
Securities with fair values of approximately $5.8 million at September 30, 2016 and 2015 were pledged as collateral for public funds on deposit.  Securities with fair values of approximately $3.4 million and $14.8 million at September 30, 2016, and 2015, respectively, were pledged as collateral for individual, trust and estate deposits.
 
Legal Proceedings
 
The Company and the Bank were named as defendants, along with other defendants, in four class action litigations commenced in three different federal district courts between October 23, 2015 and November 5, 2015: (1) Fuentes, et al. v. UniRush LLC, et al. (S.D.N.Y. Case No. 1:15-cv-08372-JPO); (2) Huff et al. v. UniRush, LLC et al. (E.D. Cal. Case No. 2:15-cv-02253-KJM-CMK); (3) Peterkin v. UniRush LLC, et al. (S.D.N.Y. Case No. 1:15-cv-08573-PAE); and (4) Jones v. UniRush, LLC et al. (E.D. Pa. Case No. 5:15-cv-05996-JLS). The same defendants, including the Company and the Bank, were also named as defendants in an additional class action litigation commenced in another federal district court on April 13, 2016: (5) Smith v. UniRush LLC, et al. (C.D. Cal. Case No. 2:16-cv-02533-SVW-E). The same defendants, including the Company and the Bank, were named as defendants in a lawsuit filed by an individual plaintiff in a Texas state court on June 24, 2016: (6) Jacobs v. UniRush LLC et al. (Harris County, Texas County Civ. Ct. Cause No. 1079432). The complaints in each of these six actions seek monetary damages for the alleged inability of customers of the prepaid card product RushCard to access the product for up to two weeks starting on or about October 12, 2015. In each case, the plaintiffs alleged claims for breach of contract, fraud, misrepresentation, negligence, unjust enrichment, conversion, and breach of fiduciary duty and violations of various state consumer protection statutes prohibiting unfair or deceptive acts or trade/business practices. In addition, the OCC and the CFPB are examining the events surrounding the allegations with respect to the Company and the other defendants, respectively. The OCC has broad supervisory powers with respect to the Bank and could seek to initiate supervisory action if it believes such action is warranted. A settlement was negotiated with class counsel in actions (1)-(4) under which neither the Company nor the Bank made any payment. Notice of the settlement was given to the approximately 425,000 class members, of which 70 opted out from the class, but not a single objection to the settlement was filed, either by any potential class member or any of the regulatory agencies who received notice of the settlement. At a September 12, 2016 hearing in the lead class action case, action (1), the Court granted final approval of the settlement, certified the Settlement Class and entered final judgment for actions (1)-(4). In the interim, action (5) was settled for a nominal amount, with no payment by the Company or the Bank, and the case was formally resolved with the filing of a dismissal notice on July 15, 2016. At this time, the petition in action (6) specifically alleges that the maximum damages, costs and attorneys’ fees that plaintiff seeks do not exceed $74,000.

The Bank was served on April 15, 2013, with a lawsuit captioned Inter National Bank v. NetSpend Corporation, MetaBank, BDO USA, LLP d/b/a BDO Seidman, Cause No. C-2084-12-I filed in the District Court of Hidalgo County, Texas. The Plaintiff’s Second Amended Original Petition and Application for Temporary Restraining Order and Temporary Injunction adds both MetaBank and BDO Seidman to the original causes of action against NetSpend. NetSpend acts as a prepaid card program manager and processor for both INB and MetaBank. According to the Petition, NetSpend has informed Inter National Bank (“INB”) that the depository accounts at INB for the NetSpend program supposedly contained $10.5 million less than they should. INB alleges that NetSpend has breached its fiduciary duty by making affirmative misrepresentations to INB about the safety and stability of the program, and by failing to timely disclose the nature and extent of any alleged shortfall in settlement of funds related to cardholder activity and the nature and extent of NetSpend’s systemic deficiencies in its accounting and settlement processing procedures. To the extent that an accounting reveals that there is an actual shortfall, INB alleges that MetaBank may be liable for portions or all of said sum due to the fact that funds have been transferred from INB to MetaBank, and thus MetaBank would have been unjustly enriched. The Bank is vigorously contesting this matter. In January 2014, NetSpend was granted summary judgment in this matter which is under appeal. Because the theory of liability against both NetSpend and the Bank is the same, the Bank views the NetSpend summary judgment as a positive in support of our position.  An estimate of a range of reasonably possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because discovery is still being conducted.

    








131


The Bank commenced action against C&B Farms, LLC, Dakota River Farms, LLC, Dakota Grain Farms, LLC, Heather Swenson and Tracy Clement in early July, 2015, in the Third Judicial Circuit Court of the State of South Dakota, seeking to collect upon certain delinquent loans made in connection with the 2014 farming operations of the three identified limited liability companies and the personal guaranties of Swenson and Clement. The three companies and Clement answered the Complaint and asserted a counterclaim against the Bank and a third-party claim against the Bank’s loan officer, alleging fraud and misrepresentation, as well as promissory estoppel.   On January 7, 2016, the Bank obtained a judgment for $6.1 million, the full amount due and owing on the delinquent loans, together with attorneys’ fees, costs and post-judgment interest.  On February 25, 2016, the Court entered an order and judgment in favor of the Bank granting the Bank’s renewed motion for summary judgment as to counterclaims and third party claim. Tracy Clement, the primary guarantor of the C&B Farms, Dakota Grain Farms, and Dakota River Farms indebtedness has filed a Chapter 11 bankruptcy proceeding in Minnesota. The Bank is an unsecured creditor in the bankruptcy proceeding. The Bank still has the right to collect from the three limited liability company debtors (C&B, Dakota Grain, and Dakota River). However, the Bank believes each entity is now insolvent and the collateral recovered and liquidated to the extent possible. The Bank has also settled with the other personal guarantor, Heather Swenson. The Bank commenced action against Interstate Commodities, Inc., on February 1, 2016, in the United States District Court for the District of South Dakota, Central Division. This matter arises out of the Bank’s loans to C&B Farms, which were guaranteed by Tracy Clement. The case alleges that Interstate Commodities has breached the terms of a subordination agreement entered into between Interstate Commodities and the Bank relating to the 2015 crops of C&B Farms, LLC. In March, 2015, the Bank sent a letter to C&B Farms and Interstate Commodities agreeing that the Bank would subordinate its first position lien in the farm products of C&B Farms once the Bank’s 2015 input advances in an agreed upon sum had been paid in full. Interstate Commodities entered into various agreements with C&B Farms in which they agreed to purchase grain at a future date and provided purchase price advance financing to C&B Farms. Interstate Commodities also partially performed under the subordination agreement by paying or allowing certain sums to flow back to the Bank to pay on the agreed upon inputs. Interstate Commodities terminated the payments to the Bank before allowing full repayment of the 2015 inputs financed by the Bank before the subordination agreement was reached. This large, non-performing agricultural relationship was partially charged off during fiscal year 2016 and has no remaining loan balance.

The Bank was served on October 14, 2016, with a lawsuit captioned Card Limited, LLC v. MetaBank dba Meta Payment Systems, Civil No. 2:16-cv-00980 in the United States District Court for the District of Utah. This action was initiated by former prepaid program manager of the Bank, which was terminated by the Bank earlier this year. Card Limited alleges that after all of the programs have been wound down, there are two accounts with a positive balance to which they are entitled. The Bank’s position is that Card Limited is not entitled to the funds contained in said accounts. The total amount to which Card Limited claims it is entitled is $1,579,398. The Bank intends to vigorously defend this claim. An estimate of a range of reasonably possible loss cannot be made at this stage of the litigation because discovery is still being conducted.

Other than the matters set forth above, there are no other new material pending legal proceedings or updates to which the Company or its subsidiaries is a party other than ordinary litigation routine to their respective businesses.




132



NOTE 15.  LEASE COMMITMENTS
 
The Company has leased property under various non-cancelable operating lease agreements which expire at various times through 2036, and require annual rentals ranging from $14,000 to $750,000 plus the payment of the property taxes, normal maintenance, and insurance on certain property. The Company also entered into capital lease agreements during fiscal year ended September 30, 2015, for building and equipment expiring at various times through 2035. Amortization expense for these capital leases was $0.1 million for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, and included in non-interest expense.
 
The following table shows the total minimum rental commitment for our operating and capital leases as of September 30, 2016.

 
Year Ended September 30,
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
 
Operating
Leases
 
Capital
Leases
2017
$
2,175

 
$
201

2018
2,092

 
179

2019
2,103

 
179

2020
2,100

 
182

2021
1,949

 
182

Thereafter
19,396

 
2,422

Total Leases Commitments
$
29,815

 
$
3,345

 
 
 
 
Amounts representing interest
 

 
$
1,327

Present value of net minimum lease payments
 

 
2,018



NOTE 16.  SEGMENT REPORTING
 
An operating segment is generally defined as a component of a business for which discrete financial information is available and whose results are reviewed by the chief operating decision-maker. Operating segments are aggregated into reportable segments if certain criteria are met.

In the Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended September 30, 2015, the Company reported its results of operations through three business segments: Meta Payment Systems, Retail Bank, and Other. Effective October 1, 2015, segments are now aligned with the new management operating structure implemented by the Company for the fiscal year 2016. The Company accordingly has changed its basis presentation for segments, and following such change, reports its results of operations through the following three business segments: Payments, Banking, and Corporate Services/Other. Certain shared services, including the investment portfolio, which was included in the former Retail Bank segment, is now included in Corporate Services/Other. AFS/IBEX and Refund Advantage were previously and are currently in the Banking and Payments segments, respectively. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation.

In addition, certain management accounting methodologies, including the treatment of intersegment assets and liabilities, and related allocations, were refined. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation for all segment reporting, are appropriately reported below.

133


 
Payments
 
Banking
 
Corporate Services/Other
 
Total
Year Ended September 30, 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
$
9,711

 
$
38,321

 
$
33,364

 
$
81,396

Interest expense
181

 
1,331

 
2,579

 
4,091

Net interest income (expense)
9,530

 
36,990

 
30,785

 
77,305

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
971

 
3,634

 

 
4,605

Non-interest income
95,261

 
4,280

 
1,229

 
100,770

Non-interest expense
74,168

 
21,516

 
38,964

 
134,648

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
29,652

 
16,120

 
(6,950
)
 
38,822

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
41,357

 
929,243

 
3,035,819

 
4,006,419

Total goodwill

 

 
36,928

 
36,928

Total deposits
2,131,042

 
299,030

 
10

 
2,430,082


 
Payments
 
Banking
 
Corporate Services/Other
 
Total
Year Ended September 30, 2015
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
$
7,261

 
$
31,394

 
$
22,952

 
$
61,607

Interest expense
169

 
1,377

 
841

 
2,387

Net interest income (expense)
7,092

 
30,017

 
22,111

 
59,220

Provision (recovery) for loan losses

 
689

 
776

 
1,465

Non-interest income
54,417

 
3,358

 
399

 
58,174

Non-interest expense
47,458

 
17,900

 
31,148

 
96,506

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
14,051

 
14,786

 
(9,414
)
 
19,423

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
44,139

 
706,172

 
1,779,394

 
2,529,705

Total goodwill

 

 
36,928

 
36,928

Total deposits
1,424,304

 
233,235

 
(5
)
 
1,657,534

 
 
Payments
 
Banking
 
Corporate Services/Other
 
Total
Year Ended September 30, 2014
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
$
5,973

 
$
21,549

 
$
21,138

 
$
48,660

Interest expense
125

 
1,396

 
877

 
2,398

Net interest income (expense)
5,848

 
20,153

 
20,261

 
46,262

Provision (recovery) for loan losses

 
1,150

 

 
1,150

Non-interest income
48,524

 
1,986

 
1,228

 
51,738

Non-interest expense
42,536

 
12,680

 
23,015

 
78,231

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)
11,836

 
8,309

 
(1,526
)
 
18,619

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Total assets
38,451

 
493,538

 
1,522,042

 
2,054,031

Total deposits
1,099,548

 
266,993

 

 
1,366,541





134


NOTE 17.  PARENT COMPANY FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
Presented below are condensed financial statements for the parent company, Meta Financial.
 
CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION
 
September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
ASSETS
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
15,716

 
$
14,280

Investment in subsidiaries
403,574

 
267,623

Other assets
413

 
408

Total assets
$
419,703

 
$
282,311

 
 
 
 
LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
 

 
 

 
 
 
 
LIABILITIES
 

 
 

Long term debt
$
83,521

 
$
10,310

Other liabilities
1,207

 
666

Total liabilities
$
84,728

 
$
10,976

 
 
 
 
STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY
 

 
 

Common stock
$
85

 
$
82

Additional paid-in capital
184,780

 
170,749

Retained earnings
127,190

 
98,359

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)
22,920

 
2,455

Treasury stock, at cost

 
(310
)
Total stockholders' equity
$
334,975

 
$
271,335

Total liabilities and stockholders' equity
$
419,703

 
$
282,311


CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
 
Years Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Interest expense
$
1,022

 
$
418

 
$
348

Other expense
382

 
269

 
770

Total expense
1,404

 
687

 
1,118

 
 
 
 
 
 
Gain (loss) before income taxes and equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
(1,404
)
 
(687
)
 
(1,118
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Income tax (benefit)
(519
)
 
(324
)
 
(422
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Gain (loss) before equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
(885
)
 
(363
)
 
(696
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
34,105

 
18,418

 
16,409

 
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

 

135


CONDENSED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
 
For the Years Ended September 30,
2016
 
2015
 
2014
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
 
 
 
 
 
Net income
$
33,220

 
$
18,055

 
$
15,713

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
 

 
 

 
 

Depreciation, amortization and accretion, net
(22
)
 

 
(310
)
Equity in undistributed net income of subsidiaries
(34,105
)
 
(18,418
)
 
(16,409
)
Change in other assets
(5
)
 
(15
)
 
246

Change in other liabilities
541

 
378

 
(332
)
Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities
(371
)
 

 
(1,092
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITES
 

 
 

 
 

Capital contributions to subsidiaries
(81,000
)
 
(67,600
)
 

Net cash used in investing activities
(81,000
)
 
(67,600
)
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
 

 
 

 
 

Cash dividends paid
(4,389
)
 
(3,493
)
 
(3,184
)
Stock compensation
427

 
253

 
4

Proceeds from issuance of common stock
11,500

 
75,471

 
(51
)
Proceeds from exercise of stock options
2,036

 
210

 
2,376

Proceeds from long term debt
75,000

 

 

Payment of debt issuance costs
(1,767
)
 

 

Other, net

 

 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities
82,807

 
72,441

 
(855
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
Net change in cash and cash equivalents
$
1,436

 
$
4,841

 
$
(1,947
)
 
 
 
 
 
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
 

 
 

 
 

Beginning of year
$
14,280

 
$
9,439

 
$
11,386

End of year
$
15,716

 
$
14,280

 
$
9,439


The extent to which the Company may pay cash dividends to stockholders will depend on the cash currently available at the Company, as well as the ability of the Bank to pay dividends to the Company.  For further discussion, see Note 13 herein.
 

136


NOTE 18.  SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)

 
QUARTER ENDED
 
December 31
 
March 31
 
June 30
 
September 30
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fiscal Year 2016
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Interest income
$
18,275

 
$
20,629

 
$
20,763

 
$
21,729

Interest expense
720

 
691

 
844

 
1,836

Net interest income
17,555

 
19,938

 
19,919

 
19,893

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
786

 
1,173

 
2,098

 
548

Net Income (loss)
4,058

 
14,283

 
8,873

 
6,006

Earnings (loss) per common and common equivalent share
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
0.49

 
$
1.69

 
$
1.05

 
$
0.71

Diluted
0.49

 
1.68

 
1.04

 
0.70

Dividend declared per share
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fiscal Year 2015
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest income
$
14,232

 
$
15,758

 
$
15,254

 
$
16,363

Interest expense
661

 
473

 
593

 
660

Net interest income
13,571

 
15,285

 
14,661

 
15,703

Provision (recovery) for loan losses
48

 
593

 
700

 
124

Net Income (loss)
3,595

 
5,181

 
4,640

 
4,639

Earnings (loss) per common and common equivalent share
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
0.58

 
$
0.79

 
$
0.67

 
$
0.64

Diluted
0.58

 
0.78

 
0.66

 
0.64

Dividend declared per share
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Fiscal Year 2014
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Interest income
$
11,162

 
$
12,063

 
$
12,566

 
$
12,869

Interest expense
649

 
544

 
638

 
567

Net interest income
10,513

 
11,519

 
11,928

 
12,302

Provision (recovery) for loan losses

 
300

 
300

 
550

Net Income (loss)
4,002

 
4,144

 
4,204

 
3,363

Earnings (loss) per common and common equivalent share
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Basic
$
0.66

 
$
0.68

 
$
0.69

 
$
0.54

Diluted
0.65

 
0.67

 
0.68

 
0.53

Dividend declared per share
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13

 
0.13














137


NOTE 19.  FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 820, Fair Value Measurements defines fair value, establishes a framework for measuring the fair value of assets and liabilities using a hierarchy system and requires disclosures about fair value measurement.  It clarifies that fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants in the market in which the reporting entity transacts.
 
The fair value hierarchy is as follows:
 
Level 1 Inputs – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for identical instruments traded in active markets that the Company has the ability to access at measurement date.

Level 2 Inputs – Valuation is based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model-based valuation techniques for which significant assumptions are observable in the market.
 
Level 3 Inputs – Valuation is generated from model-based techniques that use significant assumptions not observable in the market and are used only to the extent that observable inputs are not available.  These unobservable assumptions reflect the Company’s own estimates of assumptions that market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability.  Valuation techniques include use of option pricing models, discounted cash flow models and similar techniques.
 
There were no transfers between levels of the fair value hierarchy for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015.
 
Securities Available for Sale and Held to Maturity.  Securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis and securities held to maturity are carried at amortized cost.  Fair value measurement is based upon quoted prices, if available.  If quoted prices are not available, fair values are measured using an independent pricing service.  For both Level 1 and Level 2 securities, management uses various methods and techniques to corroborate prices obtained from the pricing service, including but not limited to reference to dealer or other market quotes, and by reviewing valuations of comparable instruments.  The Company’s Level 1 securities include equity securities and mutual funds.  The Company’s Level 2 securities include U.S. Government agency and instrumentality securities, U.S. Government agency and instrumentality mortgage-backed securities, municipal bonds, corporate debt securities and trust preferred securities.  The Company had no Level 3 securities at September 30, 2016, and 2015.
 
The fair values of securities are determined by obtaining quoted prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges (Level 1 inputs), or valuation based upon quoted prices for similar instruments in active markets, quoted prices for identical or similar instruments in markets that are not active and model‑based valuation techniques for which significant assumptions are observable in the market (Level 2 inputs).  The Company considers these valuations supplied by a third-party provider which utilizes several sources for valuing fixed-income securities.  These sources include Interactive Data Corporation, Reuters, Standard and Poor’s, Bloomberg Financial Markets, Street Software Technology and the third‑party provider’s own matrix and desk pricing.  The Company, no less than annually, reviews the third party’s methods and source’s methodology for reasonableness and to ensure an understanding of inputs utilized in determining fair value.  Sources utilized by the third-party provider include but are not limited to pricing models that vary based on asset class and include available trade, bid, and other market information.  This methodology includes but is not limited to broker quotes, proprietary models, descriptive terms and conditions databases, as well as extensive quality control programs. Monthly, the Company receives and compares prices provided by multiple securities dealers and pricing providers to validate the accuracy and reasonableness of prices received from the third-party provider. On a monthly basis, the Investment Committee reviews mark-to-market changes in the securities portfolio for reasonableness.


138


The following table summarizes the fair values of securities available for sale and held to maturity at September 30, 2016 and 2015.  Securities available for sale are measured at fair value on a recurring basis, while securities held to maturity are carried at amortized cost in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
 
Fair Value At September 30, 2016
 
Available For Sale
 
Held to Maturity
(Dollars in Thousands)
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$
12,978

 
$

 
$
12,978

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

Small business administration securities
80,719

 

 
80,719

 

 

 

 

 

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
20,937

 

 
20,937

 

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
698,672

 

 
698,672

 

 
477,202

 

 
477,202

 

Asset-backed securities
116,815

 

 
116,815

 

 

 

 

 

Mortgage-backed securities
558,940

 

 
558,940

 

 
134,435

 

 
134,435

 

Total debt securities
1,468,124

 

 
1,468,124

 

 
632,574

 

 
632,574

 

Common equities and mutual funds
1,125

 
1,125

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total securities
$
1,469,249

 
$
1,125

 
$
1,468,124

 
$

 
$
632,574

 
$

 
$
632,574

 
$


 
Fair Value At September 30, 2015
 
Available For Sale
 
Held to Maturity
(Dollars in Thousands)
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Debt securities
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Trust preferred and corporate securities
$
13,944

 
$

 
$
13,944

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

Small business administration securities
56,056

 

 
56,056

 

 

 

 

 

Obligations of states and political subdivisions

 

 

 

 
19,413

 

 
19,413

 

Non-bank qualified obligations of states and political subdivisions
608,590

 

 
608,590

 

 
261,330

 

 
261,330

 

Mortgage-backed securities
576,583

 

 
576,583

 

 
66,104

 

 
66,104

 

Total debt securities
1,255,173

 

 
1,255,173

 

 
346,847

 

 
346,847

 

Common equities and mutual funds
914

 
914

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total securities
$
1,256,087

 
$
914

 
$
1,255,173

 
$

 
$
346,847

 
$

 
$
346,847

 
$


Foreclosed Real Estate and Repossessed Assets.  Real estate properties and repossessed assets are initially recorded at the fair value less selling costs at the date of foreclosure, establishing a new cost basis.  The carrying amount represents the lower of the new cost basis or the fair value less selling costs of foreclosed assets that were measured at fair value subsequent to their initial classification as foreclosed assets.
 
Loans.  The Company does not record loans at fair value on a recurring basis.  However, if a loan is considered impaired, an allowance for loan losses is established.  Once a loan is identified as individually impaired, management measures impairment in accordance with ASC 310, Receivables.
 
The following table summarizes the assets of the Company that are measured at fair value in the consolidated statements of financial condition on a non-recurring basis as of September 30, 2016 and 2015.

139


 
 
Fair Value at September 30, 2016
(Dollars in Thousands)
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Impaired Loans, net
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 family real estate
$
68

 
$

 
$

 
$
68

Total Impaired Loans
68

 

 

 
68

Foreclosed Assets, net
76

 

 

 
76

Total
$
144

 
$

 
$

 
$
144


 
Fair Value At September 30, 2015
(Dollars in Thousands)
Total
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
Impaired Loans, net
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
1-4 family real estate
$

 
$

 
$

 
$

Commercial and multi-family real estate loans
663

 

 

 
663

Agricultural operating loans
1,880

 

 

 
1,880

Total
2,543

 

 

 
2,543

Foreclosed Assets, net

 

 

 

Total
$
2,543

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,543



 
Quantitative Information About Level 3 Fair Value Measurements
(Dollars in Thousands)
Fair Value at
September 30, 2016
 
Fair Value at
September 30, 2015
 
Valuation
Technique
 
Unobservable
Input
Impaired Loans, net
$
68

 
$
2,543

 
Market approach
 
Appraised values (1)
Foreclosed Assets, net
76

 

 
Market approach
 
Appraised values (1)

(1) 
The Company generally relies on external appraisers to develop this information.  Management reduced the appraised value by estimated selling costs in a range of 4% to 10%.

The following table discloses the Company’s estimated fair value amounts of its financial instruments.  It is management’s belief that the fair values presented below are reasonable based on the valuation techniques and data available to the Company as of September 30, 2016 and 2015, as more fully described below.  The operations of the Company are managed from a going concern basis and not a liquidation basis.  As a result, the ultimate value realized for the financial instruments presented could be substantially different when actually recognized over time through the normal course of operations.  Additionally, a substantial portion of the Company’s inherent value is the Bank’s capitalization and franchise value.  Neither of these components have been given consideration in the presentation of fair values below.


140


The following presents the carrying amount and estimated fair value of the financial instruments held by the Company at September 30, 2016 and 2015.

 
September 30, 2016
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair Value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
773,830

 
$
773,830

 
$
773,830

 
$

 
$

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale
1,469,249

 
1,469,249

 
1,125

 
1,468,124

 

Securities held to maturity
619,853

 
632,574

 

 
632,574

 

Total securities
2,089,102

 
2,101,823

 
1,125

 
2,100,698

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans receivable:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

One to four family residential mortgage loans
162,298

 
163,886

 

 

 
163,886

Commercial and multi-family real estate loans
422,932

 
422,307

 

 

 
422,307

Agricultural real estate loans
63,612

 
63,868

 

 

 
63,868

Consumer loans
37,094

 
36,738

 

 

 
36,738

Commercial operating loans
31,271

 
31,108

 

 

 
31,108

Agricultural operating loans
37,083

 
36,897

 

 

 
36,897

Premium finance loans
171,604

 
172,000

 

 

 
172,000

Total loans receivable
925,894

 
926,803

 

 

 
926,803

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
47,512

 
47,512

 

 
47,512

 

Accrued interest receivable
17,199

 
17,199

 
17,199

 

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial liabilities
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Non-interest bearing demand deposits
2,167,522

 
2,167,522

 
2,167,522

 

 

Interest bearing demand deposits, savings, and money markets
136,568

 
136,568

 
136,568

 

 

Certificates of deposit
125,992

 
125,772

 

 
125,772

 

Total deposits
2,430,082

 
2,429,862

 
2,304,090

 
125,772

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
107,000

 
108,168

 

 
108,168

 

Federal funds purchased
992,000

 
992,000

 
992,000

 

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
3,039

 
3,039

 

 
3,039

 

Capital leases
2,018

 
2,018

 

 
2,018

 

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,437

 

 
10,437

 

Subordinated debentures
73,211

 
77,250

 

 
77,250

 

Accrued interest payable
875

 
875

 
875

 

 


141


 
September 30, 2015
 
Carrying
Amount
 
Estimated
Fair Value
 
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Financial assets
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents
$
27,658

 
$
27,658

 
$
27,658

 
$

 
$

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Securities available for sale
1,256,087

 
1,256,087

 
914

 
1,255,173

 

Securities held to maturity
345,743

 
346,847

 

 
346,847

 

Total securities
1,601,830

 
1,602,934

 
914

 
1,602,020

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Loans receivable:
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

One to four family residential mortgage loans
125,021

 
121,385

 

 

 
121,385

Commercial and multi-family real estate loans
310,199

 
314,372

 

 

 
314,372

Agricultural real estate loans
64,316

 
66,682

 

 

 
66,682

Consumer loans
33,527

 
33,504

 

 

 
33,504

Commercial operating loans
29,893

 
23,245

 

 

 
23,245

Agricultural operating loans
43,626

 
40,003

 

 

 
40,003

Premium finance loans
106,505

 
108,583

 

 

 
108,583

Total loans receivable
713,087

 
707,774

 

 

 
707,774

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Federal Home Loan Bank stock
24,410

 
24,410

 

 
24,410

 

Accrued interest receivable
13,352

 
13,352

 
13,352

 

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Financial liabilities
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

 
 

Non-interest bearing demand deposits
1,449,101

 
1,369,672

 
1,369,672

 

 

Interest bearing demand deposits, savings, and money markets
117,262

 
115,204

 
115,204

 

 

Certificates of deposit
91,171

 
91,304

 

 
91,304

 

Total deposits
1,657,534

 
1,576,180

 
1,484,876

 
91,304

 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Advances from Federal Home Loan Bank
7,000

 
8,630

 

 
8,630

 

Federal funds purchased
540,000

 
540,000

 
540,000

 

 

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase
4,007

 
4,007

 

 
4,007

 

Trust preferred securities
10,310

 
10,416

 

 
10,416

 

Accrued interest payable
272

 
272

 
272

 

 


The following sets forth the methods and assumptions used in determining the fair value estimates for the Company’s financial instruments at September 30, 2016 and 2015.
 
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS
 
The carrying amount of cash and short-term investments is assumed to approximate the fair value.
 





142


SECURITIES AVAILABLE FOR SALE AND HELD TO MATURITY
 
Securities available for sale are recorded at fair value on a recurring basis and securities held to maturity are carried at amortized cost.  Fair values for investment securities are based on obtaining quoted prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges, or matrix pricing, which is a mathematical technique widely used in the industry to value debt securities without relying exclusively on quoted prices for the specific securities, but rather by relying on the securities’ relationship to other benchmark quoted securities.

LOANS RECEIVABLE, NET
 
The fair value of loans is estimated using a historical or replacement cost basis concept (i.e., an entrance price concept).  The fair value of loans was estimated by discounting the future cash flows using the current rates at which similar loans would be made to borrowers and for similar remaining maturities.  When using the discounting method to determine fair value, loans were grouped by homogeneous loans with similar terms and conditions and discounted at a target rate at which similar loans would be made to borrowers at September 30, 2016 and 2015.  In addition, when computing the estimated fair value for all loans, allowances for loan losses have been subtracted from the calculated fair value as a result of the discounted cash flow which approximates the fair value adjustment for the credit quality component.
 
FHLB STOCK
 
The fair value of such stock is assumed to approximate book value since the Company is generally able to redeem this stock at par value.
 
ACCRUED INTEREST RECEIVABLE
 
The carrying amount of accrued interest receivable is assumed to approximate the fair value.
 
DEPOSITS
 
The carrying values of non-interest-bearing checking deposits, interest-bearing checking deposits, savings and money markets is assumed to approximate fair value, since such deposits are immediately withdrawable without penalty.  The fair value of time certificates of deposit was estimated by discounting expected future cash flows by the current rates offered on certificates of deposit with similar remaining maturities.
 
In accordance with ASC 825, Financial Instruments, no value has been assigned to the Company’s long-term relationships with its deposit customers (core value of deposits intangible) since such intangible is not a financial instrument as defined under ASC 825.
 
ADVANCES FROM FHLB
 
The fair value of such advances was estimated by discounting the expected future cash flows using current interest rates for advances with similar terms and remaining maturities.
 
FEDERAL FUNDS PURCHASED
 
The carrying amount of federal funds purchased is assumed to approximate the fair value.
 
SECURITIES SOLD UNDER AGREEMENTS TO REPURCHASE, SUBORDINATED DEBENTURES AND TRUST PREFERRED SECURITIES
 
The fair value of these instruments was estimated by discounting the expected future cash flows using derived interest rates approximating market over the contractual maturity of such borrowings.
 
ACCRUED INTEREST PAYABLE
 
The carrying amount of accrued interest payable is assumed to approximate the fair value.
 



143



LIMITATIONS
 
It must be noted that fair value estimates are made at a specific point in time, based on relevant market information about the financial instrument.  Additionally, fair value estimates are based on existing on- and off-balance sheet financial instruments without attempting to estimate the value of anticipated future business, customer relationships and the value of assets and liabilities that are not considered financial instruments.  These estimates do not reflect any premium or discount that could result from offering the Company’s entire holdings of a particular financial instrument for sale at one time.  Furthermore, since no market exists for certain of the Company’s financial instruments, fair value estimates may be based on judgments regarding future expected loss experience, current economic conditions, risk characteristics of various financial instruments and other factors.  These estimates are subjective in nature and involve uncertainties and matters of significant judgment and therefore cannot be determined with a high level of precision.  Changes in assumptions as well as tax considerations could significantly affect the estimates.  Accordingly, based on the limitations described above, the aggregate fair value estimates are not intended to represent the underlying value of the Company, on either a going concern or a liquidation basis.

NOTE 20.  GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS
 
The Company recorded a total of $36.9 million of goodwill during the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016. The recorded goodwill was due to two separate business combinations during fiscal 2015 – $11.6 million of goodwill in connection with the purchase of substantially all of the commercial loan portfolio and related assets of AFS/IBEX on December 2, 2014, and $25.4 million in goodwill in connection with the purchase of substantially all of the assets and liabilities of Refund Advantage, on September 8, 2015.  The goodwill associated with these transactions are deductible for tax purposes.
 
As part of the each business combination, the Company also recognized the following amortizable intangible assets:
 
AFS/IBEX:
Intangible
Amount Upon Acquisition
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Balance at September 30, 2016
 
Book Amortization
Period (Years)
 
Method
Trademark
$
540

 
$
(66
)
 
$
474

 
15
 
Straight Line
Non-Compete
260

 
(159
)
 
101

 
3
 
Straight Line
Customer Relationships
7,240

 
(2,296
)
 
4,944

 
30
 
Accelerated
Other
173

 
(92
)
 
81

 
Varied
 
Straight Line
Total
$
8,213

 
$
(2,613
)
 
$
5,600

 
 
 
 

Refund Advantage: 
Intangible
Amount Upon Acquisition
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Balance at September 30, 2016
 
Book Amortization
Period (Years)
 
Method
Trademark
$
4,950

 
$
(275
)
 
$
4,675

 
15
 
Accelerated
Non-Compete
40

 
(14
)
 
26

 
3
 
Straight Line
Customer Relationships
18,800

 
(3,154
)
 
15,646

 
12 to 20
 
Accelerated
Other
329

 
(73
)
 
256

 
Varied
 
Straight Line
Total
$
24,119

 
$
(3,516
)
 
$
20,603

 
 
 
 

Other:
Intangible
Amount Upon Acquisition
 
Accumulated Amortization
 
Balance at September 30, 2016
 
Book Amortization
Period (Years)
 
Method
Other
$
3,054

 
$
(336
)
 
$
2,718

 
Varied
 
Straight Line
Total
$
3,054

 
$
(336
)
 
$
2,718

 
 
 
 

144


The changes in the carrying amount of the Company’s goodwill and intangible assets for the years ended September 30, 2016 and 2015 are as follows:
 
 
September 30,
 
2016
 
2015
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
Goodwill
 
Beginning balance
$
36,928

 
$

Acquisitions during the period

 
36,928

Write-offs during the period

 

Ending balance
$
36,928

 
$
36,928


The Company completed an annual goodwill impairment test for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2016. Based on the results of the qualitative analysis, it was identified that it was more likely than not the fair value of the goodwill recorded exceeded the current carrying value. The Company concluded quantitative analysis was not required and no impairment existed.
 
 
Trademark
 
Non-Compete
 
Customer
Relationships
 
All Others
 
Total
Intangibles
 
Balance as of September 30, 2015
$
5,439

 
$
227

 
$
24,811

 
$
3,100

 
$
33,577

Acquisitions during the period

 

 

 
172

 
172

Amortization during the period
(290
)
 
(100
)
 
(4,221
)
 
(217
)
 
(4,828
)
Write-offs during the period

 

 

 

 

Balance as of September 30, 2016
$
5,149

 
$
127

 
$
20,590

 
$
3,055

 
$
28,921


 
Trademark
 
Non-Compete
 
Customer
Relationships
 
All Others
 
Total
Intangibles
 
Balance as of September 30, 2014
$

 
$

 
$

 
$
2,588

 
$
2,588

Acquisitions during the period
5,490

 
300

 
26,040

 
855

 
32,685

Amortization during the period
(51
)
 
(73
)
 
(1,229
)
 
(282
)
 
(1,635
)
Write-offs during the period

 

 

 
(61
)
 
(61
)
Balance as of September 30, 2015
$
5,439

 
$
227

 
$
24,811

 
$
3,100

 
$
33,577


The Company tests intangible assets for impairment at least annually or more often if conditions indicate a possible impairment.
    
The anticipated future amortization of intangibles is as follows:
 
September 30,
 
(Dollars in Thousands)
2017
$
4,128

2018
3,529

2019
3,013

2020
2,610

2021
2,271

Thereafter
13,370

Total anticipated intangible amortization
$
28,921


145



NOTE 21.  SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

MetaBank entered into an agreement with H&R Block® on October 26, 2016 to provide funding for up to $1.45 billion and retain up to $750 million of interest-free refund advance loans for H&R Block® tax preparation customers throughout the 2017 tax season. H&R Block® is the world's largest tax services provider with approximately 12,000 company-owned and franchise retail locations.

On November 1, 2016, MetaBank, completed the acquisition of substantially all of the assets and certain liabilities of EPS from privately-held Drake Enterprises, Ltd. (“Drake”). The assets acquired by MetaBank in the EPS acquisition include the EPS trade name, operating platform, and other assets. EPS is a leading provider of comprehensive tax-related financial transaction solutions for over 10,000 EROs nationwide, offering a one-stop-shop for all tax preparer financial transactions. These solutions include a full-suite of refund settlement products, prepaid payroll card solutions and merchant services. The EPS management team and other employees have been hired by MetaBank and EPS operations will continue to be based out of Easton, PA. The purchase price for the acquisition of approximately $42.5 million included the payment of approximately $21.3 million in cash and the issuance of 369,179 shares of Meta Financial common stock to Drake. The cash portion of the purchase price was funded from the proceeds of the previously announced subordinated debt issuance.

On November 9, 2016, Meta Financial and MetaBank entered into an agreement with Specialty Consumer Services LP, (‘SCS”) to acquire substantially all of the assets, and assume specified liabilities, of SCS. In exchange, Meta Financial has agreed to pay SCS consideration of approximately $15 million, subject to adjustment. If certain performance targets are met after the closing of the transaction, SCS will be eligible to receive earnout payments consisting of up to an aggregate of $17.5 million in cash and up to an aggregate of 264,431 shares of Meta Financial’s common stock. The transaction is expected to close in the fourth calendar quarter of 2016.

On November 28, 2016, MetaBank and Jackson Hewitt finalized an agreement whereby MetaBank will be originating Express Refund Advances to Jackson Hewitt customers.


Item 9.        Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
 
None.


146



 
Item 9A.        Controls and Procedures

(a)
Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures.

Management, under the direction of its Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, is responsible for maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “1934 Act”) that are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in reports filed or submitted under the 1934 Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in SEC rules and forms and that such information is accumulated and communicated to management, including the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures.
 
In connection with the preparation of this Annual Report on Form 10-K, management evaluated the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures. The evaluation was performed under the direction of the Company’s Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer to determine the effectiveness, as of September 30, 2016, of the design and operation of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures.  Based upon that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures were effective in timely alerting them to the material information relating to the Company required to be included in the Company’s periodic SEC filings.  In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended September 30, 2016, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

(b)
Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting.

The Company’s management is responsible for establishing and maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting.  The Company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with GAAP.  Our internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with GAAP, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of the Company’s management and directors; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the Company assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Internal control over financial reporting, no matter how well designed, has inherent limitations.  Because of such inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements.  Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
Management assessed the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, based on the criteria set forth by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in “Internal Control Integrated Framework (2013).”  Based on our assessment, our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of September 30, 2016.

The effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, has been audited by KPMG LLP, the independent registered public accounting firm that also has audited the Company’s consolidated financial statements included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. KPMG LLP’s report on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting appears below.
 
(c)
Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting.

There were no changes in the Company's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the fourth quarter that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company's internal control over financial reporting.
 
Item 9B.        Other Information

None.

147


KPMG LLP
2500 Ruan Center
666 Grand Avenue
Des Moines, IA 50309
 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 

The Board of Directors and Stockholders
Meta Financial Group, Inc.:

We have audited Meta Financial Group, Inc.’s (the Company) internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.
We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audit also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
In our opinion, Meta Financial Group, Inc. maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2016, based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statements of financial condition of Meta Financial Group, Inc. and subsidiaries as of September 30, 2016 and 2015, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income, changes in stockholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended September 30, 2016, and our report dated December 14, 2016 expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements.

 
/s/ KPMG LLP
 
 
Des Moines, Iowa
 
December 14, 2016
 

148


PART III
Item 10.        Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

Directors
 
Information concerning directors of the Company required by this item will be included under the captions “Election of Directors,” “Communicating with Our Directors” and “Stockholder Proposals For The Year 2017 Annual Meeting” in the Company’s definitive Proxy Statement for the Annual Meeting of Stockholders to be held on January 23, 2017 (the “2016 Proxy Statement”), a copy of which will be filed not later than 120 days after September 30, 2016, and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Executive Officers
 
Information concerning the executive officers of the Company required by this item is set forth under the caption “Executive Officers of the Company Who Are Not Directors” contained in Part I, Item 1 “Business” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Compliance with Section 16(a)
 
Information required by this item regarding compliance with Section 16(a) of the Exchange Act will be included under the caption “Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Audit Committee Financial Expert
 
Information regarding the audit committee of the Company’s Board of Directors, including information regarding Frederick Moore, Becky Shulman and Kendall Stork, the audit committee financial experts serving on the audit committee for fiscal 2016, will be included under the captions “Meetings and Committees” and “Election of Directors” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Code of Ethics
 
Information regarding the Company’s Code of Ethics will be included under the caption “Corporate Governance” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 11.        Executive Compensation
 
Information concerning executive and director compensation will be included under the captions “Compensation of Directors” and “Executive Compensation” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 12.        Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
 
(a)           Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management
 
The information required by this item will be included under the caption “Stock Ownership” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.

(b)           Changes in Control
 
Management of the Company knows of no arrangements, including any pledge by any persons of securities of the Company, the operation of which may, at a subsequent date, result in a change in control of the Registrant.
 
(c)           Equity Compensation Plan Information
 
The Company maintains the 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan for purposes of issuing stock-based compensation to employees and directors.  An amendment to this plan, authorizing an additional 750,000 shares to be issued under this plan, was approved by the Board of Directors on November 30, 2007, and by the stockholders at the annual meeting held February 12, 2008.  The Company also has unexercised options outstanding under a previous stock option plan.  The following table provides information about the Company’s common stock that may be issued under the Company’s omnibus incentive plans.
 

149


Plan Category
 
Number of securities
to be issued upon
exercise of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
 
Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding options,
warrants and rights
 
Number of securities
remaining available
for future issuance
under equity
compensation plan
excluding securities
reflected in (a)
Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders
 
125,560

 
$
25.73

 
480,739

Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders
 

 
$

 


Item 13.        Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
 
The information required by this item will be included under the captions “Election of Directors,” “Meetings and Committees” and “Related Person Transactions” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 14.        Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
The information required by this item will be included under the caption “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” in the Company’s 2016 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
PART IV
Item 15.        Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
 
The following is a list of documents filed as Part of this report:
 
(a)           Financial Statements:
 
The following financial statements are included under Part II, Item 8 of this Annual Report on Form 10-K:

1.
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

2.
Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition as of September 30, 2016, and 2015.

3.
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended September 30, 2016, 2015, and 2014.

4.
Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the Years ended September 30, 2016, 2015, and 2014.

5.
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended September 30, 2016, 2015, and 2014.

6.
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended September 30, 2016, 2015, and 2014.

7.
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.
 

(b)           Exhibits:
 
See Index to Exhibits.
 
(c)           Financial Statement Schedules:
 
All financial statement schedules have been omitted as the information is not required under the related instructions or is inapplicable.

150


Item 16.        Form 10-K Summary

None.


151



SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this Report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
 
META FINANCIAL GROUP, INC.
 
 
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
By:
/s/ J. Tyler Haahr
 
 
J. Tyler Haahr, Chairman of the Board
 
 
and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this Report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 

152


By:
/s/ J. Tyler Haahr
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
J. Tyler Haahr, Chairman of the Board
 
 
 
and Chief Executive Officer
 
 
 
(Principal Executive Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Bradley C. Hanson
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Bradley C. Hanson, President and Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Douglas J. Hajek
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Douglas J. Hajek, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Elizabeth G. Hoople
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Elizabeth G. Hoople, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Frederick V. Moore
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Frederick V. Moore, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Rodney G. Muilenburg
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Rodney G. Muilenburg, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Becky S. Shulman
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Becky S. Shulman, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Kendall E. Stork
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Kendall E. Stork, Director
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Glen W. Herrick
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Glen W. Herrick, Executive Vice
 
 
 
President and Chief Financial Officer
 
 
 
(Principal Financial Officer)
 
 
 
 
 
 
By:
/s/ Sonja A. Theisen
 
Date:  December 14, 2016
 
Sonja A. Theisen, Senior Vice President
 
 
 
and Chief Accounting Officer
 
 
 
(Principal Accounting Officer)
 
 

153


INDEX TO EXHIBITS 
Exhibit
Number
 
Description
 
 
2.1
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of July 15, 2015, by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., MetaBank, Fort Knox Financial Services Corporation, Tax Product Services LLC, Alan D. Lodge Family Trust, Michael E. Boone, Michael J. Boone, Cary Shields and Alan D. Lodge filed on July 16, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8‑K, is incorporated herein by reference. Exhibits and schedules have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant will furnish the omitted exhibits and schedules to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request by the Commission.
 
 
2.2
Asset Purchase Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2016, by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., MetaBank, Drake Enterprises, Ltd., and EPS Financial, LLC filed on November 3, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference. Exhibits and schedules have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant will furnish the omitted exhibits and schedules to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request by the Commission.
 
 
2.3
Asset Purchase Agreement dated as of November 9, 2016, by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., MetaBank, and Specialty Consumer Services LP filed on November 10, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference. Exhibits and schedules have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant will furnish the omitted exhibits and schedules to the Securities and Exchange Commission upon request by the Commission.
 
 
3.1
Registrant’s Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, filed on May 10, 2013 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (Commission File No. 333-188535), is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
3.2
Registrant’s Certificate of Amendment to the Certificate of Incorporation, as amended, filed on January 26, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
3.3
Registrant’s Amended and Restated By-laws, as amended, filed on December 14, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2015, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
4.1
Registrant’s Specimen Stock Certificate, filed on June 26, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (Commission File No. 333-212269), is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
4.2
Sales Agency Agreement, dated December 17, 2014, among Meta Financial Group, Inc., MetaBank and Sandler O’Neill & Partners, L.P. filed on December 17, 2014 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
4.3
Indenture, dated as of August 15, 2016, by and between the Registrant and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee, filed on August 15, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
4.4
First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 15, 2016, by and between the Registrant and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee, filed on August 15, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
4.5
Form of Global Note of the Registrant representing the 5.75% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Subordinated Notes due August 15, 2026, filed on August 15, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
*10.1
Registrant’s 1995 Stock Option and Incentive Plan, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-KSB for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1996, is incorporated herein by reference
 
 
*10.2
Employment Agreement between MetaBank and J. Tyler Haahr, dated as of October 1, 2016, filed on November 18, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.3
Employment Agreement between MetaBank and Bradley C. Hanson, dated as of October 1, 2016, filed on November 18, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.4
Employment Agreement between MetaBank and Glen W. Herrick, dated as of October 1, 2016, filed on December 6, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.5
Registrant’s Supplemental Employees’ Investment Plan, originally filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-KSB for the fiscal year ended September 30, 1994.  First amendment to such agreement, filed as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2008, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.6
Registrant’s 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan, as amended and restated effective November 24, 2014, filed on December 16, 2014 as Appendix A to the Registrant’s Schedule 14A (DEF 14A) Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.



10.7
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Consector Partners Master Fund, LP, dated as of June 25, 2015, filed on July 1, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.8
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Consector Partners Master Fund, LP, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.9
Securities Purchase Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Boathouse Row I, LP, Boathouse Row II, LP, Boathouse Row Offshore Ltd., and OC 532 Offshore Fund, Ltd., dated as of June 25, 2015, filed on July 1, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.1
Registration Rights Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Boathouse Row I, LP, Boathouse Row II, LP, Boathouse Row Offshore Ltd., and OC 532 Offshore Fund, Ltd., dated as of September 8, 2015 filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.11
Securities Purchase Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., Patriot Financial Partners II, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P., dated as of June 25, 2015, filed on July 1, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.12
Registration Rights Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., Patriot Financial Partners II, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P., dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.13
Investor Rights Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., Patriot Financial Partners II, L.P. and Patriot Financial Partners Parallel II, L.P., dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.14
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Hawk Ridge Master Fund LP, dated as of June 29, 2015, filed on July 1, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.15
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Hawk Ridge Master Fund LP, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.16
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Fort George Investments, LLC, dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.17
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Fort George Investments, LLC, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.18
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners SI, LP, dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.19
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners SI, LP, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference
 
 
10.20
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Blackwell Partners LLC Series A, dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.21
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Blackwell Partners LLC Series A, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.22
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners II Limited Partnership, dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.23
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners II Limited Partnership, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.24
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Silver Creek CS SAV, L.L.C., dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.25
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Silver Creek CS SAV, L.L.C., dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.26
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners Limited Partnership, dated as of July 7, 2015, filed on July 13, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.



10.27
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners Limited Partnership, dated as of September 8, 2015, filed on September 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.28
Securities Purchase Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc. and BEP IV LLC and BEP Investors LLC, dated as of September 23, 2015, filed on September 24, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.29
Registration Rights Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., BEP IV LLC and BEP Investors, LLC, dated as of December 17, 2015, filed on December 17, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8‑K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.30
Investor Rights Agreement by and among Meta Financial Group, Inc., BEP IV LLC and BEP Investors, LLC, dated as of December 17, 2015, filed on December 17, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8‑K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.31
Securities Purchase Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners SI, LP, dated as of December 7, 2015, filed on December 8, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8‑K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
10.32
Registration Rights Agreement by and between Meta Financial Group, Inc. and Nantahala Capital Partners SI, LP, dated as of December 17, 2015, filed on December 17, 2015 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8‑K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.33
Separation and General Release Agreement dated as of September 9, 2016, by and among the Company, MetaBank and Ira D. Frericks. filed on September 9, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.34
Separation and General Release Agreement dated as of September 30, 2016, by and among the Company, MetaBank and Troy Moore III, filed on September 30, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
*10.35
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement under Meta Financial Group, Inc. 2002 Omnibus Incentive Plan filed on August 2, 2016 as an exhibit to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q, is incorporated herein by reference.
 
 
11
Statement re: computation of per share earnings (See Note 2 of “Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements,” which is included in Part II, Item 8 “Financial Statements and Supplementary Data” of this Annual Report on Form 10-K).
 
 
21
Subsidiaries of the Registrant is filed herewith.
 
 
23.1
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm is filed herewith.
 
 
31.1
Certification of Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes‑Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
 
 
31.2
Certification of Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes‑Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
 
 
32.1
Certification of the CEO pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
32.2
Certification of the CFO pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 is filed herewith.
 
 
101.INS
Instance Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
101.SCH
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
101.CAL
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
101.DEF
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
101.LAB
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
101.PRE
XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document Filed Herewith.
 
 
* Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Agreement